EPRI Phosphat & Caustic Treatment Guidelines
EPRI Phosphat & Caustic Treatment Guidelines
EPRI Phosphat & Caustic Treatment Guidelines
SED
R I
A L
LICE
M AT E
WARNING:
Please read the License Agreement
on the back cover before removing
the Wrapping Material.
Technical Report
EPRI 3412 Hillview Avenue, Palo Alto, California 94304 PO Box 10412, Palo Alto, California 94303 USA
800.313.3774 650.855.2121 [email protected] www.epri.com
ORDERING INFORMATION
Requests for copies of this report should be directed to EPRI Orders and Conferences, 1355 Willow
Way, Suite 278, Concord, CA 94520, (800) 313-3774, press 2 or internally x5379, (925) 609-9169,
(925) 609-1310 (fax).
Electric Power Research Institute and EPRI are registered service marks of the Electric Power
Research Institute, Inc. EPRI. ELECTRIFY THE WORLD is a service mark of the Electric Power
Research Institute, Inc.
Copyright 2004 Electric Power Research Institute, Inc. All rights reserved.
CITATIONS
This report was prepared by
EPRI
3412 Hillview Avenue
Palo Alto, California 94304
Authors
R. B. Dooley
K. Shields
A. Aschoff
M. Ball
A. Bursik
M. Gruszkiewicz
This report describes research sponsored by EPRI.
The report is a corporate document that should be cited in the literature in the following manner:
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Phosphate Continuum and Caustic Treatment,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2004. 1004188.
iii
PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
The purity of water and steam is central to ensuring fossil plant component availability and
reliability. These guidelines for drum units provide information on the application of phosphate
and caustic boiler water treatments. The guidelines will help operators reduce corrosion and
deposition, and thereby achieve significant operation and maintenance cost reductions and
greater unit availability.
Results & Findings
These guidelines include the following new features and control philosophies:
There are two distinct solid alkali boiler water treatments: phosphate continuum (PC) and
caustic treatment (CT). Examples are provided for the low and high levels of phosphate
addition: PC(L) and PC(H).
The PC is bounded by Na:PO4 molar ratio of 3 and tri-sodium phosphate plus 1 ppm NaOH.
It has a minimum phosphate level of 0.2 ppm and a minimum pH of 9 to reduce the
possibility for boiler corrosion.
There are two distinctly different feedwater all-volatile treatments defined by the oxidation
reduction potential (ORP). Feedwater systems having all-ferrous materials and using no
reducing agent will operate with AVT(O). Those systems having mixed metallurgy (copper)
materials and operating with a reducing agent and low oxygen (<10 ppb) will operate with
AVT(R).
A separate set of target values and action levels to protect the steam turbine and boiler are
included for both PC and CT.
Examples of specific and cation conductivity curves have been provided for PC and CT and
linked to contaminant (chloride and sulfate) levels in the boiler water.
Correction curves and approaches have been developed for the effects of ammonia and
carbon dioxide on boiler water pH.
vi
ABSTRACT
This Phosphate Continuum/Caustic Treatment (PC/CT) Guideline for Fossil Plants represents a
major revision of EPRIs previous phosphate guideline from 1994, and a combination with a
previous EPRI report on the application of Caustic Treatment. This new guideline now
represents the solid alkali treatments applicable to fossil plants.
The approach developed for PC/CT follows that used in the 2002 revision of EPRIs AVT
Guideline, where the steam and boiler water limits have been decoupled to provide unique
operating limits to protect the boiler and the turbine. The boiler water control limits for both PC
and CT have been designed so they are below the values which are predicted to meet EPRIs
new steam limits.
A phosphate continuum has been developed and is described in Section 1. Although it is a
continuum, operators need to recognize that there are extremes at the low (L) and high (H) end of
the phosphate range. These have been designated as PC(L) and PC(H), and examples of
guideline limits for both have been provided in Section 4. However, to select and optimize the
phosphate treatment for each boiler, a road map has been provided in Section 2, which requires,
as a minimum, knowledge of the possible contaminants in the boiler, the carryover into the
steam, and the level of sodium in steam. Actual derivation of each set of boiler water control
curves, especially for cation and specific conductivity, will require reference to Section 3 where
the rationale and derivation of each control parameter is extensively described.
Caustic treatment has now been developed into full EPRI Guidelines structure in Section 5. A
complete set of control curves, normal and action levels has been developed. As with PC, the
limits for each parameter have been verified and derived in the rationale of Section 3.
These new PC/CT Guidelines provide a complete set of solid alkali guidelines to address the
serious corrosion problems currently in the fossil plant industry.
vii
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
The authors of these guidelines
R. B. Dooley
K. J. Shields
A. Aschoff
M. Ball
A. Bursik
M. Gruszkiewicz
EPRI
EPRI
Consultant
Consultant
Consultant
Oak Ridge National Laboratory
acknowledge the assistance provided by D. Palmer from Oak Ridge National Laboratory in
providing guidance on the volatility/partitioning of compounds between boiler water and steam.
The draft guideline was reviewed by 75 members of the Boiler and Turbine Steam and Cycle
Chemistry Target around the world. The authors particularly acknowledge the contributions from
the following:
K. Armstrong
D. Aspden
B. Buecker
M. Caravaggio
H. Cheng
J. Mathews
R. Pate
D. Reynolds
G. Verib
Atco Power
ESKOM
KCPL
Ontario Power Generation
CLP Power Hong Kong Ltd.
Duke Energy
Southern Company
Dynegy
First Energy
ix
CONTENTS
1.1.2
Program Philosophy............................................................................................1-4
1.1.3
1.1.4
1.2.2
1.2.5
xi
xii
xiii
xiv
CONTINUUM (PC).....................................................................................................................4-1
4.1 INTRODUCTION TO PC................................................................................................4-1
4.2 GUIDANCE AND GUIDELINES FOR PC(L) ..................................................................4-4
4.2.1 Introduction to PC(L) ..............................................................................................4-4
4.2.2 Target Values for PC(L)........................................................................................4-10
4.2.3 Normal Operation for PC(L)..................................................................................4-23
Continual Check of pH and Phosphate Level ............................................................4-24
4.2.4 Operation During Upset Conditions......................................................................4-24
4.2.5 Unit Startup and Shutdown...................................................................................4-26
Cold Startup ...............................................................................................................4-26
xv
xvi
xvii
xviii
xix
xx
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1-1 Overall Philosophy of EPRIs Cycle Chemistry Program. CCIP is Cycle
Chemistry Improvement Program, BTFR is Boiler Tube Failure Reduction, FAC is
Flow-accelerated Corrosion, and CP is Condensate Polishing..........................................1-5
Figure 1-2 Schematic of the Processes in PTZ. The extra arrows pointing in to the
Deposits indicate that deposition can occur by other methods........................................1-8
Figure 1-3 Model for the Development of Corrosion Processes in the PTZ of Steam
Turbines ...........................................................................................................................1-10
Figure 1-4 Partitioning Constants for Common Salts, Oxides and Acids. KD is the
partitioning constant. ........................................................................................................1-12
Figure 1-5 pH Dependence of the Cu Release Rates at 95C (203F) for Al-Brass, 90Cu10Ni and Admiralty Brass After Treatment in Non-Degassed Feedwater at ORP
* OX =
+100 mV and 300 mV*
Oxidizing, RED = Reducing
1-13
Figure 1-6 Schematic of Operating Ranges of Boiler Water on Equilibrium Phosphate
Treatment (EPT), Congruent Phosphate Treatment (CPT) and Phosphate
Treatment (PT). It should be noted that these are the old phosphate operating
ranges, and are shown here for reference only. They shouldnt be applied to fossil
plants................................................................................................................................1-15
Figure 1-7 Schematic of Operating Range for PC. a) is normal scale, b) is log scale. ............1-17
Figure 2-1 Summary of Possible Boiler Water and Feedwater Treatments for Fossil
(1)
Plants as a Function of Equipment and Equipment Capability . This is the
Continuum of Treatments. ...............................................................................................2-5
Figure 2-2 Schematic Representation of Oxide Formed on Ferrous Feedwater Surfaces
During Operation with Reducing AVT ................................................................................2-7
Figure 2-3 Change in Oxidizing-Reducing Potential (ORP) and Feedwater Iron Levels
(Fe) at the Economizer Inlet when Hydrazine (N2H4) is Gradually Reduced on a
(10)
600MW Drum Unit with an All-Ferrous Feedwater System .............................................2-8
Figure 2-4 Schematic Representation of Oxide Formed on Iron-Based Feedwater
Surfaces During Operation with Oxidizing AVT and OT.....................................................2-9
Figure 2-5 Road Map for Optimizing Feedwater Treatment for All-Ferrous Feedwater
Systems ...........................................................................................................................2-11
Figure 2-6 Surface Images of Admiralty Brass After Treatment at 95C (203F), pH 9
and ORP = +100 mV (a,c,e,g) and ORP = -350 mV (b,d,f,h) for 8 (a,b), 24 (c,d), 100
(e,f) and 200 (g,h) hours. The surface oxide under reducing conditions is protective
(12)
Cu2O. The rougher surface oxide under oxidizing conditions is CuO. ..........................2-16
Figure 2-7 Road Map for Optimizing Feedwater Treatment for Mixed-Metallurgy Systems ....2-18
xxi
Figure 2-8 Road Map for Selecting or Optimizing Boiler Water Treatment for Drum
Boilers ..............................................................................................................................2-23
Figure 3-1 Typical Locations of Impurity Ingress, Corrosion and Deposition in a Drum
Cycle ..................................................................................................................................3-2
Figure 3-2 Representative Drum Boiler Mechanical Carryover used to Derive Generic
Cycle Chemistry Limits; Actual Carryover in Drum Boilers Must be Determined in
the Field as There are Significant Variations Due to Drum Design, Firing Rate and
Drum Operating Level. .......................................................................................................3-4
Figure 3-3 Distribution Ratios for Common Boiler Water Contaminants (This ray diagram
(7,8)
was originally developed by N. A. Styrikovich and O. I. Martynova. ) .............................3-5
Figure 3-4 Equilibrium Phosphate Treatment (EPT): Drum Boiler Water Chloride vs.
Operating Pressure. Calculated using mechanical and vaporous carryover for a
limit of 3 ppb Chloride in Steam. The values were identical for sulfate. It must be
noted that these are the old EPT limits derived in the previous Phosphate
(1)
Treatment Guidelines and should no longer be used. The new PC(L) limits are
discussed in Section 4. ......................................................................................................3-9
Figure 3-5 Phosphate Treatment (PT): Drum Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating
Pressure. Calculated using mechanical and vaporous carryover for a limit of 3 ppb
Chloride in Steam. It must be noted that these are the old limits derived in the
(1)
previous Phosphate Treatment Guidelines and should no longer be used. The
new PC(H) limits are discussed in Section 4. ..................................................................3-10
Figure 3-6 Partitioning Constants - Neutral Species ................................................................3-13
Figure 3-7 Partitioning Constants - 1:1 Compounds................................................................3-14
Figure 3-8 Partitioning Constants - 1:2 Compounds................................................................3-15
Figure 3-9 Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of
Sodium in the boiler water. The bottom set of three curves is for conditions typical
of PC(L) to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in steam. The upper set of three curves
is for conditions typical of PC(H) to ensure less than 3 ppb sodium in steam. In
each set, the top straight line is for mechanical carryover only. The two lower
curves are at Na:PO4 = 3 (lower) and TSP + 1 ppm NaOH (higher). It should be
noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits. The
curves are only to verify and illustrate the control curves in the Guidelines (Section
4). .....................................................................................................................................3-16
Figure 3-10 Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of
Chloride in the boiler water. The curves are representative of conditions for PC(L) to
ensure less than 2 ppb chloride in steam. The top line (1) is for consideration of
mechanical carryover only. Line 3 is for Na:PO4 = 3 and includes vaporous
carryover. Lines 2 and 4 are for TSP + 1 ppm NaOH and also include vaporous
carryover. Line 4 represents the condition where the chloride is limited by the
sodium limit. It should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as
boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the control curves in
the Guidelines (Section 4)................................................................................................3-17
Figure 3-11 Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of
Sulfate in the boiler water. The bottom set of three curves is for conditions typical of
PC(L) to ensure less than 2 ppb sulfate in steam. The upper set of curves is for
conditions typical of PC(H) to ensure less than 3 ppb sulfate in steam. In each set,
the top line is for mechanical carryover only. The two lower curves are at Na:PO4 =
xxii
3 (lower) and TSP+ 1 ppm NaOH (higher) and include vaporous carryover. It should
be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits. The
curves are only to verify and illustrate the control curves in the Guidelines (Section
4). .....................................................................................................................................3-18
Figure 3-12 Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of
Silica in the boiler water to Ensure Less than 10 ppb Silica (as SiO2) in Steam. The
curves are representative of PC(L), PC(H) and CT. Curve 1 is for mechanical
carryover only. Curve 2 is for mechanical and vaporous carryover. It should be
noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits. The
curves are only to verify and illustrate the control curves in the Guidelines (Section
4). .....................................................................................................................................3-19
Figure 3-13 Model Predictions for Boiler Water Chloride as a Function of Pressure. The
curves are representative of conditions for PC(H) to ensure less than 3 ppb chloride
in steam. The top line (1) is for consideration of mechanical carryover only. Line 3 is
for Na:PO4 = 3 and includes vaporous carryover. Lines 2 and 4 are for TSP + 1 ppm
NaOH and also include vaporous carryover. Line 4 represents the condition where
chloride is limited by the sodium limit, but does include vaporous carryover. It
should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as boiler control
limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the curves in the Guidelines
(Section 4)........................................................................................................................3-21
Figure 3-14 Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sodium as a Function of Pressure. The
curves are representative of conditions for CT to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in
steam. Curve 1 is for mechanical carryover only. Curve 2 is for mechanical and
vaporous carryover. It should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be
used as boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the curves in
the Guidelines (Section 5)................................................................................................3-24
Figure 3-15 Model Predictions for Boiler Water Chloride as a Function of Pressure. The
curves are representative of the conditions for CT to ensure less than 2 ppb
chloride in steam. Curve 1 is for mechanical carryover only. Curves 2 are for
mechanical and vaporous carryover with various levels of NaOH (0.5, 1.0 and 2
ppm). Curves 3 are for mechanical and vaporous carryover for AVT conditions at
different ammonia levels (pH 9, 9.2, 9.4 and 9.6). It should be noted that the curves
in this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify
and illustrate the curves in the Guidelines (Section 5). ....................................................3-25
Figure 3-16 Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sulfate as a Function of Pressure. The
curves are representative of conditions for CT to ensure less than 2 ppb sulfate in
steam. Curve 1 is for mechanical carryover only. Curve 2 is for mechanical and
vaporous carryover. It should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be
used as boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the curves in
the Guidelines (Section 5)................................................................................................3-26
Figure 3-17 Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sodium as a Function of Pressure when
Operating with PC(H) to ensure less than 3 ppb sodium in steam at Na:PO4 = 3,
and also the contribution from 1 ppm NaOH, if added. The top curve is the same as
shown in Figure 3-9. Note: these curves should not be used for boiler water control;
they are provided to illustrate the effects of sodium in boiler water. The control
curves for PC(H) are provided in Section 4......................................................................3-42
Figure 3-18 Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sodium as a Function of Pressure when
Operating with PC(L) to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in steam at Na:PO4 = 3, and
xxiii
also the contribution from 1 ppm NaOH, if added. The top curve is the same as
shown in Figure 3-9. Note: these curves should not be used for boiler water control;
they are provided to illustrate the effects of sodium in boiler water. The control
curves for PC(L) are provided in Section 4. .....................................................................3-43
Figure 3-19 Specific Conductivity as a Function of Phosphate Level with Varying Na:PO4
ratios and TSP + 1 ppm NaOH. No influence of ammonia is included. It should also
be noted that the curve for H3PO4 crresponds to cation conductivity. ..............................3-58
Figure 3-20 Estimates of Specific Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(L). The lower
curve reflects the conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is
based on the phosphate concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration
given in Figure 3-18 to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve
reflects the situation with additional chloride and sulfate in the boiler water. Note:
these curves must not be used for boiler water control; they are provided here to
assist the reader to develop a set of specific conductivity control curves in Section 4
for PC(L)...........................................................................................................................3-59
Figure 3-21 Estimate of Specific Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(H). The lower
curve reflects the conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is
based on the phosphate concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration
given in Figure 3-17 to ensure less than 3 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve
reflects the situation with additional chloride and sulfate in the boiler water. Note:
these curves must not be used for boiler water control; they are provided here to
assist the reader to develop a set of specific conductivity control curves in Section 4
for PC(H). .........................................................................................................................3-60
Figure 3-22 Estimates of Cation Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(L). The lower
curve reflects the conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is
based on the phosphate concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration
given in Figure 3-18 to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve
reflects the situation with additional chloride and sulfate present in the boiler water.
Note: these curves must not be used for boiler control; they are provided here to
assist the reader to develop a set of cation conductivity control curves in Section 4
for PC(L)...........................................................................................................................3-66
Figure 3-23 Estimates of Cation Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(H). The lower
curve reflects the conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is
based on the phosphate concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration
given in Figure 3-17 to ensure less than 3 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve
reflects the situation with additional chloride and sulfate present in the boiler water.
Note: these curves must not be used for boiler control; they are only provided here
to assist the reader to develop a set of cation conductivity control curves in Section
4 for PC(H). ......................................................................................................................3-67
Figure 3-24 Cation Conductivity Versus Pressure for PC(L) only taking into account the
maximum (normal) levels of chloride and sulfate (1:2 ratio). It must be noted that
any contribution from phosphate has been excluded.......................................................3-68
Figure 3-25 Cation Conductivity Versus Pressure for PC(H) only taking into account the
maximum (normal) levels of chloride and sulfate (1:2 ratio). It must be noted that
any contribution from phosphate has been excluded.......................................................3-69
Figure 3-26 Relationship between ammonia concentration and pH for various carbon
dioxide concentrations in feedwater. The lowest curve represents zero CO2. The top
curve represents 4 ppm CO2. ...........................................................................................3-74
xxiv
Figure 4-1 Schematic of Operating Range for PC (a is normal scale, b is log scale) ................4-2
Figure 4-2 PC(L): Boiler Water Phosphate vs. Operating Pressure ..........................................4-5
Figure 4-3 Boiler Water pH vs. Phosphate at Various Ammonia Levels. Na/PO4 = 3. The
lowest curve is at zero ammonia, the highest curve is at 2 ppm ammonia. .......................4-6
Figure 4-4 Boiler Water pH vs. Phosphate at Various Ammonia Levels. TSP + 1 ppm
NaOH. The lowest curve is at zero ammonia. The highest curve is at 2 ppm
ammonia. ...........................................................................................................................4-7
Figure 4-5 Relationship Between Corrected Boiler Water pH, Measured Boiler Water pH
and Measured Ammonia Concentration. The lines on the figure increase in 0.1 ppm
ammonia increments from 0 to 2 ppm. To determine the corrected pH, find the
measured pH on the x-axis and the point at which a vertical line intersects the
measured ammonia concentration. This point, extended horizontally to the y-axis,
indicates the corresponding corrected pH value. ...............................................................4-9
Figure 4-6 Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(L) with AVT(O) feedwater. All-ferrous
metallurgy in feedwater system. Operating with an oxidizing environment (no
reducing agent). ...............................................................................................................4-11
Figure 4-7 Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(L) with AVT(R) feedwater. All-ferrous and
mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems. Operating with a reducing environment
(reducing agent added). ...................................................................................................4-12
Figure 4-8 PC(L): Boiler Water Sodium vs. Operating Pressure .............................................4-15
Figure 4-9 PC(L): Boiler Water pH vs. Operating Pressure. pH due to trisodium
phosphate (3.8 to 1.0 ppm phosphate from Figure 4-2)...................................................4-16
Figure 4-10 PC(L): Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating Pressure ..........................................4-17
Figure 4-11 PC(L): Boiler Water Sulfate vs. Operating Pressure ............................................4-18
Figure 4-12 PC(L): Boiler Water Silica vs. Operating Pressure ...............................................4-19
Figure 4-13 PC(L): Drum Boiler Water Specific Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure
showing specific conductivity due to phosphate alone, and due to phosphate plus
various amounts of chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an
example to illustrate the effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator
will need to develop unique curves for each boiler as described in the text of
Sections 4.2.2 and 3.8.11. ...............................................................................................4-21
Figure 4-14 PC(L): Drum Boiler Water Cation Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure
showing cation conductivity due to phosphate alone, and due to phosphate plus
various amounts of chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an
example to illustrate the effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator
will need to develop unique curves for each boiler as described in the text of
Sections 4.2.2 and 3.8.12. ...............................................................................................4-22
Figure 4-15 Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(H) with AVT(O) Feedwater. All-ferrous
metallurgy in feedwater system. Operating with an oxidizing environment (no
reducing agent). ...............................................................................................................4-29
Figure 4-16 Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(H) with AVT(R) Feedwater. All-ferrous and
mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems. Operating with a reducing environment
(reducing agent added). ...................................................................................................4-30
Figure 4-17 PC(H): Boiler Water Sodium vs. Operating Pressure ...........................................4-32
Figure 4-18 PC(H): Boiler Water Phosphate vs. Operating Pressure ......................................4-33
xxv
Figure 4-19 PC(H): Boiler Water pH vs. Operating Pressure. pH due to trisodium
phosphate (5.8 to 1.4 ppm from Figure 4-18). .................................................................4-34
Figure 4-20 PC(H): Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating Pressure..........................................4-35
Figure 4-21 PC(H): Boiler Water Sulfate vs. Operating Pressure ............................................4-36
Figure 4-22 PC(H): Boiler Water Silica vs. Operating Pressure ..............................................4-37
Figure 4-23 PC(H): Drum Boiler Water Specific Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure
showing specific conductivity due to phosphate alone, and due to phosphate plus
various amounts of chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an
example to illustrate the effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator
will need to develop unique curves for each boiler as described in the text of
Sections 4.3.1 and 3.8.11. ...............................................................................................4-40
Figure 4-24 PC(H): Drum Boiler Water Cation Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure.
Showing cation conductivity due to phosphate alone and due to phosphate plus
various amounts of chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an
example to illustrate the effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator
will need to develop unique curves for each boiler as described in the text of
Sections 4.3.1 and 3.8.12. ...............................................................................................4-41
Figure 5-1 Cycle Chemistry Diagram for a Drum Unit on Caustic Treatment. All-ferrous
and mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems. Operating with a reducing environment
(reducing agent added) in the feedwater, AVT(R). ............................................................5-3
Figure 5-2 Cycle Chemistry Diagram for a Drum Unit on Caustic Treatment. All-ferrous
feedwater systems. Operating with an oxidizing environment (no reducing agent) in
the feedwater, AVT(O). ......................................................................................................5-4
Figure 5-3 Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water pH vs. Operating Pressure. The dashed line
indicates the lower limit for pH to ensure that the pH of the boiler water is at least a
minimum value to reduce the risk of boiler corrosion. ........................................................5-6
Figure 5-4 Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Cation Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure.........5-7
Figure 5-5 Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Specific Conductivity vs. Operating
Pressure. The dashed line indicates the lower limit for specific conductivity
corresponding to the minimum pH and NaOH concentration shown in Figures 5-3
and 5-6. ..............................................................................................................................5-8
Figure 5-6 Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Sodium Hydroxide vs. Operating Pressure.
The dashed line indicates the lower limit for NaOH in the boiler water. .............................5-9
Figure 5-7 Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Sodium vs. Operating Pressure..........................5-10
Figure 5-8 Caustic Treatment: HRSG Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating Pressure .............5-11
Figure 5-9 Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Sulfate vs. Operating Pressure ..........................5-12
Figure 5-10 Caustic Treatment: Drum Boiler Water Silica vs. Operating Pressure .................5-13
Figure 5-11 Relationship Between Specific Cation Conductivity, Cation Conductivity and
pH at 25C for Boiler Water with Caustic Treatment ........................................................5-16
Figure 5-12 Caustic Treatment: Drum Boiler Water Relationship Between pH and
Equivalent Sodium Hydroxide Concentration at 25C, Showing Effect of Ammonia
Concentrations. The lowest curve is at zero ammonia. The highest curve is at 2
ppm ammonia. .................................................................................................................5-17
Figure 5-13 Road Map for Conversion of Plants to Caustic Treatment ...................................5-22
xxvi
Figure A-5 A Storage Tank Nitrogen System and Sparging Elements ................................. A-9
Figure B-1 Calculated current-voltage curves for the hydrogen electrode reaction (HER),
the oxygen electrode reaction (OER) and the total polarization curve (sum of those
for the HER and OER) for a system containing 10 ppb H2 + 5 ppb O2 at 25 C. Note
that the ORP must lie between the equilibrium potentials for the HER and the OER. ...... B-7
e
Figure B-2 Calculated equilibrium potentials for the Hydrogen Electrode Reaction (E her)
e
and the Oxygen Electrode Reaction (E oer) and the calculated redox potential (ORP)
o
for the system 10 ppb H2 + X ppb O2 at 25 C. Note that, generally, the ORP
approaches the equilibrium potential for the HER at very low oxygen levels, but
does not approach the equilibrium potential for the OER at very high oxygen levels. .... B-10
Figure B-3 Plot of calculated redox potential versus molar ratio of O2:H2 for hydrogen
concentrations of 2, 5, 10, and 20 ppb H2. The arrow indicates a redox neutral
system having a molar ratio of 0.5 .................................................................................. B-18
Figure C-1 Multisensor Probe (courtesy of Intek, Inc) ............................................................ C-3
Figure C-2 Multisensor Probe Instrument Schematic .............................................................. C-4
Figure C-3 Flow Schematic for SF6 Analyzer System ............................................................. C-7
Figure C-4 Schematic Diagram of SF6 Sampling System ....................................................... C-8
Figure E-1 Head Cup for Constant Sample Flow (pressure in psi at discharge equals
the head, H inches of water, divided by 27.6) ................................................................... E-9
(2)
Figure E-2 Sampling System Configuration Used During RP2712-3 Project ...................... E-12
Figure E-3 Normal Distribution Curve for Random Data........................................................ E-23
Figure E-4 The Relationship Between True Value, Measured Value, and Bias. The bias
in the example shown is negative, but a positive bias is also possible. .......................... E-24
Figure E-5 Random and Systematic Errors ........................................................................... E-26
Figure E-6 Laboratory Quality Control Charts........................................................................ E-31
Figure E-7 Cation Conductivity Control Chart, RR%, CC = 0.5 S/cm .................................. E-32
Figure E-8 Cation Conductivity Control Chart, RSD%, CC = 0.5 S/cm................................ E-32
Figure F-1 Copper Concentration at Virginia Powers Chesterfield Unit 6 Before and
(3)
After a Filter .....................................................................................................................F-7
Figure F-2 Boiler Water Copper Concentration/Drum Boiler Pressure Control Curves
(7)
Developed at Miami Fort Station ....................................................................................F-11
Figure F-3 Drum Boiler Water Copper vs. Operating Pressure ..............................................F-12
Figure F-4 Road Map to Develop Shutdown and Layup Guidelines Common to Most
Units .................................................................................................................................F-14
xxvii
Figure G-1 Concentrations of the Aqueous Ammonium Cation (NH4 ) (Continuous Line)
and Aqueous Neutral Ammonia Species NH3 (Dashed Line) in Solutions of Pure
Ammonia. .......................................................................................................................... G-4
Figure G-2 Relationship Between Corrected Boiler Water pH, Measured Boiler Water
pH and Measured Ammonia Concentration, as Determined using Equation G-15.
The lines on the figure increase in 0.1 ppm ammonia increments from 0 to 2 ppm.......... G-6
xxviii
LIST OF TABLES
Table 1-1 Key Cycle Chemistry Guidelines* .............................................................................1-6
Table 1-2 EPRIs New Steam Limits........................................................................................1-10
Table 1-3 CEGB Water/Steam Circuit Guidelines for Drum Type Boilers as Currently
Amended by One Operator of Caustic Treatment (CT). (Section 5 should be
referred to for the latest understanding on pH in the feedwater to control copper
corrosion). ........................................................................................................................1-20
Table 1-4 Boiler Water Limits Used by Various Operators of CT for High Heat Flux, High
Pressure Drum Boilers (typically 16 MPa (2400 psi)).......................................................1-22
Table 2-1 Percentage of organizations experiencing chemically influenced BTF. Results
(4)
from survey of 93 organizations in 2001 (Figures in parentheses indicate survey
results from 1997). .............................................................................................................2-2
Table 2-2 Key Parameter Limits Relating to Continuum of Treatments.....................................2-4
Table 2-3 Major Unit Transport and Deposition Problem Areas for Units with All-Ferrous
and Mixed-Metallurgy Feedwater Systems ........................................................................2-6
Table 2-4 Feedwater Limits for All-Ferrous Systems. Values in parenthesis are easily
achieved by the best units..................................................................................................2-8
Table 2-5 Feedwater Limits for Mixed-Metallurgy Systems. The value in parenthesis is
easily achieved on the best units with low air in-leakage. ................................................2-15
Table 3-1 EPRI Steam Purity Limit Revisions Based on PTZ Research Findings...................3-11
Table 3-2 EPRIs Core Monitoring Parameters and/or Minimum Level of Continuous
Instruments for All Units Operating on Phosphate Continuum and Caustic
Treatments .......................................................................................................................3-29
Table 6-1 Possible Causes of Chemical Excursions .................................................................6-4
Table 6-2 Condensate System Corrective Actions .................................................................6-5
Table 6-3 Feedwater System Corrective Actions....................................................................6-6
Table 6-4 Boiler Water - Corrective Actions...............................................................................6-7
Table 6-5 Steam Circuit - Corrective Actions.............................................................................6-8
Table 6-6 Makeup System Malfunction......................................................................................6-9
Table 6-7 Makeup Regenerant - NaOH, H2SO4 or HCl Leaking into the Cycle........................6-10
Table 6-8 Condenser Tube Leak .............................................................................................6-11
Table 6-9 Condensate Polisher Malfunction/Exhausted ..........................................................6-12
Table 6-10 Condensate Polisher Caustic or Acid Regenerant Leakage...............................6-13
Table 6-11 Excessive or Insufficient Concentration of Oxygen Scavenger .............................6-14
Table 6-12 Corrosion and/or Flow-Accelerated Corrosion in the Preboiler Cycle....................6-15
xxix
xxx
1
INTRODUCTION TO EPRIS CYCLE CHEMISTRY
PROGRAM, AND TO THE PHOSPHATE CONTINUUM
AND CAUSTIC TREATMENT
Improving the recognition and understanding of the impacts on fossil plant equipment caused
by deficient chemistry practices.
Critically appraising the science of water and steam chemistry, and identifying specific data
needs and other deficiencies.
Establishing industry guidelines for cycle chemistry in all varieties of fossil plant units.
Preparing publications and other products intended to facilitate technology transfer to fossil
plants, designed to simplify application of good chemistry practices.
Over the nearly 20 years the program has been in existence, the understanding of chemistry
influenced damage and the effects of deposits on unit performance has increased substantially.
Unfortunately, there are still cases where the causes of damage and performance degradation are
not properly identified, resulting in situations where the role of chemistry goes unrecognized, or
damage and performance losses not involving chemistry are incorrectly determined to be
chemistry related.
1-1
There are also many cases where the optimum cycle chemistry has not been selected and
continually validated, or where inadequate instrumentation was responsible for allowing units to
operate with gross contamination. Deposits can also impair performance and have been
experienced in many areas of the steam-water cycle. Chemistry influenced component damage in
fossil plant units is widespread and includes the following mechanisms.
Condenser structure: flow-accelerated corrosion of steam side shell, supports, headers and
piping.
Feedwater heaters and associated piping: general corrosion and pitting, corrosion fatigue,
flow-accelerated corrosion, stress corrosion cracking, and deposits.
Boiler tubes: hydrogen damage, acid phosphate corrosion, caustic gouging, corrosion fatigue,
pitting, and deposit induced overheating.
Superheaters and reheaters: pitting corrosion, stress corrosion cracking and corrosion fatigue.
Turbines: corrosion fatigue, erosion and corrosion, stress corrosion cracking, crevice
corrosion, pitting, and deposits (reducing efficiency and capacity).
It should be noted that some of these damage mechanisms were unknown at the inception of the
program. Others were not readily distinguished from superficially similar damage mechanisms,
including some that are not influenced by chemistry. In other cases, the extent of components
that were vulnerable to the damage mechanism was not fully appreciated. Today, there is a very
good understanding of damage mechanisms, including the influence of chemistry on many of
them. Permanent solutions, based on identification of the responsible root cause and initiation of
action to kill the mechanism are generally available. Deficient chemistry is either a root cause
or significant influencing factor in all chemistry influenced damage mechanisms.
(1)
Initial interim chemistry guidelines were issued in 1986. Subsequent research findings, field
experience with the interim guidelines, and worldwide cycle chemistry practices justified updates
and revision activities. As a result, individual guidelines for phosphate, all-volatile, and
oxygenated treatments were issued in the 1990s.(2-4) Additionally, a document describing
(5)
favorable international experience with caustic treatment of drum boilers was published.
This report represents the second in a series of third generation EPRI cycle chemistry
guidelines for fossil plants which will be published between 2002 and 2004. The first of these
revisions was for all-volatile treatment.(6)
1-2
This guideline introduced a couple of very important new concepts into the world of fossil plant
cycle chemistry:
Decoupling of the steam and boiler limits, while providing unique protection for the steam
turbine and the boiler.
Clear distinction between AVT(O) and AVT(R) for oxidizing and reducing conditions for
all-ferrous and mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems respectively, and
Use of ORP as a core parameter for controlling feedwater chemistry with mixed-metallurgy
feedwater systems operating on AVT(R).
This second guideline is for the solid alkali phosphate and caustic treatments. As such it
introduces the concept of Phosphate Continuum (PC), which replaces the two treatments (EPT
(2)
and PT) in the previous phosphate guideline. In 2004, the OT Guideline will be revised.
1.1.1 Program Goals and Objectives
The overall objectives of the program are to provide guidelines, technology and training
materials, which together will assist in avoiding the major damage and failure mechanisms in
fossil plants. By implementation of improved water chemistry, the following goals, which have
been set for the EPRI program, are attainable by virtually all fossil plant units:
minimize iron and copper transport (each to less than 2 ppb in the feedwater)
1-3
training of staff
There are already a number of world class utility organizations that enjoy the benefits of
operating without chemistry-related boiler and turbine failures, with minimal rates of corrosion
product transport, requiring few (if any) chemical cleanings, etc. Many others are working with
EPRI to improve their chemistry programs and making measurable progress, with commensurate
changes in unit availability and performance.
1.1.2 Program Philosophy
The overall philosophy of EPRIs Cycle Chemistry Program for Fossil Plants is shown in Figure
1-1. Various projects, including state-of-knowledge assessments, technology appraisals, research
and development programs, and relevant non-technical investigations are performed to improve
the overall understanding of the science of water treatment technology and how to optimally
apply it to working fossil plant units.
1-4
Figure 1-1
Overall Philosophy of EPRIs Cycle Chemistry Program. CCIP is Cycle Chemistry
Improvement Program, BTFR is Boiler Tube Failure Reduction, FAC is Flow-accelerated
Corrosion, and CP is Condensate Polishing.
The results of these projects serve as critical input to development and products for use by plant
personnel. As indicated in bold in the figure, the main products consist of cycle chemistry
guidelines, a cycle chemistry advisor (ChemExpert), and various training programs that ensure
proper technology transfer to plant staff for optimal understanding and application. By following
this approach, it has been possible to continually refine the understanding of the underlying
science while also making appropriate changes in the products utilized by plant personnel.
1.1.3 Key Cycle Chemistry Guidelines
In all, there are 10 essential cycle chemistry guideline documents that should be available for use
by all utility personnel responsible for fossil plant cycle chemistry. Included are two operating
guidelines(4,6) as well as this current document for PC and CT, four selection, process and
(7-10)
(11-13)
Table 1-1 indicates the subject
transient guidelines, and three cycle support guidelines.
matter of these guideline publications, the year of publication, and the year in which publication
of revised and updated guidelines is planned.
1-5
Year Published
Planned Updates
Operating Guidelines
All-Volatile Treatment (AVT)
2002
1994
2003
2004
1994
Flow-Accelerated Corrosion
1997
2004
Cycling/Startup/Shutdown/Layup
1998
2004/2005
2000
1999
2001
Condensate Polishing
1996
2005
As shown in Figure 1-1, the chemistry guideline documents are integral to the content of the
training programs and other tools developed for operations, maintenance, technical, and
management personnel. The updated guidelines are the initial conduit through which the findings
of research and development efforts are transferred to the plants. However, the important new
concepts introduced in the guidelines are subsequently integrated into training program materials
and future versions of the expert system code (ChemExpert).
1.1.4 Program Vision and Future Plans
Utilities desiring optimum benefits from these and future cycle chemistry guidelines publications
will derive the best results as follows:
1-6
Perform initial benchmarking assessments of existing cycle chemistry and boiler tube failure
reduction programs to establish worldwide rankings for each unit and to identify areas of
deficiency. (EPRIs approach to Cycle Chemistry Benchmarking is included as Appendix D.)
Organizations desiring optimized chemistry should arrange for Boiler Tube Failure
Reduction/Cycle Chemistry Improvement Program (BTFR/CCIP) training to familiarize staff
with: a) the controllable aspects of the key cycle chemistry program guidelines, b) the
importance of formalized, management supported, BTFR/CCIP Programs, and c) the
importance of establishing customized chemistry treatment programs based on the
guidelines. Use of a Corporate Mandate document provides the needed support from
management.
Feedback obtained from utility personnel working with these products is an important means by
which EPRIs Cycle Chemistry Program is continually upgraded.
Chemical environment and liquid films in the Phase Transition Zone (PTZ) region of the low
pressure steam turbine
The influence of research in these areas on the development of guidelines follows in subsequent
sections. Sections 2 and 3 provide further details on how the research findings influence
selection of treatments and the rationale for these new PC and CT chemistry guidelines.
1-7
1.2.1 Chemical Environment and Liquid Films in the Phase Transition Zone (PTZ)
The risk of chemistry related turbine damage is greatest within the phase transition zone (PTZ),
where corrosion of low pressure (LP) blades and disks results in substantial availability losses
with commensurate cost impacts on the affected fossil generating units. EPRI has sponsored a
series of research projects intended to understand the environment in the PTZ in detail, to
improve the understanding of the corrosion damage processes in the PTZ and the effects of the
(14-18)
chemistry on these processes.
As a result of 10 years of research and international collaborative work with 23 organizations,
Figure 1-2 schematically shows the important processes that take place in the PTZ. The
impurities, oxides and ions in the superheated steam act as centers for the heterogeneous
nucleation of the first drops of moisture sometimes called the first or early condensate.
These drops concentrate the impurities (for chloride and sulfate up to 200 times) and are now
known to be electrically charged. However, it is very important to note that there is no oxygen
within these droplets, even for units operating on oxygenated treatment (up to 400 ppb oxygen).
The droplets can impinge on the turbine surfaces (blades and disks) and give rise to liquid films
on the surfaces. The properties of these liquid films have been extensively studied in EPRI
research.(17-19) The concentration of impurities in the liquid film is at least ten times higher than in
the droplets and the pH can drop down to below 7. These liquid films are important because they
provide the dynamic environment for the PTZ corrosion mechanisms. It has also been shown that
the liquid films have a potential and a high conductivity. As the liquid films flow off the blade
surfaces they generate relatively large droplets compared with the early condensate droplets.
Both are charged as they flow into the exhaust hood at an approximate moisture level of around
8%.
Processes in PTZ
Charged
Condensate
Steam and
Impurities,
Oxides,
Ions
Volatility
and
Partitioning
Nucleation
of
Moisture
Deposits
Charged
Liquid
Films
E
x
h
a
u
s
t
Figure 1-2
Schematic of the Processes in PTZ. The extra arrows pointing in to the Deposits indicate
that deposition can occur by other methods.
1-8
The EPRI research has also determined that the unit cycle chemistry has a major effect on the
properties of the liquid films. Parallel work has also addressed deposition of salts, oxides and
impurities onto the PTZ surfaces.
Some of the main conclusions from this large body of research, which directly influences the
development of the revised EPRI AVT Guidelines include:
It appears that less deposition and thus more reliable operation in the steam turbine PTZ will
be accomplished by reducing the current steam limits for Na, Cl, and SO4 to below 2 ppb,
although there is significant transport and deposition of steam impurities in units with
concentrations of sodium and chloride in steam of less than 0.1 ppb.
The concentration of impurities by drying of liquid films and moisture droplets on surfaces,
where the surface temperature is above the steam saturation temperature can be significant.
Liquid films have been detected on blade surfaces above the saturation line.
Pitting can be initiated in relatively pure steam on typical turbine materials in cycling units
that do not apply any shutdown protection to the turbine.
The cycle chemistry plays a major influence on the chemical composition of the early
condensate and of the liquid film on blades.
Low volatility salts, volatile and film-forming amines in steam affect the condensation
process, particularly at lower steam expansion rates such as those in turbines.
The relation of these conclusions to cycle chemistry treatment and steam purity is clear, and
these third generation chemistry guidelines have included these results in deriving some of the
revised limits.
1.2.2 Corrosion Processes in the PTZ of Steam Turbines
These extensive new findings on the environment and liquid films in the PTZ have led to a new
model of how corrosion processes (corrosion fatigue (CF) and stress corrosion cracking (SCC))
take place. Figure 1-3 shows the model. When the turbine is operating, the chemical environment
in susceptible locations in the PTZ consists of dynamic liquid films and deposition of salts,
oxides and impurities. There is no oxygen in the liquid films. However, when the turbine shuts
down, most organizations do not provide any protective environment, and so the deposits
become moist once the surfaces cool down, and cause passivity breakdown and pits to form.
Repetition of the operating/shutdown environments eventually leads to microcracks. Only when
the turbine is operating is the loading (cyclic or steady state) sufficient to drive the microcracks
into corrosion fatigue or stress corrosion cracks. Only when the unit is operating are liquid films
present, which provide the environment for the cracks to propagate. Thus the main ramifications
for the development of these new guidelines are the importance of higher purity steam (reduction
of the limits for sodium, chloride and sulfate) and of protecting the turbine during shutdown.
1-9
Loading
Chemistry
Ultimately, research results in this area will allow development of a computer model of the LP
turbine that can be used to appraise the potential for corrosion fatigue and stress corrosion
cracking. This model will include predictive capabilities to assess the time to failure once
precursor conditions (pits, crevices and microcracks) are determined to be present. The improved
model will eventually be integrated into other EPRI software such as BLADE and ChemExpert.
Turbine
Operation
Shutdown
Deposits and
Liquid Films
(No O2)
Deposits,
Oxygen and
Moisture
Pitting
Crevices
Pitting
Microcracks
Cyclic
CF
Steady State
SCC
No
Loading
Figure 1-3
Model for the Development of Corrosion Processes in the PTZ of Steam Turbines
AVT
PC(L)
CT
PC(H)
0.15
0.2
0.2
0.2
0.3
1-10
Impurities may carry over as neutral salts, as 1:1 ionic compounds or as 1:2 ionic
compounds. Neutral, 1:1 and 1:2 compounds cannot be compared directly and separate
diagrams for each of these groups are shown in Section 3.
Chloride exhibits relatively high volatility as hydrochloric acid (HCl), minor volatility as
ammonium chloride (NH4Cl), and only minimal volatility as sodium chloride (NaCl).
Sodium hydroxide (NaOH) has a volatility comparable to that of NaCl and introduction of
these species to the steam path from the boiler is strongly dependent on mechanical carryover
rather than volatile carryover.
Under oxidizing conditions, volatile transport of sulfur species to the steam occurs mainly as
sulfuric acid (H2SO4), however, under reducing conditions, volatile carryover of sulfur
dioxide, (SO2), a neutral compound, can introduce sulfur to the steam. Also, carryover of
ammonium sulfate (NH4HSO4) will be present in steam at high pH under AVT chemistry
conditions.
Phosphoric acid (H3PO4) is considered a neutral compound as it does not ionize appreciably
at boiler operating temperatures, yet volatile carryover was determined to be quite low.
Transport of phosphates to the steam is essentially the result of mechanical carryover.
Trisodium phosphate (Na3PO4), is, for practical purposes, non-volatile.
Organic acids such as formic acid (HCOOH) and acetic acid (CH3COOH) are neutral
compounds under fossil plant operating conditions and are very volatile, however, any
organic salts in steam would exhibit lower volatility and could lead to a reduction of liquid
film pH.
Volatile carryover of copper from boiler water to the steam occurs mainly as cupric
hydroxide (Cu(OH)2) and cuprous hydroxide (CuOH); both species exhibit very high
volatility across the whole range of temperatures and pressures experienced in a fossil plant
from startup to full operation.
Silica volatilization characteristics are quite consistent with the findings of other researchers.
Carryover predictions for operating fossil plant units with drum boilers require use of a
thermodynamic model to make an appraisal of the boiler water components as a system; a
model has been developed that allows prediction of saturated steam chemistry and the
chemistry of the early condensate. Component volatility is pH dependent and mechanical
carryover rate has a significant impact on steam purity.
1-11
Figure 1-4
Partitioning Constants for Common Salts, Oxides and Acids. KD is the partitioning
constant.
This model was used in developing the AVT Guidelines(6) to validate the derivation of boiler
water limits. It is used in a similar way in this PC and CT Guideline as discussed in Section 3.
The final version of the code will be incorporated within the EPRI ChemExpert software. It is
envisioned that doing so will allow utilities to customize their boiler water limits and action
levels for individual drum boiler units and to predict changes in steam purity and early
condensate chemistry with variations in the boiler water chemistry.
1-12
Figure 1-5
pH Dependence of the Cu Release Rates at 95C (203F) for Al-Brass, 90Cu-10Ni and
Admiralty Brass After Treatment in Non-Degassed Feedwater at ORP +100 mV and 300
mV*
* OX = Oxidizing, RED = Reducing
1-13
1-14
Figure 1-6
Schematic of Operating Ranges of Boiler Water on Equilibrium Phosphate Treatment
(EPT), Congruent Phosphate Treatment (CPT) and Phosphate Treatment (PT). It should be
noted that these are the old phosphate operating ranges, and are shown here for reference
only. They shouldnt be applied to fossil plants.
In the early 1990s, EPRI introduced a new guideline for phosphate treatment(2). These 1994
Guidelines introduced equilibrium phosphate treatment (EPT) and phosphate treatment (PT) after
much EPRI and independent research into corrosion mechanisms (acid phosphate corrosion,
APC), and after good operating experiences in Russia, Germany and on Great Lakes cooling
waters. The ranges are shown in Figure 1-6, and although the Guidelines suggested that only
trisodium phosphate and NaOH should be used, Figure 1-6 shows the lower bound of the
EPT/PT regions at Na:PO4 molar ratio of 2.8. This was based on research conducted by
Tremaine, which showed that maricite (the corrosion product of APC) would not form above
higher molar ratios than 2.8 at boiler operating temperatures of 360C (680F)(33).
This guideline brought enormous success to the world of phosphate treatments in conventional
fossil plants. It is not possible to form maricite (NaFePO4) with only trisodium phosphate
additions. A more recent international survey in 2003 found that as an increasing number of
operators had moved to EPT and PT, only about 40% of boilers now experience hideout and that
less than 20% have evidence of acid phosphate corrosion.
1-15
Despite the two phosphate treatments, EPT and PT, successfully addressing acid phosphate
corrosion, there have been an increasing number of operational uncertainties and some other
corrosion problems:
The improper use of low level phosphate treatments (such as EPT) have been associated with
an increase of hydrogen damage failures in both conventional plants and HRSGs(34). There
have been over 30 fully documented cases. This results from the wrong choice of boiler
water control curves for chloride, which allow too high a level of chloride in the boiler water.
Hydrogen damage has been increasing over the last 10 years. Basically operators did not
make a clear distinction between the extremes of EPT and PT in their ability to neutralize
contaminant.
The name of EPT also caused lots of confusion because there isnt really any equilibrium,
and although EPRI published a road-map to derive the equilibrium level (minimum level
that a boiler can maintain without hideout), very few organizations used this procedure. But
many high pressure boilers continue to operate at about 0.2 ppm of phosphate or lower.
Most operators were not clear about the distinct differences between EPT and PT and thus
exactly where to operate. Figure 1-6 shows an artificial boundary between the two treatments
at about 2.4 ppm phosphate.
Most operators did not measure and/or know the percentage of mechanical carryover on their
drum units.
Many operators did not take into account the ammonia levels when operating at low
phosphate levels or alternatively made the wrong connection. Similarly operators did not
account for sodium associated with contaminant anions when these were present.
In summary, the 1994 Guidelines were very successful in addressing the main corrosion concern
of acid phosphate corrosion, but the application of the guideline was often unsuccessful in
addressing control and overall boiler corrosion protection (hydrogen damage).
These concerns have led to the need for a new control technology and operating philosophy for
phosphate treatments, which could not simply be addressed by changing a few things in the
EPT/PT envelope. The new guidelines now encompass a Phosphate Continuum (PC). The
operating ranges are shown in normal and log plots in Figure 1-7.
1-16
(a)
(b)
Figure 1-7
Schematic of Operating Range for PC. a) is normal scale, b) is log scale.
1-17
The new PC treatment keeps the overriding criteria that drove the 1994 Guidelines, but also adds
new features to address the concerns delineated above. This combination leads to a treatment
which:
Has a wide range from low phosphate to around 10 ppm to assist in controlling hideout
Requires only the addition of TSP and NaOH to ensure that acid phosphate corrosion will not
occur and is thus encompassed by Na:PO4 = 3 and TSP + 1 ppm NaOH
Covers the possibility of contaminant control at the low phosphate end by having a minimum
of 0.2 ppm phosphate. This will prevent operations using < 0.2 ppm where there is
essentially no protection from contamination.
Covers the high phosphate end for low pressure boilers and in cases where contaminants are
likely/probable. (See Section 2.3 on selection and optimization of boiler water treatments.)
Phosphate continuum is a much better terminology as phosphate treatments are indeed a true
continuum of treatments, as follows:
Provides boiler protection from very low pressures (e.g. LP HRSG evaporator circuits at
60/70 psi) to very high conventional plants operating at drum pressures above 2600 psi (18
MPa) and to HP HRSG evaporator circuits.
Is a continuum of phosphate treatments from 0.2 ppm to 10 ppm, with the minimum being to
prevent excessively low phosphates being used which provide little resistance to contaminant
ingress.
Extends from the low phosphate levels (< 3 ppm) where the pH is moderated by ammonia, to
the high phosphate levels, where ammonia has a smaller effect.
The higher phosphate levels have a much greater ability to counteract contaminant ingress.
The opposite ends of the PC have much different abilities to partition sodium into steam
(Section 3).
Although PC is a continuum as described above, it also has to be recognized that there are two
extremes of low (L) and high (H) phosphate levels. In Section 4 these two regimes have been
called PC(L) and PC(H) with a very loose demarcation between the L and H variants at around 3
ppm phosphate. However, this demarcation is not marked on the PC schematic (Figure 1-7) to
prevent organizations polarizing between the two treatments in the way that was done for EPT
and PT. The emphasis must be on recognizing that there are these two extremes (and
intermediate conditions) and they will behave differently as indicated by the last set of bullets
above. This very important point is discussed again extensively in the Rationale (Section 3) and
in the Guidelines (Section 4).
1-18
In summary, the 1994 EPRI Phosphate Guidelines made a tremendous contribution to the
industry. However, clearly operators/chemists have experienced numerous problems in
developing reliable operating ranges, and there were some serious corrosion problems as
discussed in the next Section. Thus the time has come to make the previous phosphate treatments
obsolescent. The introduction of PC has done that. It keeps the best features of the old, but also
addresses the deficiencies of the old.
1.3.2 Introduction to Caustic Treatment and Operating Experiences Leading to
New CT Guideline
Caustic treatment has been used successfully for many years in coal and oil fired drum units as
an alternative to phosphate treatment, particularly where difficulties with phosphate hideout, and
monitoring and control have been experienced. In a survey conducted in the early 1990s for
(5)
EPRI , at least 50,000 MWe of plant was being successfully operated with caustic treatment
(CT), mostly in the United Kingdom, Ireland, Hong Kong and South Africa. The EPRI survey
included details of operating experience, including problems and how they were overcome.
Guidance on conditioning using sodium hydroxide was developed into an EPRI interim
(5)
guidelines . The EPRI Interim Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Combined Cycle Heat Recovery
(35)
Steam Generators published in 1998 included caustic treatment as a method of conditioning
the boiler water for drum type units. More recently, caustic treatment has started to be used on
conventional fossil fired drum units in the USA.
High concentrations of sodium hydroxide and sodium phosphate were used in many countries in
the 1950s for conditioning the boilers of low pressure plant. However, when these methods of
conditioning were applied to new high pressure plant in the 1960s, there were frequent failures
due to on-load corrosion in the form of caustic gouging or hydrogen damage due to acid attack.
There was a great deal of confusion at the time, which led to the use of sodium hydroxide being
abandoned in the USA in favor of AVT and various forms of phosphate treatment. While the use
of high or uncontrolled concentrations of sodium hydroxide can certainly cause caustic
gouging, it is now known that many examples of what were thought to be caustic gouging, were
in fact acid phosphate corrosion, due to phosphate hideout and dosing acidic forms of sodium
phosphate. In other countries, particularly the UK, the use of sodium hydroxide was pursued and
refined, so that the problems experienced with phosphate treatment, particularly those associated
with hideout, could be avoided.
The addition of low concentrations of sodium hydroxide to the boiler water used in caustic
treatment significantly increases the amount of chloride that can be tolerated without corrosion,
compared with AVT. This is important when dealing with condenser leaks, particularly when
cooling is with brackish or sea water. It is still important to limit chloride ingress with CT and
ensure that there is sufficient sodium hydroxide present to prevent potentially acidic conditions,
while at the same time limiting the amount present, to prevent caustic gouging in the boiler and
excessive carryover into the steam, resulting in damage to the turbine.
1-19
The former Central Electricity Generating Board (CEGB) in England developed guidelines for
feedwater, boiler water and steam for once-through and drum type boilers over a period of
several decades. The limits for feedwater were the same regardless of operating pressure, but
those for boiler water and steam reduced as the pressure increased. AVT was recommended
where high purity boiler water could be maintained and CT was recommended when this was not
the case, for example when there were condenser leaks. CT was also recommended when the
condensers were cooled with sea water, since in the event of condenser leaks, the sodium
hydroxide would help to prevent acidic conditions forming in the boiler water.
Like the phosphate treatments, the pH of the boiler water needs to be maintained at a sufficiently
high value with CT to minimize the risk of corrosion in the boiler. To avoid excessively high
concentration of sodium hydroxide, the concentration can be linked to the chloride concentration,
this being the most corrosive contaminant present. A semi-empirical relationship was introduced
in the 1970s, namely NaOH = 2.5 x chloride. Initially, this was based on laboratory tests and
practical operating experience, but was later substantiated by pilot plant tests. A certain
minimum amount of sodium hydroxide is required to achieve the required pH. In the CEGB
Guidelines, the minimum amount of NaOH and the permitted chloride concentrations reduce
with increasing pressure.
The CEGB Guidelines worked well for low heat flux coal fired plants, but examples of caustic
gouging occurred in high heat flux zones of oil fired boilers and it became necessary to reduce
(36)
the limits for NaOH and chloride in these plants. The 1985 CEGB Guidelines are still used as
the basis for chemical operation by all large operators in the UK, albeit with some reductions to
the limits. The CEGB Guidelines for CT, as currently amended by one operator, are given in
Table 1-3.
Table 1-3
CEGB Water/Steam Circuit Guidelines for Drum Type Boilers as Currently Amended by
One Operator of Caustic Treatment (CT). (Section 5 should be referred to for the latest
understanding on pH in the feedwater to control copper corrosion).
Fuel
Pressure (MPa) [psi]
Coal
Coal
Coal
Oil
6 [900]
10 [1500]
16 [2400]
16 [2400]
Feedwater
Ammonia (ppb)
pH at 25C
Boiler Water
Chloride (ppm)
Equivalent NaOH
Minimum NaOH (ppm)
Silica (ppm)
Steam
Sodium (ppb)
Silica (ppb)
1-20
3.5
2.5 Cl
5
5
2.5
2.5 Cl
5
1.5
1.2
2.5 Cl
2
0.2
0.3
2.5 Cl
0.5
0.2
20
20
10
20
2
20
2
20
CT is used in countries other than the UK, including Germany, Ireland, Hong Kong and South
Africa. Early examples of guidelines and operating experience were included in the EPRI(5)
report. Recent examples of CT operation are given below.
The Guidelines used by Scottish Power(37) for their 16 MPa (2400 psi) plants are similar to the
CEGB Guidelines(36). They have condensate polishing and readily achieve the much lower limits
set for high heat flux oil fired plant, despite being a coal fired plant. Oil and gas fired 16 MPa
(2400 psi) plants operated by Scottish and Southern(38) also, basically, use the CEGB Guidelines.
(39)
In England, PowerGen use the CEGB Guidelines, suitably modified to include the use of lower
NaOH and chloride limits for intermediate pressure oil fired plants, with lower limits for sodium
(40)
in steam for all intermediate and high pressure plants. Innogy (formerly National Power) also
use guidelines based on the CEGB Guidelines, adopting the lower limits given for high heat flux
plants for all their plants, where possible. Although it is accepted that lower limits for boiler
water recommended for high heat flux boilers and the lower limits for sodium in steam are
desirable for all plants, it is also accepted that this is not always possible, and less restrictive
limits may have to be adopted in some cases.
The limit for chloride in the boiler water adopted by the operators in England and Scotland is
(41)
typically 0.3 ppm chloride for 16 MPa (2400 psi) high heat flux plants. In Ireland , South
(42)
(43)
Africa and Hong Kong the limits adopted for chloride are about half this value, because this
(44)
is readily achieved, as most plants have condensate polishing. The Coronado plant in the USA
(3)
typically operates with chloride concentrations similar to the old EPRI AVT limits , but is
allowed to operate up to 0.2 ppm chloride, before operating pressure is reduced.
The main boiler water limits used by various operators of CT are given in Table 1-4.
1-21
Year
Chloride
(ppm Cl)
CEGB
1985
0.3
1988/85
VGB
Cation
Conductivity
(S/cm)
Sodium
Hydroxide
(ppm NaOH)
0.50.75
50+
0.8
ESB (Moneypoint)
1992
0.12
1.5
0.8 max
ESKOM
1993
0.15
0.872.6
EPRI (proposed)(5)
1995
0.4
1.01.5
EPRI (HRSG)(35)
1998
0.35
6.5
0.91.6
PowerGen
Current
0.3
Innogy
Current
0.3 (target)
Scottish Power
Current
(0.33* equiv)
Current
(0.37* equiv)
4.5
0.5 or 2.5Cl
ESB (Moneypoint)
Current
0.12
1.5
0.8 max
ESKOM
Current
0.15
1.5
1.12.0
Current
0.2
3.0
1.82.2
Coronado
Current
0.2
Note:
0.500.75
0.20.8
Section 3 of the guidelines presents and discusses the new rationale used to develop these
guidelines to establish appropriate target values and action levels. This section is most important
(a must read) as it will be noted that the approach to be followed is completely new and
different from previous EPRI guidelines, and differs with the system metallurgy. In Section 3,
there are many figures, which have been included to illustrate how the guidelines normal and
action levels have been derived in Sections 4 and 5. It is very important to note that none of these
figures should be used to control the chemistry of fossil plants. The Section 3 presentation also
defines the preferred sample points, chemical feed points and required on-line instrumentation
for all situations to which PC or CT is the desired cycle chemistry.
1-22
Sections 4 and 5 cover the revised PC and CT guidelines for drum boiler units, respectively. As
in prior guidelines, cycle diagrams are used to summarize the sample collection and chemical
addition point, the basic (generic and uncustomized) chemistry target values and action levels,
and the monitoring requirements. As explained in each of these sections, the instrumentation
requirements now differ depending on whether an oxidizing or reducing feedwater chemistry is
employed (AVT(O) or (AVT(R)). Guidance is given on how the guidelines should be used to
establish unit-specific target values and action levels. Also presented are discussions of best
practices for unit shutdown, layup, startup and cycling service as well as makeup water
requirements and the role of chemical cleaning in optimized PC and CT programs.
Section 6 addresses other aspects of optimized chemistry control programs. Primary attention is
focused on prompt identification of chemistry excursions by plant personnel, accurate analysis of
the cause or causes of the deviations from normal chemistry limits, and provision of corrective
actions consistent with this analysis. In addition, this section considers the purity of treatment
chemicals to be applied to units operated on PC or CT.
Sections 1-6 are followed by eight appendices, providing further details on important topics
related to PC or CT usage. Appendix A describes ways to remove dissolved oxygen from treated
makeup water, which is very beneficial when filling units for startup. Techniques for monitoring
feedwater ORP are presented in Appendix B. Condenser air in-leakage monitoring and control,
necessary to ensure attainment of target values for dissolved oxygen in condensate, are presented
in Appendix C. Appendix D provides information on the EPRI approach to cycle chemistry
benchmarking. The importance of proper sampling and analysis practices as they relate to
chemistry program management is reviewed in Appendix E. The contributions of staff training to
the overall success of the program are also covered. Appendix F covers unit shutdown, layup,
startup, cycling and peaking. Appendix G covers the calculation of the corrected pH in the boiler
water to take account of the presence of ammonia.
As indicated in Table 1-1, there are 10 key cycle chemistry guideline documents that all
personnel within the organizations supporting the EPRI Cycle Chemistry Program should have.
However, these publications represent only a small part of the products created since program
inception in 1984. Appendix H provides a listing of all currently available guidelines, technical
reports, and conference proceedings.
1-23
1.5 REFERENCES
1. Interim Consensus Guidelines on Fossil Plant Water Chemistry, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: June
1986. CS-4629.
2. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Phosphate Treatment for Drum Units, EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: December 1994. TR-103665.
3. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All Volatile Treatment, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
April 1996. TR-105041.
4. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Oxygenated Treatment, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
December 1994. TR-102285.
5. Sodium Hydroxide for Conditioning the Boiler Water of Drum-Type Boilers, EPRI, Palo
Alto, CA: January 1995. TR-104007.
6. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All-Volatile Treatment, EPRI, Palo Also, CA:
November 2002. 1004187.
7. Selection and Optimization of Boiler Water and Feedwater Treatments for Fossil Plants,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: March 1997. TR-105040.
8. Guidelines for Controlling Flow-Accelerated Corrosion in Fossil Plants, EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: November 1997. TR-108859.
9. Cycling, Startup, Shutdown and Lay-up Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for
Operators and Chemists, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: August 1998. TR-107754.
10. Guidelines for Copper in Fossil Plants, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 2000. 1000457.
11. Revised Guidelines for Makeup Water Treatment, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: October 1999.
TR-113692.
12. Guidelines for Chemical Cleaning of Conventional Fossil Plant Equipment, EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: November 2001. 1003994.
13. Condensate Polishing Guidelines, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: September 1996. TR-104422.
14. Steam, Chemistry and Corrosion in the Phase Transition Zone of Steam Turbines, Volume 1:
Key Results, Summary, and Interpretation, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: February 1999.
TR-108184-V1.
15. Steam, Chemistry and Corrosion in the Phase Transition Zone of Steam Turbines, Volume 2:
Part 1: Individual Contributions of Participants, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: February 1999.
TR-108184-V2P1.
1-24
16. Steam, Chemistry and Corrosion in the Phase Transition Zone of Steam Turbines, Volume 2:
Part 2: Individual Contributions of Participants, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: February 1999.
TR-108184-V2P1.
17. Turbine Steam, Chemistry and Corrosion: Generation of Early Liquid Films in Turbines,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: September 1999. TR-113090.
18. Turbine Steam, Chemistry and Corrosion: Experimental Turbine Tests, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
September 1997. TR-108185.
19. Corrosion of Low Pressure Steam Turbine Components, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November
2000. 1000557.
20. Behavior of Ammonium Salts in Steam Cycles, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: December 1993.
TR-102377.
21. Assessment of the Ray Diagram, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: August 1996. TR-106017.
22. Volatility of Aqueous Sodium Hydroxide, Bisulfate and Sulfate, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
February 1999. TR-105801.
23. Vapor-Liquid Partitioning of Sulfuric Acid and Ammonium Sulfate, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
February 1999. TR-112359.
24. Volatility of Aqueous Acetic Acid, Formic Acid, and Sodium Acetate, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
July 2000. TR-113089.
25. Behavior of Aqueous Electrolytes in Steam Cycles: The Solubility and Volatility of Cupric
Oxide, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 2000. 1000455.
26. The Volatility of Impurities in Steam/Water Cycles, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: September 2001.
1001042.
27. State-of-Knowledge of Copper in Fossil Plant Cycles, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: September 1997.
TR-108460.
28. Corrosion of Cu-Ni-Zn Alloys in Water-Ammonia Power Plant Environments: Development
of High Temperature Potential-pH (Pourbaix) Diagrams, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November
1999. TR-113697.
29. Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 2000.
1000456.
30. Influence of Water Chemistry on Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: October 2001. 1004586.
1-25
31. Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: May 2003.
1007391.
32. Influence of Water Chemistry on Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: September 2003. 1007612.
33. P.R. Tremaine, L.G.S. Gray, B. Wiwchar, P. Taylor and J. Stodola, Phosphate Interactions
th
with Metal Oxides Under High Performance Boiler Hide-Out Conditions, 54 International
Water Conference, Pittsburgh, PA. IWC-93-35.
34. R.B. Dooley and W.P. McNaughton, Appropriate Controls for Phosphate Boiler Water
Treatments to Avoid Acid Phosphate Corrosion and Hydrogen Damage, Power Plant
Chemistry, 2001, 3(3), pp. 127-134.
35. Interim Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Combined Cycle Heat Recovery Steam Generators
(HRSGs), EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 1998. TR-110051.
36. CEGB, GOM72, Part 2, Chemical Control of the Steam Water Circuit of Drum Type Boilers,
CEGB, England, Issue 6, September 1985.
37. A. Berg, Scottish Power, Personal Communication to M. Ball, December 2002.
38. K. Frazer, Scottish Southern, Personal Communication to M. Ball, December 2002.
39. R.R. Harries, PowerGen, Personal Communication to M. Ball, November 2002.
40. G. Bignold, Innogy. Personal Communication to M. Ball, October 2002.
41. F. McCarthy, J. Bane and G. OConnor, Oxygenated Treatment in a 300MW Drum Type
th
Boiler, Proceedings: 6 International Conference on Cycle Chemistry in Fossil Plants,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: April 2001. 1001363.
42. F. Wessels, T. Shabalala and R. Cramer, ESKOM, Personal Communication to B. Dooley,
October 2002.
43. H. Cheng, CLP Power Hong Kong Ltd., Personal Communication to B. Dooley, October
2002.
44. T.W. Robertson, Salt River Project, Personal Communication to B. Dooley, October 2002.
1-26
2
SELECTION AND OPTIMIZATION OF FEEDWATER AND
BOILER WATER
for all-ferrous feedwater systems, conversion from a reducing AVT environment (using
reducing agents) to either an oxidizing AVT environment (without reducing agents) or OT.
However, on changing from CPT to EPT, there also needs to be a change of boiler water control
limits, especially for chloride. For example for a 2500 psi (17.2 MPa) boiler, the chloride limit
with EPT was very different to that for PT. Thus it is not surprising that there has been a drastic
increase around the world in hydrogen damage tube failures in EPT units if the boiler water
limits had not been chosen correctly.
Overall this is part of a very disturbing trend of an increasing number of chemically influenced
failures. Table 2-1 indicates the percentage of organizations experiencing cycle chemistry
influenced BTF. Here it has to be said that not only those organizations with the poorest BTF
statistics and poorest cycle chemistry performance have experienced hydrogen damage; in some
cases it has occurred in organizations that have been previously benchmarked in the World
Class category.
Table 2-1
Percentage of organizations experiencing chemically influenced BTF. Results from survey
of 93 organizations in 2001(4) (Figures in parentheses indicate survey results from 1997).
Organizations having Chemically
Influenced BTF
81%
(61%)
Hydrogen Damage
57%
(37%)
25%
(17%)
Corrosion Fatigue
45%
(43%)
Pitting
40%
(7%)
28%
(18%)
Caustic Gouging
11%
(11%)
Since 2000, EPRI has benchmarked a large number of organizations based on five key fossil
plant cycle chemistry factors.(1) The benchmarking process is provided in Appendix D. The
process provides a ranking for a unit/plant/organization from World Class to Below
Average. World Class essentially means that a unit has no chemically influenced failures or
performance losses, has a full complement of cycle chemistry instruments (see Table 3-2) which
are alarmed for operators, has very few chemical cleans based on optimum choice of feedwater
treatment, and has minimum cycle losses (increased makeup addition) due to blowdown.
EPRI also conducts a boiler tube failure reduction program/cycle chemistry improvement
program (BTFRP/CCIP), and over the period 1999 to 2002 has provided initial training and
review to over 50 organizations worldwide. Some interim results from these two activities of
benchmarking and BTFRP/CCIP have recently been collated into an assessment of the
(1)
importance of cycle chemistry on fossil plant performance. It is clear from this assessment that
the most reliable and best performing units in the world operate on OT or AVT(O), have
condensate polishing, all-ferrous feedwater systems, do not use reducing agents, have tight
condensers, and excellent air in-leakage control. These organizations also take time to ensure
that the boiler and feedwater treatments match the equipment and the equipment capability.
2-2
It is, of course, appreciated that while all units to be built in the future should adhere to these
guiding principles to achieve performance requirements, not all currently operating units can
instantly change to this spectrum. This again emphasizes the need for continuing and continual
assessment of a units cycle chemistry, which is the main focus of this section.
There are four possible choices for drum boiler water treatment, as discussed in Section 2.3:
AVT, OT, PC, and CT. There are three possible choices for feedwater treatment, as discussed in
Section 2.2: AVT(O), AVT(R) and OT. The chosen treatments need to match the unit, unit
materials (particularly in the feedwater system), cooling water, and possible contaminant ingress.
The recent performance results mentioned above have led to a diagram, which simplifies the
process of selection, or at least acts as a first-cut analysis. EPRI calls this the Continuum of
Treatments. Figure 2-1 attempts to provide an overview of the Continuum. The width of the
wedge or funnel, in which the continuum of treatments is located, is proportional to the possible
level of contamination in the cycle, and to the ability of any of the five boiler water treatments to
neutralize or buffer any contaminants. As the point of the funnel is approached the level of
possible contaminants becomes less and the more likely the plant will have very good feedwater
control. Such a plant will have a condensate polisher and/or a very tight condenser. As the open
end of the funnel is approached, plants might have no condensate polisher, seawater or high TDS
water from a cooling lake or a cooling tower. The better the air in-leakage, the nearer to the point
will the plant be positioned. The vertical dotted line represents an arbitrary distinction between
units with all-ferrous and mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems. Clearly there is a relationship
with the boiler water treatments: OT and AVT(O) are only applicable to units with all-ferrous
feedwater systems, but AVT(R), PC, and CT are applicable to both all-ferrous and mixedmetallurgy. In fact in a number of cases around the world, a hybrid version of CT is used on
units effectively operating with OT where the operator adds a small amount of NaOH to the
boiler water.
For the Phosphate Continuum, the approximate range of operation has been inserted into Figure
2-1. As already discussed in Section 1-3, there is a need to consider both ends of the PC, and to
accomodate this, both PC(L) and PC(H) have been shown. Clearly PC(L) has much less ability
to buffer contamination, whereas PC(H) has the best ability of all the boiler water treatments.
In terms of cycle purity, moving towards the point of the funnel requires lower feedwater
contaminants. For example (Table 2-2), the continuum for cation conductivity at the economizer
inlet might be: for OT (< 0.15S/cm), for AVT(O) and AVT(R) (< 0.2 S/cm), and with CT (<
0.2 S/cm). For PC it will depend on whether the treatment is at the low end (< 3 ppm
phosphate) or at the high end (> 3 ppm phosphate). These are termed PC(L) and PC(H) with
possible cation conductivity limits of < 0.2 S/cm and < 0.3 S/cm, respectively. Table 2-2 also
provides an example for boiler water at a drum pressure of 2500 psi (17.2 MPa) with a
mechanical carryover of 0.18% of the normal control values.
2-3
Treatment
OT
AVT
Parameter
CT
PC
PC(L)
PC(H)
0.15
0.2
0.2
0.3
0.2
Cation
Conductivity
S/cm
1.5
1.5
10(1)(4)
25(1)(4)
9(4)
Cl ppb
50(3)
50(2)
150(4)
600(4)
300(4)
SO4 ppb
100(3)
100(2)
300(4)
1200(4)
600(4)
SiO2 ppb
180
180
180
180
180
Boiler Water
2500 psi
(17.2 MPa)
0.18%
Mechanical
Carryover
Notes:
1.
2.
3.
4.
In terms of performance, the best results occur using OT and AVT(O), whereas operating with
PC and CT there are operational problems such as hideout and hideout return. There clearly has
to be benefit in an organization changing the chemistry treatments and maybe the unit equipment
(adding a polisher, changing out copper feedwater heaters). This is the focus of EPRIs program
on assessing the value of cycle chemistry.(5)
The primary purpose of this section of the new Guidelines is to provide the needed advice,
guidance, and road maps for selection and optimization of boiler water and feedwater. The
process can, and should, be used each and every time a change in treatment is contemplated, and
also used for continual assessment of boiler water and feedwater.
(6)
This process, which was developed by EPRI in 1997, is even more important today because of
the deteriorating statistics of chemically influenced failures and performance losses (Table 2-1).
The 1997 document will be removed from circulation after publication of the revised OT
Guideline in 2004. Each guideline now contains a selection and optimization section (see the
next Section 2.2).
2-4
Figure 2-1
Summary of Possible Boiler Water and Feedwater Treatments for Fossil Plants as a
Function of Equipment and Equipment Capability(1). This is the Continuum of
Treatments.
2-5
Mixed-Metallurgy Systems
Flow-accelerated corrosion
Orifice fouling
Thus feedwater chemistry is critical to the overall reliability of fossil plants. Corrosion products
are generated here, flow around the cycle, deposit in various areas acting as initiating centers for
most of the major failure mechanisms, and often need removing by chemical cleaning. There are
three distinctly different feedwater treatments:
Reducing all-volatile, AVT(R), which uses ammonia and a reducing agent. Here the
oxidation-reduction potential, ORP, should be reducing and may be in the range 300 to
350mV [Ag/AgCl/sat, KCl], which is necessary to protect mixed-metallurgy feedwater
systems.
Oxidizing all-volatile, AVT(O), where the reducing agent has been eliminated. Here the ORP
will be around 0 mV but could be slightly positive or negative.
Oxygenated treatment (OT) where oxygen and ammonia are used. Here the ORP will be
around +100 to +150mV.
In each case, the ORP value is simply an indication that the ORP needs to be reducing or
oxidizing. Appendix B should be consulted to understand how the ORP is a function of many
variables.
Most operators can easily meet the feedwater requirements for cation conductivity. However, it
is clear that this is not sufficient by itself, and major efforts need to be applied to the generation
and transport of corrosion products. Less than 2 ppb of iron and/or copper is very achievable by
the best units operating on AVT(R). For units operating with AVT(O) the iron levels should be
around 1 ppb, and for units operating with OT iron levels should be around 0.5 ppb.
2-6
Figure 2-2
Schematic Representation of Oxide Formed on Ferrous Feedwater Surfaces During
Operation with Reducing AVT
2-7
Figure 2-3
Change in Oxidizing-Reducing Potential (ORP) and Feedwater Iron Levels (Fe) at the
Economizer Inlet when Hydrazine (N2H4) is Gradually Reduced on a 600MW Drum Unit with
an All-Ferrous Feedwater System(10).
The feedwater key parameters for AVT(R), AVT(O) and OT are summarized in Table 2-4.
Table 2-4
Feedwater Limits for All-Ferrous Systems. Values in parenthesis are easily achieved by
the best units.
Parameter
AVT(O)
AVT(R)
OT
pH
9.29.6
9.29.6
D 99.6
O 88.5
< 0.2
< 0.2
< 0.15
Fe (ppb) at EI
< 2 (<1)
<2
< 2 (0.5)
Cu (ppb) at EI
<2
<2
Oxygen (ppb) at EI
< 10
< 5 (< 2)
D 3050
O 30150
< 10
< 10
< 10
No
Yes
No
Not needed
300 to 350
Not needed
Reducing Agent
ORP (mV) at DAI*
Notes: EI - economizer inlet, CPD - condensate pump discharge, DAI - deaerator inlet, D - drum unit,
O - Once-through unit
* - Reference to Appendix B.
2-8
While an elevated pH is the basis of the two AVT treatments, oxygenated treatment (OT) uses
oxygenated high purity feedwater to minimize the corrosion and FAC in the feedwater systems.
Elevated pH is not a necessity with OT. The addition of oxygen is the preferred choice. The
feedwater key parameters for OT are shown in Table 2-4.
For the application of oxygenated treatment in units with once-through and drum boilers with allferrous feedwater systems, there is one indispensable prerequisite that the cation conductivity
must be less than 0.15 S/cm (at 25C).
The basis for the success of OT depends on the formation of a layer of ferric oxide hydrate
(FeOOH/ferric oxide (Fe2O3)) on the surface of the magnetite oxide layer and within the pores.
This is illustrated in Figure 2-4. In this case the FeOOH has a much lower solubility than Fe3O4
in feedwater, so the dissolution of surface oxide layers and the measurement of iron corrosion
products will be minimal. FAC should also be eliminated on feedwater surfaces that have the red
FeOOH/Fe2O3 appearance.
It should be also noted that the use of AVT(O) also produces red surface layers of FeOOH/Fe2O3
throughout the feedwater systems. However, the lower levels of oxygen, maintained by good air
in-leakage control, are usually not high enough to passivate 100% of the feedwater (particularly
the deaerator) surfaces. Thus the lowest levels of iron transport cannot be expected; typically
iron levels for optimized AVT(O) feedwater treatment will be around 1 ppb.
Figure 2-4
Schematic Representation of Oxide Formed on Iron-Based Feedwater Surfaces During
Operation with Oxidizing AVT and OT
2-9
This step involves a review of the current feedwater treatment, which is probably AVT(R) with a
reducing agent. If there are no problems such as indicated in Table 2-3 then continue to use the
current treatment. Such a review would indicate that the operating experience has been good, that
minimal chemical control problems have been experienced, that no BTF in the waterwalls
relating to waterside problems have occurred in the last five years, that no turbine deposition or
blade failure problems have occurred, and that the feedwater is operating in the optimum fashion
with minimum levels of feedwater corrosion products (less than 2 ppb at the economizer inlet).
In such cases of good experience, no changes need to be made. However, it is suggested that the
road map is reviewed as there may be considerable economic savings to be gained by converting
to AVT(O) or OT, and it should be remembered that FAC is always possible with reducing
feedwater chemistry.
Step 2Monitoring Baseline on Current Feedwater Treatment
This step involves a complete base-line monitoring to quantify the current chemical parameters
and, in Step 3, to determine whether continued use of a reducing agent and AVT(R) or a change
to AVT(O) should be contemplated.
This program would utilize the installed chemistry monitoring system, supplemented by
monitoring those parameters in the cycle chemistry diagrams under troubleshooting and
commissioning.
The monitoring program should pay particular attention to the adequacy of the makeup and
chemical feed systems, condenser tightness, air in-leakage, and corrosion product transport.
2-10
Figure 2-5
Road Map for Optimizing Feedwater Treatment for All-Ferrous Feedwater Systems
2-11
This monitoring involves taking a thumb-print of the unit under typical operating conditions
to identify under controlled conditions exactly how the unit chemistry is behaving. It may
involve a review of the operating chemistry logs, but this often is not satisfactory and it is
preferable to undertake a monitoring campaign. Before this campaign is initiated, it is important
to review the utilitys chemistry monitoring capability and reliability. This should include
Quality Assurance (QA) and Quality Control (QC) of existing and normally utilized analytical
chemistry monitoring and analysis methodology and equipment (see Appendix E).
The monitoring campaign should include:
If this step indicates a low level of feedwater corrosion product transport (such as Fe <2 ppb) and
acceptable feedwater purity from a dissolved solids standpoint with the control chemistry
meeting the guideline values provided in Sections 4 and 5, then an organization might consider
to continue with the current AVT(R) feedwater chemistry. Further confirmation of optimum
feedwater chemistry will be that waterwall deposition rates have historically been much less than
2
2
1 mg/cm /1000 hours (about 1 g/ft /1000 hours), that the interval between chemical cleans has
historically been better than every 10 years, and that there has been no indication of FAC in the
feedwater, feedwater steamside, deaerator, or feedwater heater drain lines.
Step 3Evaluate Reducing Agent Requirements
This step is a subset of Step 2 and should involve a series of tests to minimize the generation and
transport of feedwater corrosion products.
Many utilities with all-ferrous systems have found that, with proper air in-leakage control
(dissolved oxygen at the CPD of less than 10 ppb), the reducing agent (such as hydrazine) can be
(10)
eliminated without jeopardizing chemistry control on the unit and moving to AVT(O). Thus in
Step 3, a series of tests could be performed to evaluate the need for a reducing agent and, if
needed, to determine the proper reducing agent level. The tests should utilize the monitoring
system instrumentation (used in Step 2) while reducing or eliminating the reducing agent dosage.
Particular note should be made of dissolved oxygen levels and the level of corrosion products
generated during each test. Reference can be made to Figure 2-3, which illustrates the results
from a typical test. Table 2-4 should be referenced for typical parameter ranges. Particular
attention should be paid to the fact that there can be a long time between changes in the
feedwater chemistry and corrosion product transport, so careful planning is needed for accurate
extended tests. For instance, two months after the test outlined in Figure 2-3, the iron levels were
below 2 ppb and generally approaching 1 ppb.
2-12
Step 4 involves a period of normal operation with the new feedwater treatment, which
occasionally requires repetition of monitoring in Step 2 to confirm that running with reduced or
zero reducing agent provides the optimum feedwater treatment. This might involve a reduced
monitoring effort which just looks at feedwater oxygen and corrosion products at the economizer
inlet, in parallel with the cycle core parameters (Table 3-2), which should be normally
continuously recorded and alarmed.
In units with all-ferrous feedwater systems, but with copper based condenser tubing, there is a
possibility of copper corrosion particularly in the air removal section of the condenser. If
increased copper transport is measured at the CPD, then considerations should be given to a
reduction in cycle pH from 9.29.6 to 9.09.3 as needed to reduce copper levels to those present
during baseline monitoring. Of course such an increase in copper dissolution will not be a result
of the AVT(R) to AVT (O) change, but the pH reduction was probably needed when operating in
the AVT(R) mode.
Steps 5 and 6Consider Converting to OT
Once the baseline monitoring (Step 2) and a period of normal operation has been undertaken
then the question can be raised about whether the unit could run on oxygenated treatment (Step
5). The reader is referenced to the OT Guideline,(11) which provides step-by-step guidance on
whether a unit is suitable for OT and how to convert units to OT (Step 6) in a sequential fashion.
The transition check list in the OT Guidelines(11) should be referenced. It should be noted that
conversion to OT will take a number of weeks (more for drum units) and must include the heater
drains.
Step 7Continue to Optimize the Feedwater Treatment
There are now three treatments that can be used for the feedwater:
AVT(R),
AVT(O), and
OT
The feedwater treatment used on each unit should be continually checked to ensure it is always
the optimum treatment. As well as the core parameters at the key cycle points, it is now
necessary to ensure that the operation of the deaerator vents and heater vents are operated in a
manner which provides minimum levels of corrosion products in all parts of the cycle.
2-13
Controlling air in-leakage is of paramount importance in reaching the optimum ORP value.
Experience has indicated for over 15 years that if the air in-leakage is kept below 1
scfm/100MW, the level of oxygen within the condensate (at the condensate pump discharge,
CPD) can be kept below 10 ppb. Detailed procedures for monitoring air in-leakage are included
in Appendix C. It is now clear that the previous oxygen limit of 20 ppb at the CPD within the
original EPRI guidelines, in combination with a reducing agent addition based on the oxygen
level (three times the oxygen concentration) would not always produce a reducing environment
in the LP feedwater. The preferred approach is now to focus effort on air in-leakage to reduce
oxygen in the condensate, and to add only sufficient reducing agent to reach and maintain the
optimum ORP at the deaerator inlet.
Under reducing conditions (ORP 350mV), the surface oxide is cuprous oxide (Cu2O) and its
formation results in a compact even layer on the surface. (Figure 2-6, photos b, d, f and h),
whereas under oxidizing conditions (ORP +100mV) the surface oxide contains increasing
amounts of cupric oxide (CuO) (Figure 2-6, photos a, c, e and g). The copper release rate under
oxidizing conditions can be up to 30 times higher than under the reducing conditions, because
the surface roughness increases markedly with increasing ORP.
The importance of maintaining a reducing environment during operation cannot be
overemphasized. The cuprous oxide surface starts to change to cupric oxide within ten hours
once the environment becomes oxidizing.
Also, when a unit is shut down, if the ORP is kept reducing at an ORP of 350mV the surface
oxide (Cu2O) will remain on the surface. However, during a non-protected shutdown, when the
ORP is allowed to become oxidizing, the surface oxide layers start to change quickly (within 10
hours) from Cu2O to CuO again with a marked increase in surface roughness and transported
copper on startup. Similar results have been obtained for all the copper alloys (admiralty brass,
aluminum brass, Cu-Ni alloys, and Monel). The feedwater key parameters for AVT(R) for
mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems are summarized in Table 2-5.
2-14
AVT(R)
pH (25C, 77F) at EI
9.09.3
< 0.2
Fe, ppb at EI
<2
Cu, ppb at EI
<2
Oxygen (ppb) at EI
< 5 (< 2)
< 10
Reducing Agent
300 to 350
Notes: EI - economizer inlet; CPD - condensate pump discharge; DAI - deaerator inlet. Values in
parentheses indicate best achievable. * Reference should be made to Appendix B to review how a
reducing ORP is very dependent on a number of variables.
The most common alkalizing agent is ammonia. The most common and most satisfactory
reducing agent is hydrazine. Any alternates (amines and new organic water treatment chemicals)
must be evaluated in a monitoring campaign as indicated below under Optimization prior to
continuous use (Figure 2-7). They are not preferred for mixed-metallurgy systems because they
break down in the cycle and their use has been found to directly increase the transport of copper
corrosion products.
2-15
a)
c)
b)
d)
e)
f)
g)
h)
Figure 2-6
Surface Images of Admiralty Brass After Treatment at 95C (203F), pH 9 and ORP = +100
mV (a,c,e,g) and ORP = -350 mV (b,d,f,h) for 8 (a,b), 24 (c,d), 100 (e,f) and 200 (g,h) hours.
The surface oxide under reducing conditions is protective Cu2O. The rougher surface
oxide under oxidizing conditions is CuO.(12)
2-16
In summary, for plants with mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems, the approach should involve:
first, getting the ORP in the optimum range (350 to 300 mV) at the deaerator inlet (DAI)
by addressing air in-leakage, reducing agent addition and oxygen levels,
fourth, optimizing the complete feedwater treatment to minimize copper (< 2 ppb) and iron
(< 2 ppb).
The importance of proper shutdown and layup have already been discussed, and the necessary
procedures are further discussed in Appendix F. Sampling and analysis procedures are covered in
Appendix E.
Optimization of Mixed-Metallurgy Feedwater Chemistry
Figure 2-7 shows a road map for optimizing the feedwater treatment in mixed-metallurgy
feedwater systems. The primary purposes of this important activity are to minimize corrosion
product transport, and to reduce the accumulation of copper deposits throughout the boiler
(waterwalls and primary superheater) and the HP turbine. All of the steps included on this Road
(14)
Map are covered in detail in EPRIs Copper Guideline.
Step 1Review of Water Chemistry, Operation, and Experience
Water Chemistry. The first part of this review is verification of proper sampling and chemistry
monitoring practices to ensure that valid data are collected; in particular, for monitoring of iron
and copper in feedwater boiler water and steam, and determination of drum boiler carryover.
Any deficiencies must be corrected before Step 2 is initiated. The chemistry data should be
compared to customized limits based on the EPRI guideline limits shown in Sections 4 and 5,
and a judgement should be made whether they are acceptable or not.
Review of Operation. The type of operation, layup, and startup procedures should be reviewed
for their relation to cycle chemical transport, particularly with regards to oxidation of copper
alloys and boiler carryover. For cycling and peaking units, the influence of operation on air inleakage, layup protection, and transient chemistry should be reviewed.
Experience. The maintenance reports need to be reviewed and personnel interviewed to
evaluate the results of nondestructive testing and inspections, and the residual life of major
components influenced by water and steam chemistry. Specifically, the status of condenser and
feedwater heater, boiler, and superheater tubing and problems with flow-accelerated corrosion of
carbon steel in the feedwater cycle and in the economizer will be used in the decision making
about design and material changes.
2-17
Figure 2-7
Road Map for Optimizing Feedwater Treatment for Mixed-Metallurgy Systems
If there are no problems such as those indicated in Table 2-3, then continue to use the current
treatment. Such a review would indicate that the operating experience has been good, that
minimal chemical control problems have been experienced, that minimal BTF in the waterwalls
relating to waterside problems and deposition of feedwater corrosion products have occurred in
the last five years, that there have been no turbine deposition problems or blade failures, and that
the feedwater is operating in the optimum fashion with minimum levels of feedwater corrosion
products (<2 ppb Fe and <2 ppb Cu at the economizer inlet). In such cases of good experience,
no changes need to be made. However it is suggested that the road map is reviewed as there may
be considerable economic savings to be gained by optimizing AVT(R).
2-18
Baseline monitoring is a step which determines cycle chemical characteristics such as boiler
carryover, oxygen control, and transport of corrosion products. During the baseline monitoring
with verified sampling and analytical procedures, compliance with specifications of key water
and steam chemistry parameters is quantified. If problems exist, this monitoring should also
determine where and during what type of operation any corrosion and water chemistry problems
occur. For example, which feedwater heater generates copper alloy corrosion products, tube side
vs. shell side, during startup and/or normal operation, etc.
This program should use the installed chemistry monitoring system, supplemented by monitoring
those parameters in the cycle chemistry diagrams under troubleshooting and commissioning.
The monitoring program should pay particular attention to the adequacy of the makeup and
chemical feed systems, condenser tightness and air in-leakage, and corrosion product transport.
This monitoring involves taking a thumb-print of the unit under typical operating conditions
to identify under controlled conditions exactly how the unit chemistry is behaving. It may
involve a review of the operating chemistry logs, but this often is not satisfactory and it is
preferable to adopt a monitoring campaign. Before this campaign is initiated, it is important to
review the utilitys chemistry monitoring capability and reliability (as in Step 1). This should
include Quality Assurance (QA) and Quality Control (QC) of existing and normally utilized
analytical chemistry monitoring and analysis methodology and equipment (see Appendix E).
The monitoring campaign should include:
During the tests for optimum pH and ammonia concentrations (9.09.3) for mixed metallurgy
systems, the pH measurements should be made with on-line equipment designed for pH
measurement in high purity water at carefully controlled sample temperatures (25C0.1).
Ammonia concentrations should be related to specific conductance to be sure that no appreciable
carbon dioxide is present.
If this step indicates a low level of feedwater corrosion product transport (such as Fe <2 ppb and
Cu <2 ppb) and acceptable feedwater purity from a dissolved solids standpoint, with the control
chemistry meeting the guideline values provided in Sections 4 and 5, then an organization might
consider to continue with the current chemistry. Further points of confirmation of optimum
2
feedwater chemistry will be that waterwall deposition rates are much less than 1 mg/cm /1000
hours (about 1 g/ft2/1000 hours), that the interval between chemical cleans has historically been
better than every 10 years, and there has been no indication of FAC in the heater drain lines.
2-19
If water chemistry, corrosion and scale problems are identified in the review part of the
optimization process, cycle chemistry optimization can possibly improve the situation. This step
needs to involve operation, startup, and layup. The feedwater chemistry optimization usually
consists of reducing the ingress of impurities, such as air in-leakage and condenser leakage,
minimizing ammonia concentration, and determining the optimum reducing agent concentration
that will minimize copper corrosion while controlling corrosion and flow-accelerated corrosion
of carbon and low alloy steels. In high pressure drum boiler and once-through cycles, there is
little room for application of alternate reducing agent and volatile amines because of the
problems with their thermal decomposition and generation of organic acids and CO2.
Layup chemistry and chemical dosing and disposal of the layup solutions must also be
considered in this step. See Appendix F.
Thus in this step, a series of tests should be performed to determine the optimum reducing agent
levels. The tests should use the monitoring system instrumentation (Step 2) while lowering the
reducing agent dosage. Particular note should be made of dissolved oxygen levels, quantities of
corrosion products, and the oxidizing/reducing potential (ORP). The latter is particularly
important as a reducing environment is required for the copper containing alloys.
The choice of reducing agent is also involved here. This includes safety as well as optimized
reaction rates and concern for the alternate behavior of any thermal decomposition products and
their effects in other parts of the cycle.
Although the surface oxide on copper can start to change within ten hours after losing a reducing
environment, attention should be paid to the fact that there can be a long time (maybe six
months) between changes in feedwater chemistry (ORP) and measured changes in corrosion
product transport at the economizer inlet. Thus careful planning is needed for accurate extended
tests.
Step 4Design and Material Changes
After a number of years of operation with copper feedwater heaters, with perhaps non-optimum
chemistry such as high air in-leakage, high oxygen and oxidizing ORP, many organizations are
realizing that the heaters should be replaced. The most common replacement material is stainless
(14)
steel, but all material options are thoroughly discussed in the EPRI Copper Guideline. Such
changes are likely to need detailed economic analysis. EPRI has also developed the tools to assist
in these analyses.(5)
2-20
Step 5Operation
Operational changes can be implemented which are not very costly and can reduce water and
steam chemistry problems, such as generation and transport of copper alloy and carbon steel
corrosion products. Other changes can be applied to layup practices and to system fill and
startup. Examples of operational changes include more frequent and longer use of condensate
polishers, and filling with deoxygenated makeup water (Appendix A). Again many of these
(14)
solutions are discussed in the Copper Guidelines.
Each suggested operational change should be tested with the monitoring/instrumentation as in
Steps 2 and 3.
Step 6Monitoring to Compare with Baseline Data
This step is aimed at verifying the effectiveness of the implemented solutions to water chemistry
and corrosion problems. This water chemistry monitoring and determination of the new cycle
chemistry transport characteristics should cover base load, load variations, startup and shutdown,
and it should include all the parameters in the water and steam chemistry guidelines. Special
instrumentation and sampling could be used to ensure that the corrective measures are effective.
There should also be a longterm monitoring plan which includes equipment inspections and
nondestructive testing.
Step 7Normal Operation and Monitoring
When Step 6 results are satisfactory, indicating trouble-free water chemistry and operation, then
normal operational monitoring resumes. However, there should be periodic reviews of water
chemistry and equipment scale and corrosion problems, and chemical transport studies should be
performed every two to three years to ensure that equipment aging and other changes do not
result in problems. The water chemistry and operating manuals should be updated to reflect the
changes resulting from the optimization.
If the feedwater copper level at the economizer inlet exceeds the guideline value (< 2 ppb) during
normal operation, then attention has to be drawn to maintaining reducing chemistry. ORP in the
range of 300 to 350mV has to be maintained not only during the steady state operation, but
also during load changes, cycling and peaking operation, and startup and shutdown.
Here careful control of air in-leakage, optimized reducing agent dosing into the feedwater
upstream of the LP heaters to ensure a reducing ORP at the deaerator inlet, and feedwater
oxygen of less than 5 ppb are particularly important.
2-21
The continual check on the optimized treatment (Step 8) and the core parameters will determine
whether fine tuning is necessary (Repeat of Steps 3 and 6).
Step 9Longterm Plans
Based on the effectiveness of the solutions of water chemistry and corrosion problems
implemented in a specific unit and on the equipment life predictions, i.e., feedwater heater and
condenser tube deterioration, then longterm plans can be formulated. This can include planning
for ultimate replacement of copper alloys, retrofit of condensate polishers, nitrogen sparging and
blanketing of the storage tanks used to fill the system during startup (Appendix A). Again all
these are discussed in detail in the Copper Guidelines.(14)
2-22
Figure 2-8
Road Map for Selecting or Optimizing Boiler Water Treatment for Drum Boilers
2-23
Here the first part of this step is to determine if the current boiler water treatment is adequate or
whether the unit should be converted to another treatment. This can be performed by answering
some of the following questions:
Historically has the feedwater cation conductivity most often been below 0.2 S/cm? This
might indicate that serious condenser leakage over a period of time has not been of concern.
The answer here is very important for assessing the approach in Step 10.
Does the boiler have a consistent carryover problem? Has it been measured within the last six
months?
Does the unit have a satisfactory monitoring system with the ability to monitor the essential
core parameters as indicated in the cycle chemistry diagrams of Sections 4 and 5, and in
Table 3-2? If this assessment is being conducted for drum boilers on AVT then the EPRI
(17)
AVT guideline should be referenced for the appropriate core level of instruments .
The answers to these questions will be needed in the other steps of the road map.
The second part of this step will be accomplished by a complete review of the current and past
experience with the current treatment system (phosphate, CT or AVT) to determine if an
alternate treatment should be considered. Note that, for boiler water, AVT may be either
AVT(O) or AVT(R), as determined during efforts to select and optimize the feedwater treatment.
In many cases, the operating experience will be good, and indicate that only minimal chemical
control problems have been experienced, that no BTF in the waterwalls relating to waterside
problems have occurred in the last five years, that no turbine deposition or blade failure problems
have occurred, and that the feedwater is operating in the optimum fashion with minimum levels
of feedwater corrosion products (Fe <2 ppb, Cu <2 ppb). In such cases of good experience,
maybe no changes need to be made. However, it is suggested that the road map be reviewed as
there may be considerable economic savings to be gained.
In other cases, some problems may have occurred or still be occurring, which necessitate a more
thorough review and optimization. Information is provided in this step for units with boilers
currently operating with a phosphate treatment or CT, and for units operating on AVT.
For Units with Drum Boilers Currently Operating with a Phosphate Treatment or CT. The
initial review involves operating experience with the current phosphate treatment and in
particular, determination of whether phosphate hideout and return occurs, and whether excessive
sodium carryover occurs. Controlling carryover with CT is particularly important to minimize
damage to the steam circuits.
2-24
Do phosphate hideout and return occur, together with pH instability during transients, shutdown
and startup?
Another question is has the boiler experienced any Boiler Tube Failures (BTF) in the last five
years, and have any of these been water-side related? Here the relevant failure mechanisms are
(15)
hydrogen damage, caustic gouging, acid phosphate corrosion, or corrosion fatigue. The last is
important for AVT units as well, as it has been shown that pH depressions, which can occur
during shutdown, load reductions, and during the early startup period can exacerbate the
corrosion fatigue process.
Another question is whether any deposits have been observed in the turbine. Particularly relevant
is the deposition of copper-based materials in the HP turbine, or of sodium compounds in the HP
and IP turbines; either of which may have resulted in serious capacity and efficiency losses. If
phosphate deposits have been found, then boiler drum level control and boiler carryover
problems might exist, which need to be addressed prior to optimizing the current treatment or
converting to PC or CT.
A review of condenser in-leakage and any makeup water contaminant excursions should also be
made.
If the answer to any or some of these questions is positive, implying that the current phosphate or
caustic treatment is not providing adequate chemical control, then the other road map steps
should be followed.
For Units with Drum Boilers Currently Operating on AVT. There are also a large number of
drum units operating on AVT and it is advisable to review the operating experience to date and
to answer the following questions. The AVT may be set up incorrectly and/or the boiler may
need a solid alkali treatment (PC or CT). Alternatively the boiler may be operating very
successfully on AVT and may be suitable for conversion to oxygenated treatment (OT).
Has the unit experienced any of the problems relating to the generation, transport and
deposition of feedwater corrosion products (Table 2-3)?
Does the boiler water experience pH depressions during the shutdown and early startup
periods which require the addition of either phosphate or caustic?
Are chemicals other than trisodium phosphate or sodium hydroxide added to the boiler water
for startup or in response to contaminant ingress?
Does the feedwater cation conductivity often and significantly rise above 0.2 S/cm?
The questions on BTF, turbine problems and condenser and makeup water contaminants in
the section above for units on phosphate and caustic treatment are also applicable here.
If the answer to any or some of these questions is positive, implying that the current AVT is not
providing optimum chemical control, then the other road map steps should be followed starting
with Step 3. Alternatively if the answers are negative then the unit may be suitable for
conversion to OT starting at Step 7.
2-25
If the review in Step 1 indicates that consideration should be given to converting the boiler to
another treatment or that the current treatment requires optimizing, then Step 3 involves a
complete base-line monitoring program to quantify the chemical parameters for the particular
unit in question. This program would use the installed chemistry monitoring system,
supplemented by monitoring those parameters in the cycle chemistry diagrams under
troubleshooting and commissioning. The monitoring program should pay particular attention
to the adequacy of the makeup and chemical feed systems, condenser tightness, air ingress, and
corrosion product transport.
This monitoring involves taking a thumb-print of the unit under typical operating conditions
to identify, under controlled conditions, exactly how the unit chemistry is behaving. It may
involve a review of the operating chemistry logs, but this often is not satisfactory and it is
preferable to adopt a monitoring campaign. Before this campaign is initiated, it is important to
review the utilitys chemistry monitoring capability and reliability. This should include Quality
Assurance (QA) and Quality Control (QC) of existing and normally utilized analytical chemistry
monitoring and analysis methodology and equipment (see Appendix E).
The monitoring campaign should include:
Boiler Water Chemistry with Blowdown Open and Closedsodium, phosphate, free
hydroxide, ammonia, chloride, sulfate, silica, pH, cation conductivity, Fe, Cu, carryover.
Steam Chemistrycation conductivity, sodium (as a measure of both salts and free
hydroxide), phosphate, chloride, silica, sulfate, and boiler carryover of these chemicals.
Mechanical carryover (moisture) and chemical volatility in the steam must be measured by
monitoring total carryover. Concern must also be given to any contaminants that may be
contributed to the steam by feedwater utilized for steam temperature control (attemperation).
The feedwater treatment should be reviewed as discussed in the previous two subsections.
The outcome from this step should be a quantification of those problems recognized in Step 1.
2-26
For boilers currently operating with a phosphate treatment (EPT, PT, or even CPT) the basic
questions to be answered here are whether classic phosphate hideout is occurring, whether this is
causing any boiler tube corrosion problems, or whether any BTF have occurred. The information
collected in Steps 1 and 2 should answer these questions. Hideout could be indicated by pH and
phosphate changes during the shutdown or load reduction period, and corrosion may be indicated
by an increase of boiler water iron, for boilers operating with CPT. However, it should be noted
that units, which only have tri-sodium phosphate injected, can experience a pH elevation
together with a phosphate elevation during the shutdown or load reduction period.
Hideout can also occur on boilers operating with CT, but it is usually less pronounced than those
operating with PC.
So for boilers operating on any previous phosphate treatment (EPT, PT or CPT in Figure 1-6),
then at this stage in the roadmap two routes can be taken (A or B) based on the analysis in Steps
13.
Operators/Chemists that should initially consider Route A include those with boilers operating:
On EPT with contaminant levels exceeding the EPT boiler control curves (see for instance
Figure 3-4).
On CPT experiencing phosphate hideout and/or adding mono- or di-sodium phosphate to the
boiler.
Operators/Chemists that should initially consider Route B include those with boilers operating:
On EPT with contaminant levels not generally exceeding the EPT boiler control curves.
Here the basic direction is determined by the answers to Steps 6 and 10. Most mistakes in
choosing, optimizing and changing a boiler water treatment result from not considering these two
Steps comprehensively.(1,2) It will directly increase the risk of under-deposit corrosion and BTF.
2-27
If AVT is selected on this route then the new AVT Guidelines(17) provide the advice, guidance
and detailed steps to be followed. Once the AVT chemistry has been selected or it has been
decided to optimize the current AVT, then a monitoring campaign should be conducted (Step
17), which can provide direct comparison with the base-line monitoring conducted in Step 3. It is
important to note that the optimization of the feedwater chemistry with AVT is very important
and particular attention should be given to the choice of AVT(R) or AVT(O) (Section 2.2).
An alternative route is for the unit to be converted to OT, and then the OT guidelines provide the
(11)
necessary detailed guidance.
Step 8Boiler Chemical Clean
It is usually preferable to chemically clean the boiler immediately before conversion to a new
treatment. This becomes almost a necessity if considering changing from an older phosphate
treatment (such as CPT) to PC or AVT. Those organizations planning on changing from EPT to
PC(L) with no history of tube failures should base the chemical cleaning decision on the normal
criteria based on deposit levels. The EPRI Chemical Cleaning Guidelines(16) provide the relevant
information.
2-28
Step 10Need to Determine the Likelihood and Frequency of Cycle Contaminant Events
This most important step is the one most often not considered when changing treatments. Very
often plants have continued to operate with the older EPT with very low levels of phosphate
(0.10.2 ppm), or AVT, either with no condensate polisher and/or seawater cooling, or where, as
the unit has become older, condenser leaks occur more frequently. In any of these cases there is
clearly a need to move to a more resistant boiler water treatment, at least until the condenser can
be retubed and/or a condensate polisher is retrofitted to the unit.
This step helps in deciding whether to convert to PC(L) or PC(H) or CT, or whether to maintain
and/or optimize the current treatment. Here there is a need to look at the past operating chemical
records (Step 1) and gauge the seriousness of any contaminant ingress. One way of doing this is
to determine how closely the unit has met the guideline limits for feedwater, and the amount of
time, in the past 23 years, that the unit has been out of normal target limits. For example, plant
personnel might want to consider the cumulative hours equivalent to Level 1 for economizer
inlet cation conductivity or boiler water chloride as being acceptable and controllable
contamination. Here the boiler water control curves in Sections 4 and 5 will need to be
referenced and compared with operating practices. If the contaminant episodes have been very
infrequent then the organization might want to consider operating with PC(L) (Step 11). If,
however, the contamination is greater, then the organization will need to consider converting to
PC(H) (Step 15) or CT (Step 13); in these cases there is a need to develop operating procedures
which have closer adherence to the guideline limits.
Steps 11, 13 and 15Convert to PC(L), PC(H), or CT
The necessary detailed guidance to convert a unit to PC(L) and PC(H) is included in Section 4.
If a chemist/operator followed Route A in Step 4 and/or the unit is susceptible to frequent
feedwater contamination (Step 10), then the utility will want to convert and optimize to PC(H) or
CT for the unit. The PC(H) treatment is markedly different from the older CPT and PT, and will
be used to allow greater flexibility in phosphate control. It essentially optimizes the chemistry by
eliminating the need to chase phosphate hideout and ensures that correct additive chemicals
(only trisodium phosphate and sodium hydroxide) are added to the unit.
With PC(H) it is also very important to consider changes or potential changes to the unit
operation, which could change the heat flux patterns on the walls, or to the thermal hydraulic
conditions within the walls. Such situations might include:
These types of situations could cause hideout to be initiated; thus there is a need to ensure that
any hideout is recovered normally, by monitoring following any such changes to unit or boiler
operation. If hideout does occur with PC(H), there is no danger of it resulting in acid phosphate
corrosion because no mono- or di-sodium phosphate will be added to the boiler.(2)
2-29
Section 5 on the use of caustic treatment, using sodium hydroxide for conditioning the boiler
water of drum boilers, covers operating experience, boiler and steam chemistry, corrosion,
sampling, on-line monitoring and conversion of plant to caustic treatment. This section should be
studied when considering CT.
CT avoids the complications with monitoring, chemical control and the hideout that occur with
phosphate treatments. However, the concentration of chloride in the boiler water needs to be
carefully controlled to prevent hydrogen damage due to acid chloride. (This is also true of any of
the phosphate treatments and, particularly for AVT). The concentration of sodium hydroxide
should normally be maintained between about 1 ppm and 1.5 ppm, and must not be allowed to
exceed 3 ppm, to reduce the risk of caustic gouging in the boiler, and carryover, leading to
deposition and a potential risk of corrosion in the steam circuit. The pressure dependence of
NaOH concentration for CT is shown in Figure 5-6. It is most important that no boiler drum level
control or boiler carryover problems exist.
It is important in these steps and in Step 12 to ensure that the high pressure boilers are not
constrained by steam purity. Of particular concern is for sodium.
Steps 9, 12, 14, and 16Develop Specific Unit Chemistry Guidelines
By this stage, a utility should have decided on their optimum boiler water treatment.
The importance of this step cant be overemphasized as survey results have indicated that, in the
past, the development of unit specific guidelines was performed very infrequently to follow the
suggestions in all EPRI Cycle Chemistry Guidelines. Most utilities simply use the target values
and action levels and do not customize the guidance into specific unit cycle chemistry guidelines.
The results of this step should be unique normal target and action levels for each specific unit.
Steps 17 to 19Monitor to Compare with Baseline Monitoring and to Optimize Treatment
Selected
These are very important steps which link with Steps 9, 12, 14 and 16. They are essentially a
repeat of Step 3. The same matrix of operating conditions and parameters should be looked at.
For the PC and CT treatments, particular emphasis should be directed to monitoring the free
hydroxide in the boiler water and sodium in the steam to ensure that any excessive levels are
recognized early and will not lead to caustic gouging BTF or to turbine problems. Sections 3.8.1,
and 4 and 5 should be extensively referenced during this step.
With all treatments, it is essential to monitor and compare with the baseline data (Step 17). If the
conditions achieved (Step 18) are in any way unsatisfactory, it is necessary to proceed via the
check loop and reconsider the method of chemical treatment (Step 19). Such instances may be
an increasing number of condenser leaks, or a marked increase in air in-leakage, or a level of
sodium in steam which exceeds the EPRI steam limits (Sections 4 and 5). Only when satisfactory
chemical operation has been obtained, can normal operation (Step 20) be considered to have
been achieved.
2-30
At this stage, the unit should be operating with the optimum treatment. For the PC treatments this
should involve no phosphate hideout, or at least understandable hideout which is fully under
control through unit specific guidelines. There should be no cases where chemical/operating
personnel add the wrong chemicals.
For all treatments, the utility should have developed a set of guidelines for the chemical control
of the drum unit. There should be at least a minimum level of instrumentation on the unit, and
the key monitoring points and parameters should be alarmed in the control room. All
operating/chemical personnel should know exactly what to do in the case of a contaminant
ingress.
Contaminant episodes need to be dealt with promptly. The source of contamination needs to be
removed as soon as possible, pressure restrictions applied if maximum contaminant levels are
exceeded, and boiler water chemistry adjusted as needed to get back into the control limits
established for the unit.
As mentioned previously for feedwater treatments, it is important to continually re-evaluate the
appropriate use of boiler water treatments in individual fossil units. A general review of
treatment applicability should be made at six month intervals. Follow-up monitoring is desirable
if the general review raises any concerns.
2-31
2.4 REFERENCES
1. R.B. Dooley, The Relationship Between Cycle Chemistry and Performance of Fossil Plants,
Power Plant Chemistry, 2002, 4(6), pp. 320-327.
2. R.B. Dooley and W.P. McNaughton, Appropriate Controls for Phosphate Boiler Water
Treatments to Avoid Acid Phosphate Corrosion and Hydrogen Damage, Power Plant
Chemistry, 3(3), pp. 127-134: 2001
3. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Phosphate Treatment for Drum Units, EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: December 1994. TR-103665.
4. International Conference on BTF and HTF, and Inspections. Phoenix, Arizona, November
2001, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2002. 1007347.
5. Justifying Cycle Chemistry Upgrades to Improve Availability, Performance, and
Profitability, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: June 2001. 1001557.
6. Selection and Optimization of Boiler Water and Feedwater Treatments for Fossil Plants,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: March 1997. TR-105040.
7. B. Chexal, J. Horowitz, R.B. Dooley, et al., Flow-Accelerated Corrosion in Power Plants,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 1998. TR-106611-R1.
8. R.B. Dooley and B. Chexal, Flow-Accelerated Corrosion, Paper 347, Corrosion 99, 2628
April 1999. Also published in International Journal of Pressure Vessel and Piping, 77, pp.
8590: 2001.
9. Guidelines for Controlling Flow-Accelerated Corrosion in Fossil Plants, EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: November 1997. TR-108859.
10. R.B. Dooley, J. Mathews, R. Pate and J. Taylor, Optimum Chemistry for All-Ferrous
th
Feedwater Systems: Why Use an Oxygen Scavenger, Proc. 55 International Water
Conference, Pittsburgh, PA, Oct. 1Nov. 2, 1994.
11. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Oxygenated Treatment, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
December 1994. TR-102285.
12. Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 2000.
1000456.
13. Influence of Water Chemistry on Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: October 2001. 1004586.
14. Guidelines for Copper in Fossil Plants, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 2000. 1000457.
2-32
15. R.B. Dooley and W.P. McNaughton, Boiler Tube Failures: Theory and Practice, EPRI, Palo
Alto, CA: 1996. TR-105261.
16. Guidelines for Chemical Cleaning of Conventional Fossil Plant Equipment, EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: November 2001. 1003994.
17. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All-Volatile Treatment, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
November 2002. 1004187.
2-33
3
PHILOSOPHY FOR GUIDELINE AND RATIONALE FOR
SAMPLE POINTS, ACTION LEVELS AND TARGET
VALUES
3.1 INTRODUCTION
These guidelines are designed to assist organizations in improving the operating efficiency and
in reducing the losses in boiler and turbine availability influenced by the cycle chemistry by
accomplishing the following objectives:
selecting and optimizing the boiler water and feedwater (Section 2),
The rationale of the guidelines in achieving these objectives is based upon an understanding of
the effects of impurities on cycle component materials under stress and heat transfer conditions,
and recently developed knowledge of chemical transport from the sources of the impurities
throughout the water and steam cycle. Figure 3-1 identifies sources of impurity ingress,
corrosion and deposition areas around a typical drum boiler cycle.
These guidelines suggest target values and action levels for drum boiler units for all key cycle
contaminants as a continuum over a broad range of operating pressures. Each of the solid alkali
treatments applicable to drum boilers is addressed including those employing trisodium
phosphate and (as needed) sodium hydroxide, namely the Phosphate Continuum (PC) (covered
in Section 4) and those utilizing only sodium hydroxide, known as Caustic Treatment (CT,
covered in Section 5). The guidelines summarize all sample points, monitoring and control
parameters, target values and action levels; and feature a consistent, methodical rationale that
relates to all sample points, target values and action levels for each parameter to the
component(s) most affected by that parameter.
3-1
Figure 3-1
Typical Locations of Impurity Ingress, Corrosion and Deposition in a Drum Cycle
The guidelines include target values and action levels for significant contaminants at critical
sample points. In addition, the criteria for establishing the target values include:
the optimal steam and water chemistry for protecting cycle components (boiler, turbine, and
pre-boiler components) from deposition and corrosion, based on EPRIs research;
limits of detection based on the capability of currently available on-line analyzers and grab
sample analysis methods;
This solid Alkali Treatment Guideline is a revision of the original Phosphate Treatment
Guidelines(1), and of a report on worldwide experience with sodium hydroxide treatment(2). It is
based on the results of over 10 years of EPRI research and as such there are a number of key
changes and philosophies to the guideline values and the approach. Thus the next two
subsections have been added to outline the differences between the previous approach (Section
3.2) and the current approach (Section 3.3).
3-2
3-3
Feedwater chemistry target values also reflected the need to control feedwater corrosion by
optimizing the dissolved oxygen concentrations and pH. It is now clear that ORP is the critical
parameter in the feedwater.
4.8
6.2
7.6
9.0
15.8
17.2
18.6 19.6
0.3
0.2
0.1
0.09
0.08
(Note: This curve includes a safety factor of 2)
0.07
600 700
900
1100 1300 1500 1700 1900 2100 2300 2500 2700 2850
Drum Pressure (psig)
Figure 3-2
Representative Drum Boiler Mechanical Carryover used to Derive Generic Cycle Chemistry
Limits; Actual Carryover in Drum Boilers Must be Determined in the Field as There are
Significant Variations Due to Drum Design, Firing Rate and Drum Operating Level.
3-4
200
400
600
1000
1200
1600
2000
2200
2800
2600
3000
3200
10-0
Fe3O4
Al2O3
10-2
B2O3
NH
4 Cl
, (N
NiO
4)
2
SO
CuO
10-3
SiO2
10-4
Cu2O
CaSO4
MgO
CaCl2
10-5
Na
4
O4
2S
PO
Na 3
Na
10-6
BaO
LiCl
Cl
10-1
NaOH
10-7
22
20
16
12
8
6
Drum Pressure (MPa)
6
10
20
60
Density of Liquid/Density of Steam
100
Figure 3-3
Distribution Ratios for Common Boiler Water Contaminants (This ray diagram was
originally developed by N. A. Styrikovich and O. I. Martynova.(7,8))
3-5
It was suggested that the boiler water target values could be recalculated and made to fit
individual unit characteristics where the steam purity limits could be modified (for example, in
higher backpressure turbines) and where the mechanical carryover had been measured and
validated, and differed from the values in Figure 3-2. Consideration of high heat fluxes in drum
boilers needed to be included when recalculating boiler water target values. Reducing the target
values for boiler water impurities by as much as 50% was recommended for units known to have
high duty boilers (such as some oil-fired boilers); future work planned by EPRI in a project
called Program Boiler Corrosion will assess this need and other aspects of boiler water
chemistry, surface deposits, and their effects on corrosion activity.
The higher tolerance of non-reheat turbines to impurities in steam was acknowledged in the
previous guidelines and this was reflected in the establishment of two sets of guidelines for
reheat and nonreheat drum boiler units.
3.2.1 Illustration and Examples of Boiler Water Limits from Previous EPRI
Guidelines
The following example is provided only to illustrate the historic perspective delineated in
Section 3.2. It should not be adapted or applied to fossil plant units. This approach was used in
(1)
previous EPRI Cycle Chemistry Guidelines including the 1994 Phosphate Treatment Guideline ;
(2)
this derivation approach was not followed in the earlier report on sodium hydroxide treatment
or in the recently issued AVT Guideline(6).
Total Carryover
The allowable impurity concentrations in boiler water were calculated from those of the steam
and the amounts of mechanical and vaporous carryover.
Carryover is defined as the ratio of concentration of a chemical specie in the saturated steam
exiting the boiler drum to the concentration in the boiler water (usually measured in the
blowdown). Total carryover (T) is defined as:
T=M+V
(eq. 3-1)
where M is mechanical carryover (with steam moisture) and V is the vaporous carryover.
Total carryover is usually measured by analysis of sodium:
T=
3-6
Na in saturated steam
Na in blowdown
(eq. 3-2)
Mechanical carryover is a measure of the separation efficiency of the boiler. It can be calculated
as:
M = T V*
(eq. 3-3)
where V* is a vaporous carryover of the prevalent sodium salt (either trisodium phosphate or
sodium hydroxide depending on the solid alkali treatment in use) identified in a particular boiler
at the boiler operating pressure.
Volatile carryover of chemical species associated with unknown molecules, Vx, is then
calculated as:
Vx = Tx M
where Tx =
and
(eq. 3-4)
x in saturated steam
x in blowdown
The following equation can be derived from a mass balance around the boiler and can be used to
calculate the boiler water concentrations from the allowable steam concentrations, distribution
ratios, and mechanical carryover rate:
CB
CS
M + k d (1 M )
(eq. 3-5)
where
CB = boiler water target value (ppb)
CS = reheat steam target value (ppb)
M = mechanical carryover
kd = fractional distribution ratio
It was strongly suggested in all previous EPRI guidelines that this equation should be used to
modify the target values for boiler water chemistry when validated data on a specific plants
mechanical carryover rates were collected during commissioning and periodically thereafter and
found to be substantially different from those in Figure 3-2. The equation does not include the
effects of attemperation water, which will be negligible when the economizer inlet chemistry is
maintained at a value equal to or better than the reheat steam chemistry as recommended in the
guidelines.
3-7
Illustration
The following example illustrates the procedure for calculating the boiler water target values.
Example: Calculate the boiler water sulfate target values and action levels for a plant, using
mechanical carryover rate data from Figure 3-2. This plant has a 2500 psi (17.2 MPa) drum
boiler with reheat operated on PT.
Solution: Calculate the target value and action level for operation at full load, 2500 psi (17.2
MPa) at which the mechanical carryover from Figure 3-2 is 0.00185.
3 ppb
0.00185 + 0.0000023 (1 0.00185)
1.6 ppm
> 1.6 ppm
3.2 ppm
> 3.2 ppm
6.4 ppm
> 6.4 ppm
A similar process was used for other boiler water contaminants. By using sodium chloride as the
volatile specie for chloride and its distribution ratio from the ray diagram, the PT boiler water
target values for chloride were the same as for sulfate based on the sodium sulfate salt. Figures 34 and 3-5 show the boiler water chloride target values and action levels as a function of operating
pressure for EPT and PT chemistry. These curves were derived as described above using the
generic mechanical carryover curve (Figure 3-2).
(1)
The 1994 EPRI Phosphate Treatment Guidelines derived a family of control curves for EPT
and PT. The curves for EPT (such as Figure 3-4 for chloride) assumed that chlorides and sulfates
would be present as the more volatile (as predicted by the ray diagram) ammonium salts. Thus,
limits for these parameters in boiler water on EPT were much lower than for units operated on
PT where the volatility of chloride and sulfate was primarily considered as their respective
sodium salts (as shown in Figure 3-5 for chloride). In fact the EPT limits were identical to the
3-8
limits derived for AVT chemistry(3). The report on CT(2) did not apply the derivation procedure
used for the Guidelines for other chemistries.
Drum Pressure (MPa)
3.0
4.8
6.2
7.6
9.0
10.3
11.7
13.1
14.5
15.8
17.2
18.6 19.6
2500
2700 2850
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
Action level 3
0.2
Action level
2
Action level 1
0.10
0.09
0.08
0.07
0.06
Normal
0.05
0.04
0.03
0.02
0.01
600 700
900
1100
1300
2100
2300
Figure 3-4
Equilibrium Phosphate Treatment (EPT): Drum Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating
Pressure. Calculated using mechanical and vaporous carryover for a limit of 3 ppb
Chloride in Steam. The values were identical for sulfate. It must be noted that these are
the old EPT limits derived in the previous Phosphate Treatment Guidelines(1) and should
no longer be used. The new PC(L) limits are discussed in Section 4.
3-9
Figure 3-5
Phosphate Treatment (PT): Drum Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating Pressure. Calculated
using mechanical and vaporous carryover for a limit of 3 ppb Chloride in Steam. It must be
noted that these are the old limits derived in the previous Phosphate Treatment Guidelines(1)
and should no longer be used. The new PC(H) limits are discussed in Section 4.
3-10
Steam Purity
Parameter
OT/AVT
PC(L)
CT
PC(H)
2/2
Cation
Conductivity,
S/cm
0.15/0.2
0.2
0.2
0.3
Visits to hundreds of plants and benchmarking of the chemistry programs in use has indicated
that very few utilities around the world measure and/or know the percentage of mechanical
carryover on their drum units. This observation, combined with the inaccuracies of the ray
diagram, has led to questions about the continued use of the approach followed in the previous
Guidelines of deriving boiler water limits from steam solubilities using mechanical and vaporous
(ray diagram) carryover. Thus EPRI initiated a detailed study of partitioning of impurities, salts
and oxides into steam, which has now led to a validation of the boiler water limits (see Section
1.2.4). This is discussed in the next section.
3-11
3.3.1 Derivation of Philosophy for Steam and Boiler Water Limits in EPRIs New
Phosphate Continuum and Caustic Treatment Guidelines
As indicated in Section 3.2, the concepts of carryover were included in the derivation of boiler
water limits from the steam limits in all previous EPRI Guidelines prior to 2002. In order to
apply these concepts to a variety of individual systems with widely differing chemical and
physical environments (e.g. water chemistry, boiling and condensation temperatures), it is
necessary to quantify the extent of partitioning of various solutes between water and steam under
phase change conditions (boiling and condensation).
Jonas pointed out discrepancies between partitioning data obtained from operating plants and the
values predicted from the ray diagram.(14) For almost 50 years the ray diagram has been used to
express vaporous carryover and used for boiler water limit derivation. The plant measurements
of distribution coefficients for chloride and sulfate were higher by orders of magnitude than
those given by the ray diagram for chloride and sulfate. This observation led to the conclusion
that both the experimental and theoretical basis for the ray diagram should be investigated in
some detail, to include those solutes for which no experimental partitioning data were available,
and to develop a more rigorous treatment of solute partitioning between liquid water and steam.
This new model for solute carryover could then be applied to the wide range of operating
conditions and water chemistry found in fossil plants worldwide.
This initiated a series of EPRI sponsored research projects to rigorously measure experimentally
the partitioning constants for most of the important compounds, which can be present in boiler
water and steam. Over the last ten years, work has addressed the following compounds and
related species: NH4Cl, NH3, HCl, NH4HSO4, Na2SO4, NaHSO4, NaOH, H2SO4, organic acids
(acetic and formic), Cu(OH)2, H3PO4, NaH2PO4, and Na2HPO4. The results have been reported by
EPRI.(15-21)
The results of this new thermodynamic approach and the partitioning equations have been
summarized in a recent report(21); the overall results were shown in Figure 1-4 and discussed in
Section 1.2.4. The partitioning constants (i.e. the concentration in the steam over the activities of
the constituent ions in the water) can be illustrated on a partitioning diagram by plotting the
logarithm of the partitioning constant against reciprocal absolute temperature (in Kelvin).
Separate curves have been derived for each compound and related species: NH4Cl, NH3, HCl,
NH4HSO4, Na2SO4, NaHSO4, NaOH, H2SO4, organic acids, Cu(OH)2, H3PO4, NaH2PO4 and
Na2HPO4. Some species, NH3, SO2, organic acids, Cu(OH)2 and H3PO4 are neutral, others are 1:1
ionic compounds, NH4Cl, HCl, NaOH, NaCl, NaHSO4, NH4HSO4 and NaH2PO4, while Na2SO4
and Na2HPO4 are 1:2 ionic compounds.
The partitioning constants for the neutral species are shown in Figure 3-6, the 1:1 compounds in
Figure 3-7 and the 1:2 species in Figure 3-8. Sulfuric acid can be classed as a 1:1 compound,
+
because under the conditions of the experiments, it only ionizes one stage to H and HSO4 . The
relative volatilities of each type of species can be compared directly on each graph, but because
of the different ways in which 1:1 or 1:2 electrolytes dissociate, neutral compounds can not be
compared with 1:1 compounds, or 1:1 compounds with 1:2 compounds. However, it is clear
from the graphs that the volatilities of all the ionic solutes increase with temperature.
3-12
20
Tc
300
200
150C
NH3 (N)
Partitioning Constants
SO2 (N)
CH3COOH (N)
10
HCOOH (N)
Log KD
Cu(OH)2 (N)
H3PO4 (N)
-10
-20
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.2
2.4
2.6
1000 K/T
Figure 3-6
Partitioning Constants - Neutral Species
3-13
300
200
150C
20
Partitioning Constants
10
HCI (1:1)
Log KD
NH4CI (1:1)
NaCI (1:1)
H2SO4 (1:1)
-10
NaOH (1:1)
CH3COONa (1:1)
NaH2PO4 (1:1)
NH4HSO4 (1:1)
-20
NaHSO4 (1:1)
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.2
2.4
2.6
1000 K/T
Figure 3-7
Partitioning Constants - 1:1 Compounds
Because the data in Figures 3-6 to 3-8 cannot be used simply as with the ray diagram to calculate
vaporous carryover, all of this data has been incorporated into a computer code(21). This code
allows predictions to be made of the composition of the boiler water, steam and early
condensate. Some initial examples were provided where the steam and early condensate
composition was predicted from the boiler water composition. The model can predict vaporous
carryover alone and with various degrees of mechanical carryover. Equilibrium conditions are
assumed to apply all around the water/steam circuit.
The model can be used as an excellent check on the validity of any derived boiler water limits.
Starting with the new steam limits (Table 3-1) of 2 ppb of sodium, chloride and sulfate for PC(L)
and CT, 3 ppb for PC(H), and 10 ppb for silica, the model was applied in the backwards
direction to calculate the corresponding boiler water values across a range of pH and mechanical
carryover under various PC(L), PC(H) and CT regimes to assess the impact of variations in pH
and other factors. The curves presented in the following discussions of PC(L), PC(H) and CT
represent the most conservative and restrictive limits within the range of normal chemistry
conditions allowed for each treatment.
3-14
20
Tc
300
200
150C
Partitioning Constants
10
Log KD
-10
Na2HPO4 (1:2)
-20
Na2SO4 (1:2)
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.2
2.4
2.6
1000 K/T
Figure 3-8
Partitioning Constants - 1:2 Compounds
3-15
Figure 3-9
Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of Sodium in the
boiler water. The bottom set of three curves is for conditions typical of PC(L) to ensure
less than 2 ppb sodium in steam. The upper set of three curves is for conditions typical of
PC(H) to ensure less than 3 ppb sodium in steam. In each set, the top straight line is for
mechanical carryover only. The two lower curves are at Na:PO4 = 3 (lower) and TSP + 1
ppm NaOH (higher). It should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as
boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the control curves in the
Guidelines (Section 4).
3-16
Figure 3-10
Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of Chloride in the
boiler water. The curves are representative of conditions for PC(L) to ensure less than 2
ppb chloride in steam. The top line (1) is for consideration of mechanical carryover only.
Line 3 is for Na:PO4 = 3 and includes vaporous carryover. Lines 2 and 4 are for TSP + 1
ppm NaOH and also include vaporous carryover. Line 4 represents the condition where
the chloride is limited by the sodium limit. It should be noted that the curves in this figure
are not to be used as boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the
control curves in the Guidelines (Section 4).
3-17
Figure 3-11
Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of Sulfate in the
boiler water. The bottom set of three curves is for conditions typical of PC(L) to ensure
less than 2 ppb sulfate in steam. The upper set of curves is for conditions typical of PC(H)
to ensure less than 3 ppb sulfate in steam. In each set, the top line is for mechanical
carryover only. The two lower curves are at Na:PO4 = 3 (lower) and TSP+ 1 ppm NaOH
(higher) and include vaporous carryover. It should be noted that the curves in this figure
are not to be used as boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the
control curves in the Guidelines (Section 4).
3-18
Figure 3-12
Model Predictions for the maximum pressure-dependent concentrations of Silica in the
boiler water to Ensure Less than 10 ppb Silica (as SiO2) in Steam. The curves are
representative of PC(L), PC(H) and CT. Curve 1 is for mechanical carryover only. Curve 2 is
for mechanical and vaporous carryover. It should be noted that the curves in this figure
are not to be used as boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and illustrate the
control curves in the Guidelines (Section 4).
3-19
The trends for sodium, chloride and sulfate with PC(L) indicated in Figures 3-9 to 3-11 are quite
similar to those derived for control of boiler water sodium, chloride and sulfate on PC(H);
differences in relative limit values predicted by the model are nearly in the same proportion as
the allowable steam purity limits for the two chemistry treatments.
With respect to sodium (Figure 3-9), the major feature is that mechanical carryover is the
decisive factor. Thus there is a need for each operator/chemist to correctly maintain and operate
the separation devices and know the total carryover characteristic for each drum unit. Sodium
control in the boiler water is extremely important when using PC(L) as a significant fraction of
the sodium in the steam could be present as sodium hydroxide. The figure also shows that
volatility starts to influence the sodium limit only at about 2500 psi (17.2 MPa). The limits of the
thermodynamic model are, due to the constant carryover contribution, more restrictive at lower
pressures while at higher pressures the reduced volatility predicted by the model in combination
with the lower allowable steam purity limit (2 ppb) results in less restrictive boiler water limits
than are predicted using the ray diagram and higher steam purity limit (3 ppb) used to derive the
earlier EPT Guidelines.
For chloride, Figure 3-10 illustrates that volatility is one of the influencing factors on steam
purity at pressures above about 900 psi (6.2 MPa) and becomes progressively more significant as
pressure increases. Allowable boiler water chloride levels predicted by the thermodynamic
model are considerably higher than would be allowed if volatile carryover is calculated from the
ray diagram.
For sulfate (Figure 3-11), mechanical carryover appears to be the exclusive influencing
parameter at least up to about 2700 psi (18.6 MPa). Allowable boiler water sulfate levels
predicted by the thermodynamic model are considerably higher than would be allowed if volatile
carryover is calculated from the ray diagram.
Figure 3-12 confirms that vaporous carryover is the major contributor of silica in steam. Also,
the silica data (Curve 2) show very good agreement with limits derived using the old
methodology.
Phosphate Continuum at High Phosphate Levels (> 3 ppm) (PC(H))
Figures 3-9, 3-13, 3-11 and 3-12 show the model predictions of boiler water sodium, chloride,
sulfate and silica values to ensure 3 ppb of sodium, chloride and sulfate, and 10 ppb of silica in
steam. These figures show the effect of assuming mechanical carryover in agreement with Figure
3-2. These are the upper lines in each figure. The added effect of vaporous carryover predicted
with the thermodynamic model is shown by the lower lines in each figure.
3-20
Figure 3-13
Model Predictions for Boiler Water Chloride as a Function of Pressure. The curves are
representative of conditions for PC(H) to ensure less than 3 ppb chloride in steam. The top
line (1) is for consideration of mechanical carryover only. Line 3 is for Na:PO4 = 3 and
includes vaporous carryover. Lines 2 and 4 are for TSP + 1 ppm NaOH and also include
vaporous carryover. Line 4 represents the condition where chloride is limited by the
sodium limit, but does include vaporous carryover. It should be noted that the curves in
this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits. The curves are only to verify and
illustrate the curves in the Guidelines (Section 4).
3-21
With respect to sodium (Figure 3-9), the major feature, as for PC(L), is that mechanical
carryover is the decisive factor. Thus there is a need for each operator/chemist to correctly
maintain and operate the separation devices and know the total carryover characteristic for each
drum unit. As is the case with PC(L), sodium control in the boiler water is very important when
using PC(H) as a portion of the sodium in the steam likely will be present as sodium hydroxide if
there is any free sodium hydroxide in the boiler water. The figure also shows that volatility starts
to influence the sodium limit only at about 2500 psi (17.2 MPa). The limits of the
thermodynamic model are, due to the constant carryover contribution, more restrictive at lower
pressures while at higher pressures the reduced volatility predicted by the model in combination
with the lower allowable steam purity limit (3 ppb) results in less restrictive boiler water limits
than are predicted using the ray diagram and higher steam purity limit (5 ppb) used to derive the
earlier PT Guidelines.
For chloride, Figure 3-13 illustrates that volatility is one of the influencing factors on steam
purity at pressures above about 500 psi (10.3 MPa) and becomes progressively more significant
as pressure increases. Allowable boiler water chloride levels predicted by the thermodynamic
model are remarkably similar to those calculated using volatile carryover from the ray diagram.
For sulfate (Figure 3-11), mechanical carryover appears to be the exclusive influencing
parameter at least up to about 2600 psi (17.9 MPa). Allowable boiler water sulfate levels
predicted by the thermodynamic model are higher than those calculated using volatile carryover
from the ray diagram.
Figure 3-12 confirms that vaporous carryover is the major contributor of silica in steam; the
control curves for PC(L) and PC(H) predicted with the thermodynamic model are virtually
identical.
Caustic Treatment (CT)
Figures 3-14 through 3-16, and Figure 3-12, respectively, show the model predictions of boiler
water sodium, chloride, sulfate and silica values to ensure 2 ppb of sodium, chloride and sulfate,
and 10 ppb of silica in steam. These figures show the effect of assuming mechanical carryover in
agreement with Figure 3-2. These are the upper lines in each figure. The added effect of
vaporous carryover predicted with the thermodynamic model is shown by the lower lines in each
figure.
To minimize the risk of corrosion and deposition in the turbine with CT, the limits for sodium,
chloride and sulfate in steam have all been set at 2 ppb, and those for silica at 10 ppb. The limits
for these constituents in the boiler water for CT, calculated using the thermodynamic model,
Figures 3-14 to 3-16 and Figure 3-12, respectively, are similar to those derived for PC(L), shown
in Figures 3-9 to 3-12. This is because the limits for sodium, chloride, sulfate and silica in steam
are the same for both CT and PC(L). Note how the presence of a solid alkali in the boiler water,
in this case NaOH, reduces the vaporous carryover of chloride in the steam, compared with AVT
(Figure 3-15).
3-22
With respect to sodium (Figure 3-14), the major feature is that mechanical carryover is the
decisive factor. Thus there is a need for each operator/chemist to correctly maintain and operate
the separation devices, and to know the carryover characteristics for each drum. Sodium control
in the boiler water is crucial when using CT as nearly all sodium present in the steam is likely to
be present as sodium hydroxide; it is for this reason that an upper operating limit of 2500 psi
(17.2 MPa) at the drum is imposed on CT. The figure also shows that volatility starts to influence
the sodium limit only at about 2500 psi (17.2 MPa).
For chloride, Figure 3-15 illustrates that volatility is one of the influencing factors at pressures
above about 1500 psi (10.3 MPa) and becomes progressively more significant as pressure
increases. Also, evaluations showed that chloride volatility increases as levels of sodium
hydroxide decreased, converging with predictions for AVT chemistry.
For sulfate (Figure 3-16), mechanical carryover appears to be the exclusive influencing
parameter at least up to about 2500 psi (17.2 MPa).
The curves for CT shown in Figures 3-14 to 3-16 extend to 2850 psi (19.6 MPa) so that they can
be compared to the corresponding curves for PC. However, it must be noted that CT is only
proven up to 2500 psi (17.2 MPa), and thus, the control curves given in Section 5 only extend to
2500 psi (17.2 MPa).
As with PC(L) and PC(H), Figure 3-12 confirms that vaporous carryover is the major contributor
of silica in steam.
3-23
Figure 3-14
Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sodium as a Function of Pressure. The curves are
representative of conditions for CT to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in steam. Curve 1 is
for mechanical carryover only. Curve 2 is for mechanical and vaporous carryover. It
should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits.
The curves are only to verify and illustrate the curves in the Guidelines (Section 5).
3-24
Figure 3-15
Model Predictions for Boiler Water Chloride as a Function of Pressure. The curves are
representative of the conditions for CT to ensure less than 2 ppb chloride in steam. Curve
1 is for mechanical carryover only. Curves 2 are for mechanical and vaporous carryover
with various levels of NaOH (0.5, 1.0 and 2 ppm). Curves 3 are for mechanical and
vaporous carryover for AVT conditions at different ammonia levels (pH 9, 9.2, 9.4 and 9.6).
It should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits.
The curves are only to verify and illustrate the curves in the Guidelines (Section 5).
3-25
Figure 3-16
Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sulfate as a Function of Pressure. The curves are
representative of conditions for CT to ensure less than 2 ppb sulfate in steam. Curve 1 is
for mechanical carryover only. Curve 2 is for mechanical and vaporous carryover. It
should be noted that the curves in this figure are not to be used as boiler control limits.
The curves are only to verify and illustrate the curves in the Guidelines (Section 5).
3-26
The curves for silica obtained from the thermodynamic model are similar to those already in use
and will therefore be used for boiler water silica limits in these revised guidelines.
3-27
3-28
Using the approach in Section 3.3, contaminant control curves were developed for drum units.
These curves are presented in Sections 4 and 5. By confirming these values with mechanical and
vaporous carryover (partitioning) modeling it has been possible to stress the importance of steam
carryover and boiler drum pressure to provide the concentration of the contaminant of interest.
3.4.1 Reheat Steam/Superheated Steam
Factors affecting steam chemistry, other than the mechanical and vaporous carryover from the
boiler, include the following:
precipitation of impurities as deposits in the superheater, reheater, and in the turbine due to
changes in steam temperature and pressure.
Monitoring of key contaminants at this sample point indicates the actual impurity levels in the
steam and indicates whether the turbine blades are protected against deposition and/or corrosion.
This monitoring also verifies compliance with the turbine manufacturers guarantee condition.
3-29
Should this sample point not be available, the steam chemistry may be calculated from the
chemistries of the saturated steam and feedwater, accounting for any impurity ingress associated
with the superheater and reheater attemperating water (feedwater).
Steam sampling requires special techniques, which are described in an EPRI Report(23) and in
Appendix E.
3.4.2 Saturated Steam
Monitoring of this sample point provides verification of compliance with the boiler
manufacturers performance guarantee for steam purity, which may apply only to the saturated
steam. The sample source may be from one steam offtake or all steam offtake tubes from the
drum as long as a representative sample is taken. This sample point also serves as a vital
diagnostic tool to monitor the total carryover (a core parameter) of impurities into the steam.
The saturated steam chemistry data and resulting carryover figures can also be related to the
performance of the steam drum moisture separator devices. Excessive carryover generally
indicates either poor moisture separator performance or operation with a higher than intended
water level in the steam drum. Mechanical carryover has the greatest impact upon steam
chemistry at boiler drum operating pressures below 2500 psi (17.2 MPa); for most species,
particularly for sodium and sulfate, mechanical carryover is the major component of the total
carryover. For silica and copper, however, volatile carryover is very significant, even at lower
pressures. As indicated previously, a knowledge of carryover is considered so important, that it is
now a core parameter (Table 3-2), which should be routinely checked (every six months).
As discussed in Section 3.3.1, EPRI research on volatility has shown that, for sodium, chloride
and sulfate, carryover of these constituents is almost entirely attributable to mechanical
carryover. Volatile carryover only becomes significant at the higher operating pressures. Thus, it
becomes clear that the steam purity with respect to these constituents is dependent on factors
such as the integrity of steam separator devices and drum level control. Also, at higher pressures,
the boiler water chemistry must be carefully controlled to prevent contamination of the steam.
The control curves presented in Sections 4 and 5 define boiler water conditions that will protect
both the boiler and turbine. However, the turbine protection aspect assumes that boiler carryover
is effectively controlled. As in earlier chemistry guidelines, industry mechanical carryover
criteria were used and a safety factor was applied; see Figure 3-2. Vaporous carryover was
determined with the EPRI thermodynamic model developed as a result of earlier volatility
studies (see Section 3.3.1).
To ensure that the control curves of Sections 4 and 5 are providing turbine protection it is
imperative to periodically assess boiler carryover in every drum-type unit. This involves making
a routine check of total carryover at six month intervals. Total carryover is defined as the fraction
of a given constituent in the saturated steam, expressed as a percentage of the same constituent in
the boiler water. For routine chemistry surveillance of total carryover, the determination should
be made using sodium as the selected constituent. Total carryover typically varies with boiler
load and pressure. Thus it is necessary to evaluate the total carryover under a range of operating
conditions, preferably with the boiler chemistry in normal operating limits.
3-30
Sodium monitoring in boiler water and steam may be performed with either on-line analyzers or
by laboratory analysis of grab samples. For units that meet the instrumentation criteria of Table
3-2, it will be possible to make total carryover assessments with the installed analyzers,
providing that the saturated steam sample can be directed to the sodium analyzer normally used
to monitor reheat steam or main steam. (Increased sodium readings at these sample points are a
possible indication of increased carryover from the boiler water and this may be evaluated by
checking sodium in the saturated steam.)
Once the carryover has been calculated, then the value of the sodium in boiler water for PC(L) or
PC(H) should be compared with Figure 3-9 (i.e., should be less than the values shown in Figure
3-9 to ensure that the sodium value in steam is not exceeded). The value of sodium in steam for
CT should be compared with Figure 3-14. These curves provide the overriding criteria to protect
the turbine. The boiler water sodium curves for PC(L) (Figure 4-8), PC(H) (Figure 4-17), and CT
(Figure 5-7) in Sections 4 and 5 have been designed to be the same as or lower than the sodium
values in Figures 3-9 and 3-14, respectively.
3.4.3 Boiler Water
This sample point monitors drum boiler water chemistry to minimize deposition and corrosion in
the boiler tubes. This sample point allows control of boiler water chemistry through blowdown
and chemical feed, and is a primary control point for saturated steam purity. Boiler drum samples
(either blowdown or downcomer) can be used for boiler water analysis. With some boiler
designs, the blowdown may not provide a representative boiler water sample, and the
downcomer sample should be used. The downcomer samples should also be used for cycling
units and for layup chemistry control.
Samples from the downcomer will be diluted with the feedwater, and this will reflect a lower
concentration of the various chemical species when compared to blowdown samples. This effect
may be considerable, depending on boiler design. Therefore, limits derived from downcomer
samples must reflect this dilution effect when compared to limits given in these guidelines,
which are derived for blowdown samples.
Once a satisfactory data base on total carryover is established, it may be possible to customize
the boiler limits from what is indicated in the generic control curves presented in Sections 4 and
5. If warranted, relaxation of the boiler water sodium and phosphate (for PC) limits may provide
added boiler protection, while still protecting the turbine, so long as the sodium values in Figure
3-9 for PC(L) and PC(H), and Figure 3-14 for CT, are not exceeded. Thus the need to
periodically appraise total carryover remains, regardless of whether or not the boiler limits are
customized.
On the other hand, tightening of the boiler water limits due to steam purity concerns (exceeding
the maximum allowable boiler water sodium values predicted to ensure satisfactory steam purity
as indicated in Figures 3-9 and 3-14), will compromise the boiler protection aspect of the Section
4 and 5 control curves. If total carryover testing indicates that the limits for boiler water are
impacting steam purity, it is imperative that actions be initiated as soon as possible to identify
and correct the root cause responsible for the high carryover rate.
3-31
3-32
Amount of oxygen entering the feedwater train and thus, indirectly, the air in-leakage.
For plants without condensate polishers, this point monitors the chemistry at the start of the
feedwater system. A major change was made in the new AVT Guidelines(6), which involved a
tightening of the dissolved oxygen normal target to 10 ppb. This is important for both mixedmetallurgy and all-ferrous feedwater systems and is included in these PC/CT Guidelines.
3.4.9 Condenser Leak Detection Trays and/or Hotwell Zones (if Applicable)
This sample point, if provided and available, may allow condenser tube leaks to be detected
earlier than by the sample point located at the condensate pump discharge. This aids in timely
determination of needed corrective actions. Monitoring at these leak detection tray sample points
allows determination of the tube sheet on which the leak is occurring. Quick detection and repair
of leaks minimizes the ingress of impurities into the heat cycle. Each individual condenser
hotwell section may also be monitored.
3.4.10 Air Removal System Exhaust
Condensate oxygen as well as carbon dioxide levels in condensate and low pressure feedwater
are a direct function of cycle air in-leakage activity. Air in-leakage in excess of that which can be
removed by the air removal system design will result in increased oxygen and carbon dioxide
levels, which may cause an increase in corrosion-product generation. The monitoring of air inleakage is considered so important that it has been designated a core parameter. Those
organizations that have active air in-leakage programs can easily maintain the 10 ppb oxygen
limit at the condensate pump discharge. Minimization of air in-leakage will also prevent
corrosion of the condenser shell. A further discussion on measurement of air in-leakage can be
found in Appendix C.
3-33
3-34
to determine the chemical transport characteristics of the cycle, make final selection of water
treatment approach, and establish water and steam chemistry limits.
to quantify total carryover. Note that this is a core parameter, which should be determined at
regular intervals (every six months). However, it should be determined as soon as possible if
there is a sudden change in steam purity. It should also be measured following each major
outage where inspection and repair of the drum has been conducted. Carryover should be
measured under a range of operating conditions.
There have been too many cases where unit commissioning was not performed at all or was
performed insufficiently, resulting in major equipment damage within weeks or months of the
initial operation. There have also been too many instances where a monitoring campaign was not
initiated when the feedwater or boiler water treatment was changed. Section 2 delineates clearly
the steps that are needed in either case. Typical problems that can be avoided by proper
commissioning and monitoring include:
high carryover leading to superheater, reheater, and turbine deposits and superheater and
reheater overheating failures.
dirt and debris left in the boiler or elsewhere in the system resulting in buildup of deposits or
foreign object damage.
The water chemistry-related systems and functions that should be tested during commissioning
and monitoring include:
boiler carryover,
iron and copper oxide generation and transport (determination of the points where the
corrosion occurs),
pretreatment system,
3-35
Normal. Values are consistent with longterm system reliability. A safety margin has been
provided to avoid concentration of contaminants at surfaces and under deposits.
Action Level 1. There is a potential for the accumulation of contaminants and corrosion.
Return values to normal levels within 1 week.
Action Level 2. The accumulation of impurities and corrosion will occur. Return values to
normal levels within 24 hours.
Action Level 3. Experience indicates that rapid corrosion could occur, which can be avoided
by shutdown of the unit within 4 hours.
Immediate Shutdown. There is clear evidence of rapid boiler tube damage by low boiler
water pH. Immediate shutdown of the unit is required to avoid such damage.
If the problem is not corrected within the time allotted to each action level, the next higher action
level takes effect. In drum boilers having the capability of sliding pressure operation, one way to
respond to an action level condition is to reduce boiler pressure.
The target values for Action Levels 1, 2, and 3 were established to allow and provide guidance
during transient or abnormal operating conditions. The following criteria were used for most of
the parameters:
3-36
Operation at the lowest achievable impurity levels, with the shortest and least frequent
excursions, is the most desirable mode of operation. The probability of corrosion damage and
deposit formation grows significantly with increasing impurity concentration, and the damage is
proportional to the exposure time. When corrosive impurities concentrate on metal surfaces, the
breakdown of passivity (damage to the protective oxide layer) occurs within a few minutes to
several hours. (Reheater, superheater, and boiler tubes have been destroyed within days when the
impurity concentrations have been high, in some cases as a result of improper chemical cleaning
operations or seawater ingress.)
During excursions, when the impurity concentration increases sharply, the accumulation of
impurities in the cycle (turbine deposits, boiler scale, superheater deposits) can occur quickly,
but the subsequent cleanup or return to good chemistry may take weeks. Therefore, yearly time
accumulations have also been established as a guide.
Another useful approach to damage accumulation control is to set an annual goal for all key
parameters of (contaminant concentration) x (days). Basically, this approach involves setting a
limit on the absolute amount of contaminant transport to a component per year. Contaminant
concentrations are then monitored for fixed lengths of time, multiplied by the respective
sampling periods, and totaled over the year. The yearly concentration-days calculated in this way
can then be compared with the set limit. This approach has been used to rate unit chemistry,
compare performance of multiple units, and, for some organizations, serve as an input for
assessing the need for boiler chemical cleaning. However, this approach should not be used for
accomodating preventable excursions, which amount to using up most of the allowance at one
time.
A controlled excess of free NaOH is required for CT. The limits for silica are based on the need
to limit the amount of silica carried over into the steam, based on partitioning data and the
thermodynamic model.
Concern related to possible acid phosphate corrosion and caustic under-deposit corrosion,
boiler tube damage mechanisms which do not involve contamination by impurities but instead
involve improper control of the boiler water chemistry, are thoroughly addressed by the
operating guidelines presented in Sections 4 and 5 of these guidelines. The PC treatments are
designed to avoid any possibility of a boiler experiencing acid phosphate corrosion by only
allowing additions of trisodium phosphate and NaOH. Each section includes appropriate control
limits that prevent the formation of conditions needed to initiate the relevant under-deposit
corrosion damage mechanisms.
3.7.2 Feedwater and Condensate
As discussed in detail in Section 2, there are three possible feedwater treatments:
A. Reducing. Ammonia plus a reducing agent is added after the condensate pump or
condensate polisher (if applicable). This treatment must be used for mixed-metallurgy
systems but is also used for some all-ferrous systems with poor feedwater cation conductivity
(> 0.3 S/cm). This is AVT(R).
B. Oxidizing. Ammonia is added after the condensate pump or condensate polisher (if
applicable). Addition of a reducing agent is not applicable. This is the feedwater of choice for
all-ferrous systems, especially in those units that generally have good feedwater purity
(< 0.3 S/cm) and/or may not consistently be able to meet the requirements for OT. This is
AVT(O).
C. Oxygenated. Ammonia plus oxygen is added. This is the feedwater of choice for all-ferrous
systems with a condensate polisher or with the ability to maintain feedwater cation
conductivity of less than 0.15 S/cm. This is OT. This feedwater treatment has been used on
a number of drum units operating with the CT boiler water treatment.
In conventional fossil units, the main emphasis for feedwater must be to minimize the generation
of feedwater corrosion products as these act as initiating centers for many BTF, and result in the
need to chemically clean. The secondary emphasis is to minimize FAC.
For mixed-metallurgy units, iron and copper levels of less than 2 ppb are also achievable if the
feedwater is optimized according to Section 2. This requires careful monitoring of air in-leakage
and the addition of a reducing agent after the condensate pump. Controlling ORP at the deaerator
inlet (a core parameter) can ensure that the low pressure feedwater systems will run under
(1-5)
reducing conditions (ORP < 0mV). Previous EPRI Cycle Chemistry Guidelines suggested
controlling oxygen at the CPD at less than 20 ppb, and loosely related this with air in-leakage of
less than 1 scfm/100 MW. However, the importance of maintaining a reducing environment in
the feedwater for mixed-metallurgy systems now suggests that the oxygen at the CPD should be
less than 10 ppb, independent of the air in-leakage rate. The previous limit of < 1 scfm/100 MW
is, however, still a good operating target, particularly for condenser performance purposes.
3-38
Recent research in Program Copper(24) has indicated that the optimum pH for mixed-metallurgy
systems is between 9 and 9.3 under reducing conditions.
This new CPD limit for oxygen also applies to all-ferrous systems to allow full benefit of the
oxidizing environment control. All organizations with all-ferrous systems should be striving to
meet less than 2 ppb of iron at the economizer inlet with AVT(R), at around 1 ppb with AVT(O)
and less than 1 ppb on OT. These levels are easily achievable if the processes described in
Section 2 are followed.
3-39
Attainment of suitable steam purity to protect the turbine, provided drum carryover is not
excessive (In practice this means that sodium in the boiler water must not exceed the values
provided for PC and CT in Sections 4 and 5. It should be remembered that these have been
set below the maximum allowable levels predicted in Figures 3-9 for PC(L) and PC(H) and
3-14 for CT.)
The presence of reasonable and allowable levels of chloride and sulfate in the boiler water;
contaminant levels may be monitored indirectly via conductivity when direct measurement
capabilities are unavailable.
For PC(L) and PC(H), proper control of free sodium hydroxide to allowable levels.
With routine assessment of total carryover to ensure that it is within expected values, meeting the
boiler water sodium target also ensures attainment of acceptable sodium levels in saturated
steam. Meeting the boiler water sodium target values also provides protection of the boiler from
contaminant ingress (which can lead to hydrogen damage) and minimizes the risk of
underdeposit corrosion by caustic gouging in CT.
Organizations applying the PC guidelines of Section 4 (Figure 4-8 for PC(L) and Figure 4-17 for
PC(H)) to fossil units should keep in mind that the sodium measured in boiler water represents
the total sodium, not just sodium associated with phosphate. It includes any sodium that is
associated with anionic impurities such as chloride, sulfate, and carbonate plus any free
hydroxide present as a result of caustic additions to the boiler, makeup system or condensate
polisher malfunctions, use of impure sodium hydroxide or possibly, in the case of those units
with highly alkaline cooling waters, condenser leaks. Thus it is inappropriate to use the raw
sodium and phosphate data to calculate a sodium to phosphate molar ratio in the boiler water. An
approach sometimes considered is to monitor sodium hydroxide levels in the boiler water and
use this information, along with the measured phosphate concentration to assess the sodium to
phosphate ratio. However, available procedures for sodium hydroxide analysis reportedly are not
(34,35)
completely reliable when applied to boiler water samples containing phosphate.
Determination of the sodium to phosphate ratio, and of the presence or absence of free NaOH
and thus the adherence to limits for PC requires that calculations be made, using measured boiler
water phosphate concentration and pH, corrected for the influence of ammonia at standard
conditions. Publications by Verib provide a good assessment of these relationships and how to
(35,36)
Boiler water sodium measurements are also necessary for
manage them in fossil plants.
routine control purposes, or for correction of out of specification chemistry in boiler water.
Guidance on control of PC is given in Sections 4 and 6.
3-40
Boiler water sodium target values were derived from sodium limits for the reheat/superheated
steam for PC(L), PC(H) and CT. The values for PC(H) are consistent with conventional
treatment practice for lower pressure boilers but are lower than commonly maintained in practice
for higher pressure boilers. These lower values have been included not only in consideration of
steam purity but also to reduce problems with phosphate hideout during load changes. Lower
sodium, and consequently, lower phosphate, have been found to reduce the severity of hideout.
Although this practice gives less buffering capacity for contaminants introduced by condenser
tube leakage, adherence to the guidelines throughout the rest of the cycle will diminish the need
for excess buffering capacity. Phosphate levels consistent with the sodium target values in the
guidelines will provide adequate capacity when all other boiler target values are being met.
Target values for PC(L) provide less boiler protection than those for PC(H), however, they both
require and allow for better steam purity control, which is crucial in high pressure drum-type
units. Operation with free sodium hydroxide in the boiler water increases the boiler protection
but this sodium can be introduced to the steam with mechanical carryover. The contribution of 1
ppm of free sodium hydroxide in boiler water as a function of the pressure is shown in Figures 317 and 3-18. This is allowed with PC(H) and PC(L) when included in the total allowable sodium
permissible to ensure suitable steam purity under PC(H) and PC(L) chemistries. Thus the
importance of monitoring sodium in the boiler water to avoid steam purity excursions becomes
apparent; it is especially critical at higher pressures.
3-41
Figure 3-17
Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sodium as a Function of Pressure when Operating with
PC(H) to ensure less than 3 ppb sodium in steam at Na:PO4 = 3, and also the contribution
from 1 ppm NaOH, if added. The top curve is the same as shown in Figure 3-9. Note: these
curves should not be used for boiler water control; they are provided to illustrate the
effects of sodium in boiler water. The control curves for PC(H) are provided in Section 4.
3-42
Figure 3-18
Model Predictions for Boiler Water Sodium as a Function of Pressure when Operating with
PC(L) to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in steam at Na:PO4 = 3, and also the contribution
from 1 ppm NaOH, if added. The top curve is the same as shown in Figure 3-9. Note: these
curves should not be used for boiler water control; they are provided to illustrate the
effects of sodium in boiler water. The control curves for PC(L) are provided in Section 4.
3-43
A minimum phosphate concentration for boiler water of 0.2 ppm as phosphate has been
established for PC(L) in recognition of the limited neutralization and pH buffering capabilities of
this treatment. An upper limit for phosphate for PC(H) is around 10 ppm as PO4, however, steam
purity concerns and hideout characteristics will effectively constrain the practical upper limit of
PC(H) at higher boiler operating pressures.
Further discussion of the boiler water phosphate target values for PC is provided in Section 3.8.2.
Target values for CT have been selected to provide better boiler protection than is possible with
PC(L) but not as good as with PC(H). As with PC(L), the associated steam purity requirements
for CT are more stringent than for PC(H). As discussed in Section 5, this allows CT to be used in
many high pressure drum-type units. Key aspects of the rationale for CT, presented in Section
3.3, and reflected in the operating guidelines presented in Section 5, may be summarized as
follows.
Steam purity must be controlled to ensure that concentrations of sodium, chloride and sulfate
are less than 2 ppb.
Total carryover monitoring (at least every six months) is routinely performed to ensure the
steam purity remains satisfactory.
Routine control of boiler water chemistry is based on monitoring of the pH, sodium, and
conductivity (cation and/or specific).
Results for pH and sodium provide an indication of the treatment control while sodium also
is useful in steam purity control; the conductivity readings are used to identify contaminant
levels and must be controlled to protect the boiler.
Although no absolute minimum free caustic level is indicated, the intent is to maintain the
sodium hydroxide concentration at least 2.5 times the chloride concentration. (It should be
kept in mind that the degree of boiler protection lessens as the caustic concentration
decreases; complete loss of free caustic in the boiler water results in the same degree of
boiler protection, essentially none, afforded by AVT.)
At low sodium hydroxide levels the pH is influenced by ammonia entering the boiler with the
feedwater; see Figure 5-12. The allowable corrected pH is dependent on the measured
sodium hydroxide concentration and should never be less than 9.0.
In Section 5, lower limits for pH, specific conductivity and sodium hydroxide concentration
are shown as dashed lines in order to provide guidance on the minimum pH. The area
between the dashed line and Action Level 1 should be taken as the normal operating zone.
Sodium analysis of units on CT can also be useful in identifying and responding to incidents of
caustic hideout. Although less common than sodium phosphate hideout, hideout of caustic is
occasionally observed in units that operate on CT. Section 5 characterizes caustic hideout and
provides guidance on how to deal with it.
3-44
For PC and CT, higher treatment levels are permitted by the action levels during excursions but
are limited in duration since these higher levels only buffer boiler water pH and will not deter the
carryover of corrodents such as chlorides and sulfates into the turbine when their boiler water
concentrations exceed target values.
Sodium Target Value in Condensate and Makeup Water
Low sodium levels are required for condensate and makeup water for the following reasons:
To achieve recommended steam purity under normal operation without routinely relying on
boiler blowdown capability (which remains available to control transients) and maintain the
chemistry within guidelines at all times.
Limits on sodium concentration in the condensate can be more relaxed for units with condensate
polishers than for units without polishers, however, it is not advisable to operate for extended
periods with contaminated condensate, even in units with polishers. Monitoring of condensate
polisher effluent (where applicable) for sodium is useful in evaluating polisher performance.
Sodium Target Value in Condensate Storage Tank Effluent (Aluminum Tanks Only)
Corrosion of aluminum condensate storage tanks can occur in the presence of free sodium
hydroxide. Aluminum corrosion products form difficult-to-remove boiler tube and turbine
deposits. Free sodium hydroxide may be present in the condensate storage tank whenever sodium
levels become excessive. The major sources of sodium in the condensate are from the makeup
treatment system effluent and from condenser leakage. The sodium level in condensate storage
tank effluent should be comparable to that in makeup treatment system effluent.
3.8.2 Phosphate Target in Boiler Water
Monitoring of boiler water phosphate when using PC is necessary for the following reasons:
The sodium-to-phosphate molar ratio determines the control point relative to the pH/PO4
curves (as illustrated in Figure 1-7), and
Acid phosphate corrosion is a concern if the boiler water is operated with low sodium-tophosphate ratios.
Corrosive conditions may result from the concentration of either low ratio phosphate treatment
chemicals or excessive free NaOH beneath porous magnetite and other boiler wall deposits, and
in steam blanketed areas. This may lead to tube damage by corrosion and failures in boilers with
accumulated waterside (porous) deposits.
3-45
Careful consideration should be given to avoid the feed of excessive amounts of treatment
chemicals in PC(H) units. As discussed previously this may result in hideout, but will not result
in corrosion if only trisodium phosphate is added as the phosphate addition. Studies have now
shown that the hideout behavior under acceptably clean conditions is very different than when
excessive deposits are present. The deposits are essentially magnetite but can also contain other
corrosion products from different pre-boiler construction materials.
Key aspects of the rationale for PC, presented in Sections 1 and 3.3, and reflected in the
operating guidelines presented in Section 4, may be summarized as follows.
High pressure boilers will generally need to be operated at the lower end of the PC, normally
in the region designated PC(L). While this treatment offers a limited boiler protection
capability, it must also ensure that steam of satisfactory purity is generated for expansion in
the turbine.
Low pressure boilers can usually be operated at the higher end of the PC, in the region
designated PC(H); this treatment offers additional neutralization and buffering capacity to
protect the boiler and also has less stringent steam purity criteria that are considered
sufficient to protect the turbine.
Trisodium phosphate is the only phosphate-based chemical used with PC; sodium hydroxide
may be added as needed to control the pH while maintaining a free sodium hydroxide
residual of up to 1 ppm as NaOH. Attention must be given to Section 3.8.1, and particularly
to Figures 3-17 and 3-18 to ensure compliance with steam sodium limits.
Phosphate hideout is possible with either PC(H) or PC(L); chasing of hideout with repetitious
additions of chemicals is not required and should be discouraged.
A minimum allowable boiler water phosphate concentration of 0.2 ppm as PO4 has been
established, in recognition of the need for a minimum limit on boiler protection in the event
of contaminant ingress; maintaining some free sodium hydroxide is especially desirable
when phosphate concentrations are < 1 ppm as PO4. The minimum boiler water pH is 9.0. If
for some reason a high pressure boiler can only operate with phosphate levels below 0.2
ppm, then it is suggested that the boiler water treatment is converted to CT or AVT. Section
2.3 provides the necessary guidance.
As discussed in Section 1, PC should be regarded as having the two extremes of PC(L) and
PC(H), which behave and react in very different ways. A loose transition between these two
extremes has been suggested at about 3 ppm PO4. The maximum allowable phosphate
concentration for PC(H) is 10 ppm as PO4, however, not all boilers will be able to operate
over the entire range for PC(H), due to steam purity constraints (sodium as indicated in
Figure 4-17), or excessive hideout and return of phosphate.
Routine control of boiler water chemistry is based on monitoring of the pH, phosphate,
sodium, and conductivity (cation and/or specific; see examples in Figures 4-13 and 4-14 for
PC(L), and Figures 4-23 and 4-24 for PC(H)).
Results for pH and phosphate, provide an indication of the treatment control, while sodium is
useful in steam purity control and as a general indicator of contamination; the conductivity
readings are used to identify and track changes in contaminant levels and must be controlled
to protect the boiler.
3-46
At the low phosphate levels associated with PC(L), the pH is strongly influenced by
ammonia entering the boiler with the feedwater; see Figures 4-3 and 4-4; as indicated in
Figure 4-4, the influence of ammonia on pH is less pronounced when the boiler water
contains free sodium hydroxide. The pH correction may be determined directly from the
measured pH and ammonia values using Figure 4-5. The ammonia effect is also discussed in
Section 3.8.10.
The influence of ammonia on pH is less significant when the boiler water phosphate
concentration is above about 3 ppm as PO4; thus the effect of ammonia on boiler water pH is
generally not of as great a concern when employing PC(H).
3.8.3 Chloride
Monitoring of chloride is necessary, especially for troubleshooting, because chloride contributes
to the following:
synergistic effect on drum boiler waterwall corrosion in the presence of oxygen and copper
oxide
3-47
For the volatility and speciation in ammonium chloride solutions, it is important to remember
that the solute transports to the steam as mixtures of HCl, NH3 and NH4Cl, the relative
proportions being dependent on temperature, total chloride, solution pH and presence of other
cations (e.g. Na+). The difference in pH and the increasing volatility of HCl, accounts for the
increased importance of chloride as HCl at high temperatures.
Chloride Target Value in Makeup Water
The makeup water target value of 3 ppb is necessary for the following reasons:
to achieve recommended steam purity under normal operation without depending on boiler
blowdown, leaving the full blowdown capability available to control transients and maintain
the chemistry within guidelines at all times, and
This target value should be modified if necessary to be consistent with the capabilities of the
makeup treatment equipment design.
3.8.4 Sulfate
Monitoring of sulfate is necessary for troubleshooting purposes for the following reasons:
sulfate can deposit in reheaters and subsequently lead to pitting during non-protected
shutdown periods.
Grab sample analysis is normally used to assess sulfate, supplemented by indirect on-line
continuous analysis by cation conductivity.
Sulfate Target Value in Steam
(9-12)
Based on the turbine deposition studies, and that the solubility of sodium sulfate in
superheated steam is estimated to be similar to that of sodium chloride, and acid sulfate is as
corrosive as acid chloride, the same limits were chosen for sulfate in steam (2 ppb for PC(L) and
CT, 3 ppb for PC(H)) as those for chloride.
3-48
Although H2SO4 can be considered as a 1:1 compound or a 1:2 compound, at high temperatures,
it behaves more as a 1:1 compound. Sulfuric acid was found to be the dominant form of sulfur
(VI) species in steam under most conditions and is the principal transporting medium for the
(21)
vaporous carryover of sulfate in steam .
Reduced sulfur species (SO2) were observed in all vapor samples taken over sulfuric acid
solutions. The partitioning coefficients for SO2 obtained from the sulfuric acid volatility data,
showed that with increasing pH, the hydrolysis of the weaker sulfurous acid becomes significant
and the level of sulfite decreases in the vapor phase. Sulfur dioxide is a neutral specie and is very
volatile (Figure 3-6). Reduced sulfur species may provide an important route for the transport of
sulfate and sulfite to the steam. Thus the carryover of sulfate should be significantly reduced for
plants with oxygenated treatment by eliminating SO2 transport.
It is also interesting to compare the figures for chloride and sulfate in Section 3.3.1, which show
the predictions from the thermodynamic partitioning code. Higher values of sulfate in boiler
water are required than for chloride in boiler water to generate 2 ppb in steam.
Sulfate Target Value in Makeup Water
The makeup water sulfate target value of 3 ppb is necessary for the following reasons:
to achieve recommended steam purity under normal operation without relying upon boiler
blowdown, leaving the full blowdown capability available to control transients and maintain
the chemistry within guidelines at all times, and
This target value should be modified, if necessary, to be consistent with the capabilities of the
makeup treating equipment.
3-49
3.8.5 Silica
Monitoring of silica is necessary for the following reasons:
precipitation of silica forms silicate deposits on the turbine that are not soluble in water and
are very difficult to remove;
significant amounts of silica can enter the condensate/feedwater undetected in the nonreactive colloidal form through the makeup, causing boiler water and steam target values to
be exceeded in spite of apparently good-quality makeup.
To achieve recommended steam purity under normal operation without relying on boiler
blowdown, leaving the full blowdown capability available to control transients and maintain
the chemistry within guidelines at all times, and
This target value should be modified if necessary to be consistent with the capabilities of the
makeup treating equipment design.
3-50
Copper alloy corrosion in condensate and feedwater systems is controlled by ORP. The value
of ORP is influenced by the levels of oxygen and reducing agent in the feedwater and by pH.
In all-ferrous feedwater systems, very low levels of oxygen (<1 ppb) in conjunction with
high levels of reducing agent (hydrazine or alternative) result in very strong reducing
(26)
conditions. Under such conditions, the feedwater reacts with the ferrous alloys in the
feedwater system to generate corrosion products. These corrosion products are subsequently
transported to the boiler, which leads to a) increased chemical cleaning requirements, and b)
increased risk of boiler waterwall tube failures by under-deposit corrosion.
Many plants with all-ferrous feedwater systems operate without the use of reducing agents,
and have significantly reduced iron transport.
3-51
3-52
3.8.9 pH
Boiler water pH is a core monitoring parameter. Monitoring of pH is necessary for the following
reasons:
corrosion of cycle materials in contact with feedwater and boiler water is a function of pH,
and
alkaline pH values increase the stability of the magnetite film and reduce magnetite solubility
in water.
pH Control
It is important to keep in mind that ammonia treatment of the feedwater (alkaline AVT (R) or
AVT (O)) is intended to reduce general corrosion and FAC in the pre-boiler system. However,
ammonia (or ammonium hydroxide) provides minimal, if any, neutralizing effect in the boiler
water. Ammonium hydroxide is essentially fully associated at boiler operating temperatures. It,
therefore, does not materially contribute to neutralizing possible acidic feedwater contaminants
that may be available to concentrate beneath porous oxide waterwall tube deposits. Alkali solids
(trisodium phosphate and/or sodium hydroxide) are added to the boiler water to neutralize any
acidic contaminants that may be present. However, at typical sampling conditions, ammonia in
boiler water samples is partially dissociated and therefore affects the pH. For this reason extreme
care should be taken in the measurement of pH from the standpoint of both sample temperature
(25C, 77F) and proper calibration of electrodes in an on-line measurement system. The effect
of ammonia in the sample on the measured boiler water pH is discussed in the next section.
pH Target Values in Boiler Water
The measured pH in conditioned boiler water samples will be influenced by ammonia. This
effect is most pronounced under PC(L) and under CT when levels of sodium hydroxide are less
than one ppm. For effective surveillance and control of PC and CT, a correction for the influence
of ammonia should be made.
By measuring the boiler water pH and ammonia concentration, it is possible to calculate the
corrected pH value, by manipulation of the relationship between the concentration of hydrogen
and hydroxide ions in the water; the following approach has been described by Verib that is
(35)
useful in defining the basic relationships involved :
pH = -log[H]
(eq. 3-6)
pH + pOH = 14
(eq. 3-7)
Concentrations are expressed in moles per liter. Be rearranging, it is possible to express the OH
concentration as a function of the pH:
-14
-pH
[OH] = 10 /10
(eq. 3-8)
3-53
To this point, all terms relate to initial measurement of the pH in the boiler water. The following
equations may be applied to calculate the corrected pH by subtracting the influence of the
measured ammonia concentration, also expressed in moles per liter:
[OH]c = [OH]m [NH3]m
(eq. 3-9)
pOHc = -log[OH]c
(eq. 3-10)
pHc = 14 pOHc
(eq. 3-11)
In this series of equations, [OH]m is the value calculated in equation 3-8 using the measured pH.
Terms with the subscript c denote corrected values, as determined by calculcation.
The corrected pH, if determined by this methodology is, at best, a rough estimate, since not all of
the ammonia measured in the boiler water sample will dissociate to ammonium and hydroxide
ions. Complete dissociation of ammonia is assumed by direct substitution of the measured
ammonia concentration in Equation 3-9. The actual degree of ammonia hydrolysis is incomplete
and variable in conditioned samples, influenced by both sample temperature and concentrations
of ammonia and alkali treatments present. These influences are considered in the EPRI
thermodynamic model used to develop Figures 4-3 and 4-4 presented in Section 4 for PC and
Figure 5-12 in Section 5 for CT.
While Figure 5-12 may be readily used to determine the influence of ammonia on pH when
employing CT, the situation is more complicated in the case of PC, where both phosphate and
sodium hydroxide may be present, resulting in a spectrum of sodium to phosphate ratios
intermediate to the relationships shown in Figures 4-3 (only trisodium phosphate) and Figure 4-4
(trisodium phosphate plus 1 ppm of caustic.) To facilitate correction of pH for the effects of
ammonia, Figure 4-5 has been developed, which can be used for PC(L), PC(H) and CT. The
derivation process is described in detail in Appendix G. The corrected pH, that is, the pH that
would be produced by the chemical treatment in the absence of the ammonia can be determined
as a function of the measured pH value at various measured ammonia concentrations and
independent of the actual measured phosphate concentration. However, to use the figure for
diagnostic purposes the boiler water phosphate concentrations should be verified to be within the
range (0.210 ppm) required when operating with PC.
Proper use of Figure 4-5 is addressed in Subsection 4.2.1, Introduction to PC(L). However, the
figure is applicable to the entire PC working range and thus may also be used with PC(H) if
desired. Comparison of pH correction results obtained with Figure 5-12 for CT with those of
Figure 4-5 shows satisfactory agreement. This result was anticipated, since dissociation of
trisodium phosphate to disodium phosphate and sodium hydroxide is nearly complete within the
pH range of interest at standard sample temperature (25C (77F). However, derivation of a
corrected pH equation of CT (based only on sodium hydroxide and ammonia) was performed (as
discussed further in Appendix G) to confirm this consistency. Thus under normal treatment
conditions, and with accurate measurement of boiler water pH and ammonia, the ammonia
specific correction curves shown in Figure 4-5 are applicable to operation with CT as well as PC.
3-54
When managing boiler water chemistry, it must also be kept in mind that errors in measurement
of the boiler water parameters needed to determine corrected pH may be significant and will thus
affect the results obtained when making the pH correction. General guidance on chemistry data
quality is included in Appendix E.
Immediate shutdown is recommended for low drum boiler water pH of less than 8 (as measured)
and descending. Immediate shutdown is recommended since the pH will generally be much
lower locally, which could lead to severe localized attack on waterwall tubes depending on the
local conditions, particularly if the waterwall tubes are dirty and boiler chemical cleaning is due.
pH Target Values in Feedwater
The corrosion rate of carbon steel reaches minimum values over the pH range of 9.2 to 9.6. The
optimal pH for protection of copper has been researched extensively over the last 5 years and is
dependent upon temperature and ORP. Thus systems having mixed-metallurgy should now be
able to minimize the corrosion rate of both carbon steel and the copper alloy by maintaining the
condensate/feedwater pH between 9.0 and 9.3 under reducing conditions. The feedwater pH can
be affected by carbon dioxide which enters with air in-leakage (Figure 3-26).
For units with condensate polishers in H-OH form, polisher run lengths decrease significantly at
higher pH values. Operation at the lower end of the feedwater pH range may be necessary to
maintain reasonable condensate polisher run lengths and acceptable effluent quality when using
hydrogen form cation resins. Operation in the ammonia form will maximize run lengths at the
expense of somewhat higher sodium leakage (normally within guidelines for sodium).
3.8.10 Ammonia
Monitoring of ammonia can be used to supplement the direct measurement of feedwater pH
and/or specific conductivity for the control of the ammonia feed rate. It also influences the pH of
samples from boilers operating on PC and CT (Section 3.8.9). Curves displaying these effects, as
determined by the thermodynamic model, are presented and discussed in Sections 4 and 5
(Figures 4-3 to 4-5 for PC, and Figure 5-12 for CT).
For plants containing copper alloys in the condensate/feedwater systems, monitoring of ammonia
is also important to minimize ammonia attack on copper alloys (particularly when oxygen and
carbon dioxide are present), and particularly in the air removal section of the condenser.
3-55
3-56
3-57
It should be noted that the curves presented in these figures correspond to selected phosphate
concentrations at sodium to phosphate molar ratios of 3.0 with no free sodium hydroxide present;
the allowable specific conductivity limits suggested by these figures would change with
variations in treatment chemical (including ammonia) inventories and be influenced by
contaminant inventories actually present in the boiler water. Also, steam purity could become an
issue in boilers at the higher operating pressures unless the mechanical carryover rate is lower
than that used to establish the guidelines.
Figure 3-19
Specific Conductivity as a Function of Phosphate Level with Varying Na:PO4 ratios and
TSP + 1 ppm NaOH. No influence of ammonia is included. It should also be noted that the
curve for H3PO4 crresponds to cation conductivity.
3-58
Figure 3-20
Estimates of Specific Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(L). The lower curve reflects
the conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is based on the
phosphate concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration given in Figure 3-18
to ensure less than 2 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve reflects the situation with
additional chloride and sulfate in the boiler water. Note: these curves must not be used for
boiler water control; they are provided here to assist the reader to develop a set of specific
conductivity control curves in Section 4 for PC(L).
3-59
Figure 3-21
Estimate of Specific Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(H). The lower curve reflects the
conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is based on the phosphate
concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration given in Figure 3-17 to ensure
less than 3 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve reflects the situation with additional
chloride and sulfate in the boiler water. Note: these curves must not be used for boiler
water control; they are provided here to assist the reader to develop a set of specific
conductivity control curves in Section 4 for PC(H).
3-60
Personnel responsible for operation of fossil units on PC(L) and PC(H) are encouraged to
monitor boiler water specific conductivity and examine the correlation this parameter displays
with respect to pH, phosphate and sodium levels. Over time, this should lead to a better
understanding of normal readings for each individual boiler. Once this is known, samples of
boiler water should be tested for chloride and sulfate to verify that the accepted normal specific
conductivity readings also ensure satisfactory control of these parameters within the target values
indicated in Section 4.
Specific conductivity will increase as a result of several factors, such as addition of phosphate or
caustic to the boiler water or increases in the feedwater ammonia dosing rate. Increasing specific
conductivity that is not related to chemical feed activity is most likely due to contamination
entering the boiler with the feedwater; phosphate concentrations will begin to fall if the
contamination includes any hardness. In most instances, the contamination can be readily
identified and responded to if the cycle chemistry program includes the appropriate
instrumentation and operator response procedures. However, in many fossil units, extremely low
level contamination is a chronic problem that can lead to concentration of impurities in the boiler
water to levels capable of initiating corrosion damage. A longterm trend of increase in the
conductivity readings may be the only indication that a problem exists until the damage produces
failures. As suggested by Figures 3-20 and 3-21, allowable specific conductivity increases
associated with contamination are fairly low and become increasingly restrictive at increased
operating pressures.
Organizations seeking to establish unit specific limits for boiler specific conductivity are
encouraged to dose the boiler to the maximum allowable phosphate and free sodium hydroxide
levels; this should be done carefully and with the blowdown closed or at the normal minimum
setting since overfeed will require opening the blowdown, which will impact subsequent
sampling and analysis activities. Once this treatment level is established the conductivity should
be checked and samples collected for analysis of chlorides and sulfates. The effect of treatment
on steam purity will also need to be checked at this time. By using this data and the information
presented in this section, it will then be possible to establish site specific limits that will require
blowing down the boiler before contaminants increase to levels that put the boiler at risk. As
continual reliance on blowdown is costly and limits flexibility in response to more serious
chemistry excursions, personnel responsible for the unit are advised to identify and correct
sources of chronic contamination at the earliest possible opportunity. Examples of boiler water
specific conductivity control curves for PC are provided in Section 4 (Figure 4-13 for PC(L) and
Figure 4-23 for PC(H)).
As with other parameters, it is very important to customize the specific conductivity limits for
each boiler as just outlined. This is included in the road map to optimize PC and CT in Section 2.
In summary, neither specific or cation conductivity give unambiguous results for PC, and thus
there is a need to also check pH and phosphate. It is difficult to separate the individual
contributions of phosphate and impurity anions on conductivity with PC. It is much easier with
CT since there is no contribution from phosphate. With CT, specific and cation conductivity can
give a good indication of pH, free NaOH (Figure 5-11) and anionic contamination.
3-61
3-62
AVT limits on maximum allowable boiler water impurity concentrations to minimize corrosion
in the boiler are based on longstanding fossil plant experience with boiler water cation
conductivity around the world(6). It is possible to calculate the concentrations of chloride and
sulfate from cation conductivity, provided the proportions of these and the other anions present
are known. However, these proportions vary from plant to plant and operating conditions,
thereby requiring that the proportion be assumed. As it is known that chloride represents a
greater risk than sulfate in initiating corrosion, the concentration of sulfate has been taken as
twice that of chloride when calculating the limits from cation conductivity. Note that the 1:2
concentration ratio for chloride:sulfate corresponds to a 40/60 stoichiometric ratio. Taking less
than 50% ratio for chloride also makes some allowance for the fact that the cation conductivity
(6)
includes other impurities. This approach was used in EPRIs new AVT Guidelines .
In order to develop cation conductivity curves for the high and low phosphate extremes of PC, it
is necessary to consider the effect of the phosphate on the measured cation conductivity value;
hydroxides have no effect on this parameter. It is also necessary to assess the level of
contamination that the alkali solid in the boiler water is capable of neutralizing and/or buffering.
The cation conductivity control curves for PC(L) and PC(H), and CT determine these effects and
then overlay the cation conductivity associated with the allowable (un-neutralized and/or unbuffered) contaminants (based on and as used with AVT) to define the boiler water limit values.
The sodium boiler water control curves presented in Sections 4 and 5 are based on maximum
permissible levels of chloride and sulfate in the boiler water assuming they are present as sodium
salts. They also account for additional sodium associated with allowable levels of any phosphate
and free hydroxide in the boiler water. For PC this allowable concentration is 1 ppm sodium
hydroxide as NaOH while for caustic treatment it ranges from 1-3 ppm sodium hydroxide as
NaOH depending on the pressure. Effects of other contaminants that may be present (such as
carbon dioxide and organics) on boiler water cation conductivity are also considered.
In units where boiler water sodium is not routinely monitored, there is risk of caustic corrosion if
free sodium hydroxide is present in the boiler water at higher than intended levels. This is one
reason why sodium is a core parameter (Table 3-1). Boiler water pH limits are set to avoid
excessive free hydroxide conditions but this parameter is affected by ammonium hydroxide for
all of the alkali solid treatments. Like ammonium hydroxide, sodium hydroxide affects the
specific conductivity of the boiler water but not the cation conductivity. Thus, for indirect,
conductivity-based monitoring and control of free sodium hydroxide in boiler water in units that
do not monitor sodium directly, it may desirable to monitor the specific conductivity as
discussed in Section 3.8.11.
Thus, the measurement of cation conductivity in the blowdown or downcomer provides a reliable
on-line indication of the level of contamination entering the boiler and concentrating by
recirculation. For this reason, plant operators can rely on this measurement to initiate control
measures to mitigate the undesirable effects associated with increasing levels of contamination.
Corrective action, typically blowing down and/or pressure reduction, is needed when increased
contaminant levels are observed even if there is no apparent change in boiler water pH or
chemical treatment levels.
3-63
It should be kept in mind that samples from the downcomers will be diluted by feedwater to a
level dependent on the boiler recirculation ratio. Care should be taken to ensure optimum sample
flow rate and temperature control.
The boiler cation conductivity control curves, which are discussed in Sections 4 and 5, and are
designed to protect the boiler from corrosion. They are currently based on experience of limiting
the concentrations of impurities in the boiler water to minimize corrosion as well as the effects of
the alkali solid treatments in use. They indirectly consider the boiler water chloride and sulfate
levels as a function of pressure together with a number of other contributors such as organic
acids, carbonates, etc. For PC, phosphate and contaminant anions all affect the cation
conductivity, making it difficult to assess the individual contributions without further data (pH
and phosphate). With CT, cation conductivity provides a direct indication of anionic
contamination.
Cation conductivity control curves have been constructed for CT (Figure 5-4). It is much more
difficult to construct similar curves for PC since the measured cation conductivity is strongly
influenced by the phosphate concentration, which increases by a factor of 50 over the entire PC
operating range. Thus it becomes very difficult for EPRI to produce generic control curves that
are applicable to all or even most fossil units. Figures 3-22 and 3-23 show the results of estimates
for boiler water cation conductivity under PC(L) and PC(H) conditions. Each figure includes two
curves; the lower curves indicate the cation conductivity attributable only to the phosphate, while
the upper curves reflect the conductivity associated with the same level of phosphate and an
additional maximum allowable level of chloride and sulfate in the boiler water. It should be
noted that the curves presented in these figures correspond to a selected phosphate concentration
at sodium to phosphate molar ratios of 3.0; the allowable cation conductivity limits suggested by
these figures would change with variations in treatment chemical inventories (although cation
conductivity is not affected by sodium hydroxide or ammonia) and be influenced by contaminant
inventories actually present in the boiler water. Also, steam purity could become an issue in
boilers at the higher operating pressures unless the mechanical carryover rate is lower than that
used to establish the guidelines.
At present, cation conductivity is often not measured in the boiler water of fossil units that utilize
phosphate treatments. As was indicated earlier for specific conductivity, personnel responsible
for operation of fossil units on PC(L) and PC(H) are encouraged to monitor boiler water cation
conductivity and examine the correlation this parameter displays with respect to pH, phosphate
and sodium levels. Over time, this should lead to a better understanding of normal readings for
each individual boiler. Once this is known, samples of boiler water should be tested for chloride
and sulfate to verify that the accepted normal cation conductivity readings also ensure
satisfactory control of these parameters within the target values indicated in Section 4.
3-64
Cation conductivity will increase as a result of addition of phosphate to the boiler water.
Increasing cation conductivity that is not related to chemical feed activity is most likely due to
contamination entering the boiler with the feedwater; phosphate concentrations will begin to fall
if the contamination includes any hardness. In most instances, the contamination can be readily
identified and responded to if the cycle chemistry program includes the appropriate
instrumentation and operator response procedures. However, in many fossil units, extremely low
level contamination is a serious problem that can lead to concentration of impurities in the boiler
water to levels capable of initiating corrosion damage. A longterm trend of increase in the
conductivity readings may be the only indication that a problem exists until the damage produces
failures. Figures 3-24 and 3-25 show the cation conductivity values versus pressure for PC(L)
and PC(H) only taking into account the maximum (normal) levels of chloride and sulfate (1:2
ratio). No contribution of phosphate is included.
Organizations seeking to establish unit limits for boiler cation conductivity are encouraged to
dose the boiler to the maximum allowable phosphate concentration; this should be done carefully
and with the blowdown closed or at the normal minimum setting since overfeed will require
opening the blowdown, which will impact subsequent sampling and analysis activities. Once this
treatment level is established the cation conductivity should be checked and samples collected
for analysis of chlorides and sulfates. The effect of treatment on steam purity will also need to be
checked at this time. By using this data and the information presented in this section it will then
be possible to establish site specific limits that will require blowing down the boiler and/or
reduction of pressure before contaminants increase to levels that put the boiler at risk. As
continual reliance on blowdown is costly and limits flexibility in response to more serious
chemistry excursions, personnel responsible for the unit are advised to identify and correct
sources of chronic contamination at the earliest possible opportunity. Examples of boiler water
cation conductivity control curves for PC are provided in Section 4 (Figure 4-14 for PC(L) and
Figure 4-24 for PC(H)).
Calculation of boiler water cation conductivity limits for PC(L) and PC(H) at a drum pressure of
2500 psi (17.2 MPa) and 0.18% carryover has been performed and reported to be around 10 and
(28)
25 S/cm, respectively ; similar values are indicated in Figures 4-14 and 4-24. It will be noted
that these values reflect considerably different capacities to cope with boiler contamination. The
cation conductivity value for PC(L) (10 S/cm) at a normal chloride limit of 150 ppb is about the
same as for CT (see Figure 5-4) (about 9 S/cm) at a normal chloride limit of 300 ppb, while the
value for PC(H) is more than double that permissible with CT. The relative levels of boiler
protection available with these treatments is reflected in both the continuum of treatments
(Figure 2-1) and the boiler water treatment selection road map (Figure 2-8) presented and
discussed in Section 2.
As with other parameters, it is very important to establish customized cation conductivity limits
for each boiler as just outlined. This is included in the road map to optimize PC and CT in
Section 2.
3-65
Figure 3-22
Estimates of Cation Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(L). The lower curve reflects the
conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is based on the phosphate
concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration given in Figure 3-18 to ensure
less than 2 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve reflects the situation with additional
chloride and sulfate present in the boiler water. Note: these curves must not be used for
boiler control; they are provided here to assist the reader to develop a set of cation
conductivity control curves in Section 4 for PC(L).
3-66
Figure 3-23
Estimates of Cation Conductivity Against Pressure for PC(H). The lower curve reflects the
conductivity if only phosphate is present in the boiler water. It is based on the phosphate
concentration corresponding to the sodium concentration given in Figure 3-17 to ensure
less than 3 ppb sodium in steam. The upper curve reflects the situation with additional
chloride and sulfate present in the boiler water. Note: these curves must not be used for
boiler control; they are only provided here to assist the reader to develop a set of cation
conductivity control curves in Section 4 for PC(H).
3-67
Figure 3-24
Cation Conductivity Versus Pressure for PC(L) only taking into account the maximum
(normal) levels of chloride and sulfate (1:2 ratio). It must be noted that any contribution
from phosphate has been excluded.
Note: These curves must not be used for boiler control; they are provided here only to
assist the reader to develop a set of cation conductivity control curves in Section 4 for
PC(L).
3-68
Figure 3-25
Cation Conductivity Versus Pressure for PC(H) only taking into account the maximum
(normal) levels of chloride and sulfate (1:2 ratio). It must be noted that any contribution
from phosphate has been excluded.
Note: These curves must not be used for boiler control; they are provided here only to
assist the reader to develop a set of cation conductivity control curves in Section 4 for
PC(H).
3-69
3-70
For mixed-metallurgy systems it is necessary to maintain low levels of dissolved oxygen (< 10
ppb) in the feedwater and utilize a reducing agent in order to maintain reducing conditions to
minimize copper transport. ORP monitoring must be used to ensure that a reducing condition is
maintained at all times. ORP is a core parameter for mixed-metallurgy systems. A reducing
environment (-300 to -350 mV) at the deaerator inlet is necessary to minimize copper transport.
Total Iron and Copper Limits
The total iron and copper limits are based on the minimum values practically achievable and on
the solubility of iron in water and steam, and of copper and its oxides in superheated steam (to
avoid deposition in the turbine). Meeting these limits requires that the feedwater chemistry be
periodically and properly selected and optimized.
Monitoring Considerations
Although not core monitoring parameters, iron and copper are extremely important diagnostic
parameters. Any routine monitoring or more rigorous monitoring campaign conducted to assess
the performance of feedwater treatment program must include monitoring of iron and, in the case
of mixed metallurgy cycles, copper. In general, use of on-line analyzers for monitoring metals
transport is not extensive in fossil units. An on-line monitoring system that employs x-ray
(29)
fluorescence is available but costly and application has been confined mainly to nuclear units .
On-line colorimetric analyzers have been developed and the general experience has been that
they are difficult to maintain. Also, colorimetric methods are generally incapable of measuring
iron and copper at the concentrations corresponding to target values for these metals in
feedwater.
Devices known as integrated corrosion product samplers provide for collection of a composite
grab sample over a user-selected time interval. If desired, nonfilterable (soluble) and filterable
(suspended) metals may be collected and analyzed separately. Methods of analysis typically used
for iron and copper may be applied to samples collected with these devices. Commercially
available samplers have been used extensively in both fossil and nuclear power plants; some
organizations have designed and constructed their own samplers.
On-line integrated sampling devices allow for concentration of filterable species on a 0.22 or
0.45 m membrane, and for concentration of non-filterable colloidal and soluble species on
cation (and, if needed, anion) ion exchange membranes. The accumulated waterborne
particulates can then be analyzed in one of two ways. In the most common approach, filters are
removed and the solids are digested by appropriate procedures for subsequent analysis by flame
atomic absorption, graphite furnace atomic absorption, or atomic emission spectroscopy.
Integrated sampling devices require access to a representative water sample, flowing at rates high
enough (up to 2 liters or 0.53 gallons per minute) to avoid corrosion product particle dropout.
Significant pressure drops in sample coolers should be minimized for the same reason.
3-71
The sample flow is split so that water is delivered continuously to the integrated sampling device
at a constant flow rate in the range of about 50 to 200 cm3/min (0.013-0.053 gpm), and the
remainder flows to the drain. The filtration unit holds a 0.45 m membrane to collect the
particulate matter and, beneath that, one or more cation ion exchange membranes are positioned
to collect colloidal and soluble species passing through the 0.45 m filter. A constant sample
flow rate is maintained through filter and ion exchange membranes by incorporating a pressure
regulator downstream of the filtration unit. The volume of water passing through the integrated
sampling device is measured with a sample flow totalizer before the sample flows to the drain.
For laboratory analyses of iron and copper, the filter membrane (carrying the particulates) and
cation resin impregnated membranes (carrying the soluble metals) are digested separately,
typically in hydrochloric-nitric acid mixtures to produce the integrated and solubilized samples
needed for reliable chemical analysis. A concentration factor of 1000 or more is typical using
this approach. Thus, these samples can be used to analyze separately for particulate loading and
for dissolved corrosion products (iron and/or copper) in the original sample.
The following noncolorimetric analysis methods may be used for analysis of iron copper in
water.
Of these, AAS (furnace) has been most widely used for analysis of iron and copper at the low
levels normally present in condensate, feedwater and steam. IC also offers the potential to
monitor these metals at low ppb levels.
ICP-AES and AAS (flame) are better suited to levels of corrosion products which may be present
in the boiler water. (Use of ICP/mass spectrometry (ICP/MS) permits detection of copper at sub
ppb levels.) XRF is potentially applicable to low level analysis if the sample is concentrated prior
to analysis. CIA and CE are ion analysis methods which may eventually be utilized for low level
metals analysis.
Each of these noncolorimetric techniques involves use of instrumentation not available at most
fossil plants. AA, IC and ICP-AES are most likely to be present, especially when used for
environmental compliance. All of these instruments are costly and should only be operated by
(30)
(31,32)
are available for
trained technicians or chemists. Standard methods and ASTM procedures
analysis of copper by AA and ICP. Methods for the other techniques have been developed by the
manufacturers.
3-72
There are numerous colorimetric methods available for analysis of soluble iron and copper in
water. For iron, there are procedures based on phenanthroline compounds such as
orthophenanthroline and bathophenanthroline, and specific triazine compounds. Colorimetric
procedures for copper include methods employing compounds such a neocuproine,
bathocuproine, bicinchoninate, and porphyrin. Some of the methods were at one time recognized
by ASMT(31,32) but may no longer be supported. Some may be recognized as standard methods(30).
Some of the methods in use have been developed by and/or are supported by manufacturers of
(33)
testing apparatus and reagents .
Users considering application of any of these colorimetric methods for metals analysis are
advised that they are not generally well suited to analysis of grab samples of feedwater, since
limits of detection for these methods are usually well above target values for iron and copper.
These methods may be of some benefit when testing for metals during startup or when analyzing
metals concentrated by integration corrosion product sampler devices. Users should determine if
the limits of detection, precision and accuracy, interferences and other characteristics of these
methods are suitable for the intended application.
3.8.15 Air In-leakage
Air in-leakage is the primary source of oxygen and carbon dioxide in the condensate and
feedwater system; it is now designated as a core monitoring parameter (Table 3-2). Oxygen and
carbon dioxide can promote corrosion, and carbon dioxide can degrade condensate polisher
performance. High air in-leakage rates can also cause corrosion damage to the condenser shell
and can result in reduced condenser vacuum, thereby reducing the efficiency of the cycle.
Carbon dioxide also can have an effect on the pH of feedwater. The relationship between
ammonia concentration and pH, and the effect of carbon dioxide on feedwater are shown in
Figure 3-26.
3-73
Figure 3-26
Relationship between ammonia concentration and pH for various carbon dioxide
concentrations in feedwater. The lowest curve represents zero CO2. The top curve
represents 4 ppm CO2.
3-74
commissioning,
3-75
3.10 REFERENCES
1.
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Phosphate Treatment for Drum Units.
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: December 1994. TR-103665. (out of print)
2.
Sodium Hydroxide for Conditioning the Boiler Water of Drum-Type Boilers. EPRI, Palo
Alto, CA: January 1995. TR-104007.
3.
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All-Volatile Treatment. EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: April 1996. TR-105041. (now out of print)
4.
Interim Consensus Guidelines on Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
June 1986. CS-4629. (Now out of print.)
5.
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Oxygenated Treatment. EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: December 1994. TR-102285.
6.
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All-Volatile Treatment, EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: November 2002. 1004187.
7.
N.A. Styrikovich and O.I. Martynova, Contaminations of the Steam in Boiling Reactors
from Solutions of Water Impurities. Soviet Atomic Energy, Vol. 15, 1963, pp. 917-921.
8.
O.I. Martynova, Transport and Concentration Processes of Steam and Water Impurities
in Steam Generating Systems, in Water and SteamTheir Properties and Current
Industrial Applications, pp. 547-562. Ed. by J. Straub and K. Scheffler for International
Association for the Properties of Steam, Pergamon Press, New York, 1980.
9.
Steam, Chemistry, and Corrosion in the Phase Transition Zone of Steam Turbines,
Volumes 1 and 2. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: February 1999. TR-108184.
10.
Turbine Steam, Chemistry and Corrosion. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: September 1997. TR108185.
11.
12.
Proceedings: Workshop on Corrosion of Steam Turbine Blading and Disks in the Phase
Transition Zone. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 1998. TR-111340.
13.
Steam Turbine Efficiency and Corrosion: Effects of Surface Finish, Deposits, and
Moisture. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: October 2001. 1003997.
14.
3-76
15.
Behavior of Ammonium Salts in Steam Cycles. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: December 1993.
TR-102377.
16.
Volatility of Aqueous Sodium Hydroxide, Bisulfate and Sulfate. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
February 1999. TR-105801.
17.
Vapor-Liquid Partitioning of Sulfuric Acid and Ammonium Sulfate. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA:
February 1999. TR-112359.
18.
Volatility of Aqueous Acetic Acid, Formic Acid and Sodium Acetate. EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: July 2000. TR-113089.
19.
Behavior of Aqueous Electrolytes in Steam Cycles: The Solubility and Volatility of Cupric
Oxide. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 2000. 1000455.
20.
Vapor-Liquid Partitioning of Phosphoric Acid and Sodium Phosphates, EPRI, Palo Alto,
CA: 2003. 1007291.
21.
The Volatility of Impurities in Water/Steam Cycles. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2001. 1001042.
22.
Interim Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Combined Cycle Heat Recovery Steam
Generators (HRSGs), EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: November 1998. TR-110051.
23.
Development of a Steam Sampling System. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 1991. TR-100196.
24.
Guidelines for Copper in Fossil Plants. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2000. 1000457.
25.
Guidelines for Chemical Cleaning of Conventional Fossil Plant Equipment, EPRI, Palo
Alto, CA: November 2001. 1003994.
26.
27.
28.
R.B. Dooley and K.J. Shields, Cycle Chemistry for Conventional Fossil Plants and
Combined Cycle/HRSGs, Seventh International Conference on Cycle Chemistry in
Fossil Plants, Houston, Texas, June 2003. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2003. 1009194,
December 2003.
29.
Reference Manual for On-Line Monitoring of Water Chemistry and Corrosion: 1998
Update, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: April 1999. TR-112024.
3-77
30.
th
Standard Methods for the Examination of Water and Wastewater, 20 Edition, American
Public Health Association, American Waterworks Asociation and Water Environmental
Federation, Washington, DC: 1998. (Part 3000, Metals)
31.
ASTM D 1068-95, Standard Test Methods for Iron in Water, ASTM, Philadelphia, PA:
1998. (Vol. 11.01).
32.
ASTM D 1688-95, Standard Test Methods for Copper in Water, ASTM, Philadelphia,
PA: 1998. (Vol. 11.01)
33.
rd
Water Analysis Handbook, 3 Edition, Hach Company, Loveland, CO: 1997. (Methods
8506 and 8143)
34.
35.
G.J. Verib. Sodium to Phosphate Ratios, presented at the ASME Research Committee
on Power Plant & Environmental Chemistry, San Diego, CA. March 2001.
36.
G.J. Verib. History and Strategy of Phosphate Chemistry Control at Ohio Edison
th
Company, presented at the 57 International Water Conference, Pittsburgh, PA. IWC96-23. 1996.
3-78
4
CYCLES WITH DRUM BOILERS OPERATING WITH THE
PHOSPHATE CONTINUUM (PC)
4.1 INTRODUCTION TO PC
A brief overview of the development of various phosphate treatments was provided in Section
1.3.1. There it was discussed how the Phosphate Continuum had grown out of the treatments in
the previous EPRI Guidelines. The remarkable successes of the previous treatments (EPT and
PT) and the remaining concerns were delineated. The main reasons for the development of the
Phosphate Continuum (Figure 4-1) were very common operating deficiencies. It was indicated
that very few organizations attempted to determine an equilibrium (minimum) level of phosphate
for their boilers, and most often the level of phosphate used in high pressure boilers was very low
(< 0.2 ppm). Additionally there has been the problem of corrosion (hydrogen damage) in cases of
contaminant ingress, in conjunction with the application of the incorrect contaminant curves and
ignoring of the ammonia/pH correction when determining the boiler water pH and the sodiumto-phosphate ratio.
The PC treatment keeps the overriding criteria from the 1994 Phosphate Guidelines and also
adds some new features to address the concerns. This combination leads to the PC treatment
which:
4-1
(a)
(b)
Figure 4-1
Schematic of Operating Range for PC (a is normal scale, b is log scale)
4-2
The PC treatment keeps the overriding criteria from the 1994 Phosphate Guidelines and also
adds some new features to address the concerns. This combination leads to the PC treatment
which:
Has a wide range from low phosphate to around 10 ppm to assist in controlling hideout.
Requires only the addition of TSP and NaOH to ensure that acid phosphate corrosion will not
occur and is thus encompassed by Na:PO4 = 3 and TSP + 1 ppm NaOH (Figure 4-1)..
Covers the possibility of contaminant control at the low phosphate end by having a minimum
of 0.2 ppm phosphate. This will prevent operation using less than 0.2 ppm, where there is
essentially little protection from contamination. Together with the proper choice of
contaminant control curves, this will prevent the onset of hydrogen damage.
Ensure that a minimum boiler water pH (corrected for ammonia) of 9.0 is maintained to
provide a reasonable level of boiler corrosion protection in the event that acid forming
contaminant ingress is experienced; with low trisodium phosphate dosing rates some free
sodium hydroxide must be present to maintain the pH at or above 9.0.
Covers the high phosphate end for low pressure boilers and in cases where contaminants are
likely/possible in high pressure boilers. (See Section 2.3 on Selection and Optimization of
Boiler Water Treatments.)
Continues the use of boiler water contaminant and pH control curves (Sections 4.2 and 4.3).
Although PC is a continuum as shown in Figure 4-1, it needs to be recognized that there are two
very different extremes of low (L) and high (H) phosphate levels. In the following two
subsections (4.2 and 4.3) these regimes are PC(L) and PC(H) with a very loose demarcation
around 3 ppm phosphate. To determine which of these treatments is applicable to a boiler, an
operator will need to be continually cognizant of the following two main factors:
total carryover, particularly carryover of sodium into steam, as the sodium boiler water limits
are the least conservative in this PC Guideline.
The process of selection of either PC(L) or PC(H) has been described in Section 2.
4-3
4-4
Figure 4-2
PC(L): Boiler Water Phosphate vs. Operating Pressure
4-5
Figure 4-3
Boiler Water pH vs. Phosphate at Various Ammonia Levels. Na/PO4 = 3. The lowest curve
is at zero ammonia, the highest curve is at 2 ppm ammonia.
4-6
Figure 4-4
Boiler Water pH vs. Phosphate at Various Ammonia Levels. TSP + 1 ppm NaOH. The
lowest curve is at zero ammonia. The highest curve is at 2 ppm ammonia.
4-7
Figure 4-5 may be used to determine the corrected pH, which is the pH attributable to the
presence of phosphate and/or sodium hydroxide treatments, and to eliminate the influence of
ammonia. While also applicable to PC(H) and even to CT, use of Figure 4-5 is most beneficial
when employing PC(L). For routine surveillance and control of boiler water chemistry, the figure
provides a reliable indication of the corrected pH. Users of Figure 4-5 should be cognizant of the
following circumstances, which could lead to incorrect and misleading results:
Errors in measured data: the relationships shown in the figure assume that the measured pH
and ammonia data are accurate. Any measurement errors will naturally influence the pH
correction factor determined by the figure and the resulting corrected pH. Data validity is an
issue of general concern and information pertinent to data quality are provided in Appendix
E.
Correction assessment using Figure 4-5 is appropriate only when the boiler water contains at
least the requisite minimum level of treatment chemical and this should be verified prior to
making the pH correction. Under circumstances of confirmed loss of treatment chemicals,
determining the reason for reduced treatment chemical inventory and restoration to normal
levels is the more important issue.
Thus, when correctly applying PC(L) (using the ammonia/pH correction), i.e., when operating
correctly with Na:PO4 ratio 3, establishing an equilibrium phosphate concentration is
superfluous and should not be undertaken. There are three boiler water parameters that have to
be monitored and only two that will be used for routine operation and optimization of PC(L):
Ammonia
pH
as the primary boiler protection parameter; with PC(L) the measured pH must be
corrected for the influence of ammonia;
PO4
as the secondary boiler protection parameter. The actual level of the phosphate
concentration depends on the actual cycle contamination.
As is discussed in the next Sub-Section, cation conductivity should be used as the main control
of contaminants in the boiler water for PC(L) in conjunction with pH and phosphate. This will
enable effective diagnosis of any operational problems.
Any phosphate treatment, even PC(L), is necessarily accompanied with phosphate hideout and
hideout return, but when trisodium phosphate is the only phosphate added to the boiler, any
hideout will not result in corrosion. For this reason, trials in high pressure boilers to establish the
equilibrium concentration with nearly zero (or negligible) hideout will result in very low
phosphate concentrations being applied. This, in connection with neglecting the necessary
ammonia/pH correction, has led to operation with an actual Na:PO4 ratio < 3, often very much
less than 3. This incorrect phosphate control together with a small ingress of contaminants has
resulted in serious boiler tube failures due to hydrogen damage. This important feature of PC(L)
is discussed further in Sections 3.8.2, 3.8.9 and 3.8.10.
4-8
Figure 4-5
Relationship Between Corrected Boiler Water pH, Measured Boiler Water pH and Measured
Ammonia Concentration. The lines on the figure increase in 0.1 ppm ammonia increments
from 0 to 2 ppm. To determine the corrected pH, find the measured pH on the x-axis and
the point at which a vertical line intersects the measured ammonia concentration. This
point, extended horizontally to the y-axis, indicates the corresponding corrected pH value.
4-9
Cycle chemistry target values and action levels are presented in this section for each monitoring
point for plants having drum boilers operating on PC(L). A target, or normal value, and as many
as three action levels are given for each parameter at each monitoring point. This section is
intended to be used by operating staff and management personnel.
4.2.2 Target Values for PC(L)
The sample points, monitoring parameters, target values, and action levels were developed for
those plants that have reheat. To customize these values for plants without reheat, the reader is
referenced to Section 3.8. The following figures show the target values and action levels for each
sample point and monitoring parameter:
Figure 4-6 for all-ferrous systems operating with oxidizing conditions, AVT(O), (but not on
OT), and with no reducing agent.
Figure 4-7 for mixed-metallurgy and all-ferrous systems operating under reducing
conditions, AVT(R). These systems use a reducing agent and provide (for mixed-metallurgy
systems) the reducing conditions necessary to minimize copper transport.
Figure 4-7 features the use of ORP instrumentation at the deaerator inlet to ensure that reducing
conditions are maintained at all times. ORP is not specified as a core parameter for Figure 4.6
(oxidizing regime). Figures 4-6 and 4-7 list target values (N) and from one to three action levels
for a compendium of sampling points around the cycle. The steam values are more restrictive
than featured in previous Guidelines in order to provide enhanced turbine protection (Section
1.2.3) (steam limits of 2 ppb sodium, chloride and sulfate versus 3 ppb in previous editions). The
limit for silica in the steam remains the same at 10 ppb.
Research has indicated that, for mixed-metallurgy systems (with strict air in-leakage and oxygen
control, the addition of a reducing agent, and with reducing conditions), the pH range at the
economizer inlet can be increased from 8.8 to 9.2 (previously) to 9.0 to 9.3. This increase in pH
will reduce the transport of iron in the cycle, while minimizing the copper bearing materials from
corrosion. It must be recognized that the ORP needs to remain in the reducing regime for these
mixed-metallurgy systems. Simply changing the pH will not suffice if the air in-leakage remains
high.
4-10
Figure 4-6
Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(L) with AVT(O) feedwater. All-ferrous metallurgy in feedwater system. Operating with an oxidizing environment (no reducing agent).
4-11
Figure 4-7
Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(L) with AVT(R) feedwater. All-ferrous and mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems. Operating with a reducing environment (reducing agent added).
4-12
There are a number of features to keep in mind when adapting Figures 4-6 and 4-7 to an
individual plant. Particular emphasis has been placed in the development of these new guideline
cycle diagrams to make control of a unit as simple as possible, and to minimize repetitive grab
sampling.
The Core Parameters (Table 3-2) are indicated by an asterisk (*). These instruments should
be monitored continuously and on-line. These have a C for continuous in the sample
column.
There are a number of other parameters, which have also been designated by a C as they
provide useful confirmation of unit condition, but are not regarded as Core instruments.
These parameters include silica and sodium in makeup, specific conductivity at the
economizer inlet, and boiler water sodium.
There are a number of other parameters on these diagrams, which have been designated in
this guideline as T for troubleshooting. It is only necessary to monitor these if one of the
continuous Core instruments provides an indication that the parameter is out of its
normal guideline value. In most cases, this will be accomplished by grab sample; however,
in some cases an organization might have decided to install a continuous analyzer. In the case
of iron and copper at the economizer inlet, it should be recognized that in a well operated
plant it should not be necessary to monitor these parameters more frequently than once or
twice a year; and then only to confirm the feedwater regime remains optimized.
Dissolved oxygen at the CPD should be controlled to less than 10 ppb. This is a much better
control for the feedwater than air in-leakage into the condenser and is critical to be able to
control copper corrosion in the feedwater for mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems, as well as
oxidizing environments for all-ferrous feedwater systems.
A limit for copper at the economizer inlet remains on Figure 4-6 for those units with copper
based condenser tubing.
Reducing agent (hydrazine preferred) feed in Figure 4-7 is a requirement, whereas in Figure
4-6 it is not required nor is it necessary if the unit is to be operated with AVT(O). For both
AVT(R) and AVT(O) rigorous air in-leakage control must be maintained to ensure oxygen
levels at the CPD of less than 10 ppb.
As discussed in Section 3 (Table 3-2), a new suite of core parameters has been developed for
Figures 4-6 and 4-7. The following core parameters are applicable for PC(L):
Sodium and cation conductivity at the condensate pump discharge provide cycle
contamination control from condenser leaks and makeup malfunctions.
Dissolved oxygen at the condensate pump discharge ensures the optimum feedwater potential
can be controlled. It also provides the important indication of air in-leakage into the cycle.
4-13
Deaerator inlet ORP (Figure 4-7) ensures reducing conditions are maintained to minimize
copper transport. Reference to Appendix B will illustrate how reducing ORP levels can vary
dependent on a number of variables and does not always need to be in the range of -300 to 350mV to be reducing.
Economizer inlet sodium (or condensate polisher effluent sodium) on units with a condensate
polisher reveals condensate polisher malfunction and guards against cycle contamination.
Boiler water pH (corrected for ammonia) and cation conductivity. Cation conductivity is the
main control for boiler water contaminants, and thus, corrosion.
Boiler water sodium and phosphate are necessary to ensure proper feed of trisodium
phosphate and caustic (to 1.0 ppm if used). Boiler water specific conductivity is a further
check on boiler water purity and also reflects the concentration of ammonia being used,
chlorides, sulfate and caustic (to 1.0 ppm if used).
Saturated steam carryover is required to be determined on a routine/ periodic basis (every six
months or after an outage or when drum work is conducted) to prevent excessive
contamination of the turbine caused by boiler drum internal separation failure, foaming, high
boiler water levels, etc.
Air removal system exhaust air in-leakage is required to prevent serious corrosion via excess
cycle dissolved oxygen and carbon dioxide.
The core parameters shown in Figures 4-6 and 4-7 are the minimum required for routine
chemistry monitoring and provide basic input data for the EPRI computer program
ChemExpert. The basic requirement for every unit is that a minimum level of instruments
should be installed that can uniquely identify any problem on the unit.
A series of curves have been developed which present smooth, continuous relationships of boiler
water target values as a function of boiler pressure. These curves have been designed to provide
boiler corrosion protection, but as indicated in Section 3.3.1 they have been validated to ensure
they are below the boiler water contaminant values which would cause the steam values to be
exceeded. Thus these curves provide protection to the boiler and the turbine.
The following boiler water limits are presented:
4-14
Figure 4-8
PC(L): Boiler Water Sodium vs. Operating Pressure
4-15
Figure 4-9
PC(L): Boiler Water pH vs. Operating Pressure. pH due to trisodium phosphate (3.8 to 1.0
ppm phosphate from Figure 4-2)
4-16
Figure 4-10
PC(L): Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating Pressure
4-17
Figure 4-11
PC(L): Boiler Water Sulfate vs. Operating Pressure
4-18
Figure 4-12
PC(L): Boiler Water Silica vs. Operating Pressure
4-19
Copies of these figures, modified to reflect specific unit characteristics by monitoring (see
Section 2), should be included in the plant operating procedures and prominently displayed in the
control room, water and steam sample room, and the chemistry laboratory.
The specific and, in particular, cation conductivity are very important core parameters when
operating on PC(L). Extensive discussion took place on these parameters in Sections 3.8.11 and
3.8.12. It was illustrated how these conductivities depend on the level of phosphate and any
contaminants (chloride and sulfate). The effect of phosphate by itself, and of chloride/sulfate was
shown in a series of figures.
Those organizations wishing to establish specific and cation conductivity control curves are
referenced to the suggested procedures in Sections 3.8.11 and 3.8.12. Copies of these figures,
modified to reflect specific unit characteristics by monitoring (see Section 2), should then be
included in the plant operating procedures and prominently displayed in the control room, water
and steam sample room, and the chemistry laboratory.
As an example, two figures are included in this PC(L) guideline section to illustrate the
sensitivity of specific and cation conductivity to the balance between phosphate and
chloride/sulfate (Figures 4-13 and 4-14). Both of these figures show the specific and cation
conductivity due only to phosphate, and also due to additional amounts of chloride and sulfate.
To assist operators in using these two figures or developing a set of curves for their boiler, a few
words are provided on how these curves were derived.
For specific conductivity (Figure 4-13). The contribution of phosphate at the normal limits
shown in Figure 4-2 has been converted into specific conductivity using the relationship shown
in Figure 3-19 for Na3PO4. The contributions of chloride and sulfate at the normal limits shown
in Figures 4-10 and 4-11 have been converted to specific conductivity. The top dashed curve in
Figure 4-13 represents the envelope corresponding to the upper curve in Figure 3-20. There are
no contributions in Figure 4-13 from NaOH or ammonia.
For cation conductivity (Figure 4-14). The contribution of phosphate at the normal limits shown
in Figure 4-2 has been converted into cation conductivity using the relationship shown in Figure
3-19 for H3PO4. The contributions of chloride and sulfate at the normal limits in Figures 4-10 and
4-11 have been converted to cation conductivity. The top dashed curve in Figure 4-14
corresponds to the upper curve in Figure 3-22.
4-20
Figure 4-13
PC(L): Drum Boiler Water Specific Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure showing specific
conductivity due to phosphate alone, and due to phosphate plus various amounts of
chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an example to illustrate the
effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator will need to develop unique
curves for each boiler as described in the text of Sections 4.2.2 and 3.8.11.
4-21
Figure 4-14
PC(L): Drum Boiler Water Cation Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure showing cation
conductivity due to phosphate alone, and due to phosphate plus various amounts of
chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an example to illustrate the
effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator will need to develop unique
curves for each boiler as described in the text of Sections 4.2.2 and 3.8.12.
4-22
If control curves such as illustrated in Figures 4-13 and 4-14 are derived, then specific and cation
conductivity can be used as the main control for contaminants in the boiler water for PC(L), but
they should be utilized together with other monitored parameters (pH and phosphate) to diagnose
effectively various potential operational problems. For example, from a baseline steady load and
uniform boiler water specific and cation conductivity, a sudden or continuing change in either or
both of these parameters can be the basis for determining the source of the potential problem and
of initiating the appropriate corrective action. The four case studies in the PC(H) section (Section
4.3.1) illustrate the diagnostic indications.
Boiler water pH must be kept within a narrow alkaline range to maintain the protective layer of
magnetite on the internal boiler water tube surfaces. Contaminants such as chlorides, sulfates and
silica must be maintained at reasonable low concentrations to prevent corrosion or excessive
deposits within the boiler tubes or downstream steam circuits.
In PC(L), boiler water alkalinity is maintained with an adequate concentration of a blend of
sodium hydroxide and trisodium phosphate. The rationale for this treatment is described in the
introduction to this section and in Section 1.3.
4.2.3 Normal Operation for PC(L)
Once the optimum phosphate level based on the risk of possible contamination has been
determined for the boiler, then the unique operating limits for the unit should be determined. The
cycle chemistry diagrams and contaminant curves, that are provided in Figure 4-2 and Figures 46 to 4-12, should be regarded purely as a guide, and that need to be customized for each unit.
Here reference should be made to the roadmap in Section 2. The importance of this procedure
cannot be overemphasized: it is very important to measure the carryover from the boiler drum
into the steam for each unit and to use this information to develop specific unit operating
chemical guidelines. It is of particular concern with PC(L), operating with a very small level of
free hydroxide, that particular attention is paid to the steam sodium levels.
During normal operation, only trisodium phosphate and sodium hydroxide should be added to
the boiler water. Under PC(L), it is necessary to maintain some free sodium hydroxide in the
boiler water to maintain the ammonia corrected pH above 9.0, particularly if the normal
phosphate concentration is under 1 ppm. In units where sodium leakage from makeup systems
and polishers is well controlled, there will be generally a need for sodium hydroxide dosing to
avoid boiler corrosion if the boiler operates with low concentrations of phosphate. The use of the
boiler blowdown should be minimized. If this operation can be maintained then the addition of
chemicals to the unit will be minimized. If blowdown is used for some reason (e.g., for reducing
the contaminant concentration in the boiler water), additional dosing of trisodium phosphate and
sodium hydroxide is required to keep the boiler water pH in the optimum region and to ensure
that the sodium-to-phosphate ratio actually is 3.
4-23
4-24
In the absence of boiler water contamination, the degree of corrosion protection afforded by
lower than desired levels of treatment (and commensurate low corrected pH values) may be
completely satisfactory, however, restoration of normal chemistry is required as quickly as
possible to ensure that the boiler will be protected in the event contamination is experienced.
With PC(L), if the absence of contamination is confirmed and the phosphate residual is within
the customized limits of the unit, addition of caustic is needed to raise the pH. On the other hand,
addition of trisodium phosphate should be made first if (again, in the confirmed absence of
contamination) the phosphate level is less than the minimum allowable concentration; a
subsequent addition of caustic would be needed if the trisodium phosphate addition does not
restore the corrected pH value to normal limits.
The more serious situation is the one involving the presence of boiler contamination, typically
confirmed by increased boiler water conductivity readings. Operation of PC(L) without pH
correction, and without surveillance and control of the conductivity, can give a false sense of
security with respect to corrosion protection. When the corrected pH and treatment chemical
levels are within expected ranges for control, the boiler water can provide corrosion protection as
indicated in the impurity and conductivity control curves (Figures 4-10, 4-11, 4-13 and 4-14);
corrosion protection is compromised at higher boiler water impurity levels. However, when the
corrected pH is less than normal, this means that the levels of treatment chemicals are also lower
than needed to provide corrosion protection at the levels indicated in the impurity and
conductivity control curves; in the event of complete loss of chemical treatment, the boiler
corrosion protection would be the same as for all-volatile treatment.
If the measured pH is rapidly falling and at risk of reaching the immediate shutdown level of 8,
there is clearly no point in making the pH correction until and unless the boiler chemistry can be
stabilized quickly and without the need for immediate shutdown. For example, it may be possible
to keep the unit in service by reducing pressure and/or load and restoring program treatment
levels, in which case correction of the measured pH for ammonia should be resumed.
Loss of the ammonia feed system could conceivably lead to a rapid yet relatively minor
reduction in the measured boiler water pH. However, the corrected pH should remain at an
acceptable level providing the cycle is free of significant contamination and levels of phosphate
and/or sodium hydroxide treatments are in expected ranges for control. Under such
circumstances, the boiler corrosion protection is maintained but the ammonia feed system must
be returned to service as soon as possible to control the feedwater pH at the optimum level
needed to minimize corrosion of metals from the waterside surfaces of preboiler components and
piping and subsequent transport of these metals to the boiler.
If at any time the boiler blowdown pH falls to below 8, the unit should be taken off line and
drained. In the case of a longterm operation with markedly increased contamination, chemical
cleaning should be considered. After the source of contamination has been isolated and the
concentration of the contaminants in the boiler blowdown is within limits, the unit can be
converted back to standard PC(L) chemistry.
4-25
4-26
Figure 4-15 for all-ferrous systems operating with oxidizing conditions, AVT(O), (but not on
oxygenated treatment) and with no reducing agent feed, which minimizes iron transport in
the cycle.
Figure 4-16 for mixed-metallurgy and all-ferrous systems operating under reducing
conditions, AVT(R). These systems use a reducing agent and provide (for mixed-metallurgy
systems) the reducing conditions necessary to minimize copper transport.
Figure 4-16 features the use of ORP instrumentation at the deaerator inlet to ensure that reducing
conditions are maintained at all times. ORP is not specified as a core parameter for Figure 4-15
(oxidizing regime). Figures 4-15 and 4-16 list target values (N) and from one to three action
levels for a compendium of sampling points around the cycle. The steam values are more
restrictive than featured in previous Guidelines, in order to maintain enhanced turbine protection
(Section 1.2.3), with steam limits of 3 ppb sodium, versus 5 ppb in previous editions. The limit
for silica in the steam remains the same at 10 ppb, as does chloride and sulfate at 3 ppb each.
Research has indicated that, for mixed-metallurgy systems (with strict air in-leakage and oxygen
control, the addition of a reducing agent, and with reducing conditions), the pH range at the
economizer inlet can be increased from 8.8 to 9.2 (previously) to 9.0 to 9.3. This increase in pH
will reduce the transport of iron in the cycle, while minimizing corrosion of the copper bearing
materials. It needs to be recognized that the ORP needs to remain in the reducing regime for
these mixed-metallurgy systems. Simply changing the pH will not suffice if the air in-leakage
remains high.
There are a number of features to keep in mind when adapting Figures 4-15 and 4-16 to an
individual plant. Particular emphasis has been placed in the development of these new guideline
cycle diagrams to make control of a unit as simple as possible, and to minimize repetitive grab
sampling.
The Core Parameters (Table 3-2) are indicated by an asterisk (*). These instruments should
be monitored continuously and on-line. These have a C for continuous in the sample
column.
There are a number of other parameters, which have also been designated by a C as they
provide useful confirmation of unit condition, but are not regarded as Core instruments.
These parameters include: silica and sodium in makeup, specific conductivity at the
economizer inlet, and boiler water sodium.
4-27
There are a number of other parameters on these diagrams, which have been designated in
this guideline as T for troubleshooting. It is only necessary to monitor these if one of the
continuous Core instruments provides an indication that the parameter is out of its
normal guideline value. In most cases, this will be accomplished by grab sample; however,
in some cases an organization might have decided to install a continuous analyzer. In the case
of iron and copper at the economizer inlet, it should be recognized that in a well operated
plant it should not be necessary to monitor these parameters more frequently than once or
twice a year; and then only to confirm the feedwater regime remains optimized.
Dissolved oxygen at the CPD should be controlled to less than 10 ppb. This is a much better
control for the feedwater than air in-leakage into the condenser, and is critical to be able to
control copper corrosion in the feedwater for mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems, as well as
oxidizing environments for all-ferrous feedwater systems.
A limit for copper at the economizer inlet remains on Figure 4-15 for those units with copper
based condenser tubing.
Reducing agent (hydrazine preferred) feed in Figure 4-16 is a requirement, whereas in Figure
4-15 it is not required nor is it necessary if the unit is to be operated with AVT(O). For both
AVT(R) and AVT(O) rigorous air in-leakage control must be maintained to ensure oxygen
levels at the CPD of less than 10 ppb.
As discussed in Section 3 (Table 3-2), a new suite of core parameters has been developed for
Figures 4-15 and 4-16. The following core parameters are applicable for PC(H):
Sodium and cation conductivity at the condensate pump discharge provide cycle
contamination control from condenser leaks and makeup malfunctions.
Dissolved oxygen at the condensate pump discharge ensures the optimum feedwater potential
can be controlled. It also provides the important indication of air in-leakage into the cycle.
Deaerator inlet ORP (Figure 4-16) ensures reducing conditions are maintained to minimize
copper transport. Reference to Appendix B will provide an understanding of how reducing
ORP is dependent on a number of variables and does not always need to be in the range of 300 to -350 mV to be reducing.
Economizer inlet sodium (or condensate polisher effluent sodium) on units with a condensate
polisher reveals condensate polisher malfunction and guards against cycle contamination.
Boiler water pH and cation conductivity. Cation conductivity is the main control for boiler
water contaminants, and thus, corrosion.
Boiler water sodium and phosphate are necessary to ensure proper feed of trisodium
phosphate and caustic (to 1.0 ppm if used). Boiler water specific conductivity is a further
check on boiler water purity and also reflects the concentration of ammonia being used,
chlorides, sulfate and caustic, (to 1.0 ppm if used).
4-28
Figure 4-15
Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(H) with AVT(O) Feedwater. All-ferrous metallurgy in feedwater system. Operating with an oxidizing environment (no reducing agent).
4-29
Figure 4-16
Cycle Chemistry Diagram for PC(H) with AVT(R) Feedwater. All-ferrous and mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems. Operating with a reducing environment (reducing agent added).
4-30
Saturated steam carryover is required to be determined on a routine/ periodic basis (every six
months or after an outage or when drum work is conducted) to prevent excessive
contamination of the turbine caused by boiler drum internal separation failure, foaming, high
boiler water levels, etc.
Air removal system exhaust air in-leakage is required to prevent serious corrosion via excess
cycle dissolved oxygen and carbon dioxide.
With PC(H), the influence of ammonia in the boiler water is generally less significant than it is
for PC(L), as indicated in Figures 4-3 and 4-4. The corrected pH may be determined using Figure
4-5.
The core parameters shown in Figures 4-15 and 4-16 are the minimum required for routine
chemistry monitoring and provide basic input data for the EPRI computer program ChemExpert.
The basic requirement for every unit is that a minimum level of instruments should be installed
that can uniquely identify any problem on the unit.
A series of curves have been developed which present smooth, continuous relationships of boiler
water target values as a function of boiler pressure. These curves have been designed to provide
boiler corrosion protection, but as indicated in Section 3.3.1 they have been validated to ensure
they are below the boiler water contaminant values which would cause the steam values to be
exceeded. Thus these curves provide protection to the boiler and the turbine.
The following boiler water limits are presented:
4-31
Figure 4-17
PC(H): Boiler Water Sodium vs. Operating Pressure
4-32
Figure 4-18
PC(H): Boiler Water Phosphate vs. Operating Pressure
4-33
Figure 4-19
PC(H): Boiler Water pH vs. Operating Pressure. pH due to trisodium phosphate (5.8 to 1.4
ppm from Figure 4-18).
4-34
Figure 4-20
PC(H): Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating Pressure
4-35
Figure 4-21
PC(H): Boiler Water Sulfate vs. Operating Pressure
4-36
Figure 4-22
PC(H): Boiler Water Silica vs. Operating Pressure
4-37
The sodium vs. pressure curve, Figure 4-17 is based on the mechanical carryover curve presented
in Figure 3-2 plus the vaporous carryover from the research conducted by EPRI and discussed in
Section 3.3.1. As indicated in Figure 3-9, vaporous carryover remains unimportant until
pressures reach 2500 psi and above. Even at these high pressures, mechanical carryover is the
dominant factor in determining sodium in the steam. This research finding emphasizes the
necessity of having an accurate measurement of total carryover from each boiler drum to prevent
excessive carryover of sodium to the steam
The mechanical carryover curve, Figure 3-2, contains a safety factor of 2 to provide
conservatism. Thus, the sodium curve (Figure 4-17) illustrates that relatively low boiler water
sodium levels must be maintained in the boiler to prevent sodium steam limits from being
exceeded. If a particular operating boiler has mechanical carryover less than indicated on Figure
3-2, sodium levels in the boiler may be increased above those in Figure 4-17 without exceeding
sodium steam limits. Conversely, if actual mechanical carryover is greater than shown on Figure
3-2, sodium limits in the boiler must be reduced to maintain proper sodium steam limits. These
considerations make it mandatory that total carryover be measured in each boiler with some
frequency (twice per year at least).
The feed of pure trisodium phosphate will, obviously, result in a molar ratio of sodium phosphate
of 3.0. However, contaminants, such as sodium chloride and sodium sulfate, as well as the feed
of up to 1.0 ppm of caustic will elevate the sodium values in the boiler water resulting in sodium
to phosphate ratios greater than 3.0. The sodium vs. pressure curve, Figure 4-17, represents the
maximum sodium in the boiler water to maintain a steam limit of 3 ppb, irrespective of whether
the sodium is from trisodium phosphate, sodium chloride, sodium sulfate or caustic. As
discussed later in this section, the curves for specific and cation conductivity reflect sodium from
these other sources. These conductivity curves should be used in conjunction with measurements
of sodium in the boiler water to ensure that the sodium levels in Figure 4-17 are not exceeded.
The chloride and sulfate curves, Figures 4-20 and 4-21, are based on protecting the boiler from
corrosion. These curves were developed from extensive experience with operating boilers on
(2)
phosphate treatment (PT) and caustic treatment (CT) which is thoroughly discussed in Section
5. Sulfate was recognized as a lesser risk than chloride in initiating corrosion in boilers, so the
concentration of sulfate has been taken as twice that of chloride. These curves have also been
validated to ensure they are below the boiler water contaminant values, which would cause the
steam values to be exceeded. (Compare to Figures 3-11 and 3-13.) Thus these curves provide
protection to the boiler and turbine.
The specific and, in particular, cation conductivity are very important parameters when operating
with PC(H). Conductivity methods utilize simple and reliable instrumentation and are, therefore,
the preferred methods of evaluating and controlling boiler water chemistry. Conductivity
measurements should, of course, be supplemented by measurements of other control parameters
such as pH, sodium and phosphate to ensure proper control of the boiler at all times.
Extensive discussion took place on these parameters in Sections 3.8.11 and 3.8.12. It was
illustrated how these conductivities depend on the level of phosphate and any contaminants
(chloride and sulfate). The effect of phosphate by itself, and of chloride/sulfate was shown in a
series of figures.
4-38
Those organizations wishing to establish specific and cation conductivity control curves are
referenced to the suggested procedures in Sections 3.8.11 and 3.8.12. Copies of these figures,
modified to reflect specific unit characteristics by monitoring (Section 2) should be then included
in the plant operating procedures and prominently displayed in the control room, water and
steam sample room, and the chemistry laboratory.
As an example, two figures are included in this PC(H) guideline section to illustrate the
sensitivity of specific and cation conductivity to the balance between phosphate and
chloride/sulfate (Figures 4-23 and 4-24). Both of these figures show specific and cation
conductivity due only to phosphate, and also due to additional amounts of chloride and sulfate.
To assist operators in using these two figures or developing a set of curves for their boiler, a few
words are provided on how these curves were derived.
For specific conductivity (Figure 4-23). The contribution of phosphate at the normal limits
shown in Figure 4-18 has been converted into specific conductivity using the relationship shown
in Figure 3-19 for Na3PO4. The contributions of chloride and sulfate at the normal limits shown
in Figures 4-20 and 4-21 have been converted to specific conductivity. The top dashed curve in
Figure 4-23 represents the envelope corresponding to the upper curve in Figure 3-21. There are
no contributions in Figure 4-23 from NaOH or ammonia.
For cation conductivity (Figure 4-24). The contribution of phosphate at the normal limits shown
in Figure 4-18 has been converted into cation conductivity using the relationship shown in Figure
3-19 for H3PO4. The contributions of chloride and sulfate at the normal limits in Figures 4-20 and
4-21 have been converted to cation conductivity. The top dashed curve in Figure 4-24
corresponds to the upper curve in Figure 3-23.
4-39
Figure 4-23
PC(H): Drum Boiler Water Specific Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure showing specific
conductivity due to phosphate alone, and due to phosphate plus various amounts of
chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an example to illustrate the
effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator will need to develop unique
curves for each boiler as described in the text of Sections 4.3.1 and 3.8.11.
4-40
Figure 4-24
PC(H): Drum Boiler Water Cation Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure. Showing cation
conductivity due to phosphate alone and due to phosphate plus various amounts of
chloride and sulfate. It must be noted that this figure is only an example to illustrate the
effects of phosphate, chloride and sulfate. Each operator will need to develop unique
curves for each boiler as described in the text of Sections 4.3.1 and 3.8.12.
4-41
If control curves such as illustrated in Figures 4-23 and 4-24 are derived, then specific and cation
conductivity can be used as the main control for contaminants in the boiler water for PC(H), but
they should be utilized together with other monitored parameters (pH and phosphate) to diagnose
effectively various potential operational problems. For example, from a baseline steady load and
uniform boiler water specific and cation conductivity, a sudden or continuing change in either or
both of these parameters can be the basis for determining the source of the potential problem and
of initiating the appropriate corrective action. The following four case studies illustrate the
diagnostic indications.
Case I: Boiler Water Specific Conductivity Rises While Cation Conductivity Remains
Steady
A. Ammonia feed increasing
Case II: Boiler Water Specific Conductivity Falls While Cation Conductivity Remains
Steady
A. and B. Same as Case I, except parameters fall
Case III: Boiler Water Specific Conductivity and Cation Conductivity Both Rise
A. Phosphate feed increasing
B. Cycle contamination
Economizer inlet cation conductivity increasesmay reflect any of the other bullets in B.
4-42
Case IV: Boiler water specific and cation conductivity both fall
A. Phosphate feed decreasing
A varying unit load may add a complication to these diagnostic procedures related to possible
chemical hideout. In this situation, additional monitoring may be required to verify the
underlying root causes for chemistry parameter deviations from their normal target values.
Copies of Figure 4-15 through 4-22 and the customized versions of Figure 4-23 and 4-24, should
be included in the plant operating procedures and prominently displayed in the control room,
water and steam sample room, and chemistry laboratory. It may be more convenient to develop a
separate figure, based on Figures 4-15 and 4-16, which only includes the core parameters for a
specific unit.
4.3.2 Normal Operation for PC(H)
Phosphate Hideout and Its Control
With PC(H), the phosphate during normal operation will probably be at a level that the boiler
cannot maintain without hideout, especially for high pressure boilers.
Hideout will be expected during initial startup on PC(H). It is important to be patient during this
period and not to chase phosphate while attempting to maintain pH-phosphate control
relationships.
As indicated in Figure 4-1, the control range (pH-phosphate) for PC has been enlarged over that
for phosphate treatment (PT) from the previous EPRI Guidelines, and there is an allowance for
up to one ppm of free sodium hydroxide (NaOH) over a given range of phosphate not to exceed
that dictated by boiler pressure. No additions of mono- and di-sodium phosphate should be made
to correct for any observed hideout return. Controlled additions of trisodium phosphate can be
made to increase phosphate concentration levels materially affecting pH. Minor sodium
hydroxide additions to give boiler water concentration of always less than one ppm (free
sodium hydroxide beyond the Na/PO4 ratio of 3.0) can be utilized to increase pH if it becomes
necessary, but should be avoided, if possible. It is important to have knowledge about the typical
amounts of chemicals that can be added to the boiler. Normally, hydrated trisodium phosphate
(Na3PO4 12H2O) is utilized because of its better solubility as compared with the anhydrous
Na3PO4 material. Any additions should be made based on the targeted sodium to phosphate ratio.
The phosphate concentration is dependent on what the boiler will accept at the operating pressure
utilized.
4-43
A modern natural circulation boiler of about 500 MW contains around 600,000 lbs of water at
normal operating pressure. For example, the total quantity of TSP utilized for a Na/PO4 of 3.0 to
achieve a boiler water phosphate level of 2 ppm would be 978 g or 2.13 lbs. Careful records of
the additions should be kept. With the blowdown valve normally closed, the only additions
required should be for average carryover and sample losses (hopefully less than 0.3%).
It is advisable to use good technical grade chemicals as specified by the American Chemical
Society. Any sodium hydroxide utilized should be of a grade specified by ASME PTC-31 (for
regeneration of condensate polishing resins). The latter (as crystalline material) should be stored
in a dry atmosphere as it readily absorbs moisture from humid environments. Since operation
should normally be with the blowdown valve closed or nearly closed, careful control of the
inventory of chemicals added must be maintained to ensure that additions are not being made to
correct for phosphate hideout.
Blowdown should be used only for contaminant control.
Reaction to Contaminants in Boiler Cycle
Condenser cooling water in-leakage or makeup water contamination can and will occur. The
reaction to this is dependent on the kind of contamination. Three examples could be:
caustic or acid contamination from makeup (or condensate polisher if utilized) regenerant
chemical leakage or
The reaction in all cases should be to increase blowdown, necessitating boiler water treatment
chemical addition to compensate for the loss, and in some cases variation of additions to correct
for such things as pH depression (caustic addition). Such caustic injection should never result in
the boiler water caustic concentration exceeding 1 ppm.
4-44
The ramp to full pressure is dependent on boiler design and boiler/turbine stress limitations.
Frequent analysis of the boiler water with emphasis on suspended solids and silica is
recommended. Suspended solids is a measure of the magnetite inventory and the source of
deposition and subsequent under-deposit corrosion. Silica is monitored out of concern for turbine
deposition.
Adjust boiler chemical feed to take advantage of tolerance for higher alkalinity at lower
pressure.
Anticipate boiler startup and begin pumping chemicals so that target treatment is in place
when boiler is fired.
Maximize boiler blowdown and perform bottom blow (if present) during startup when solids
are at their highest concentration.
With pressure increases above 1500 psi the phosphate residual should be allowed to slide
back to a concentration consistent with the guidelines values for PO43 versus pressure
(Figures 4-15 and 4-16).
Now is the time to conserve boiler blowdown since excess suspended solids have been
removed, chemical feed is stable and consistent. Boiler blowdown should be zero during
normal operation.
4-45
4-46
It is not an acceptable or effective practice to increase the reducing agent to counteract increasing
levels of air in-leakage. In the LP feedwater system (up to the deaerator) the reaction rate
between a reducing agent and oxygen is very low. The optimum practice is to monitor ORP at
the LP heater outlet (deaerator inlet) to ensure that reducing conditions are maintained. If air inleakage is allowed to be excessive with oxygen levels at the condensate pump discharge greater
than 10 ppb, then it is not possible to add sufficient reducing agent to make the low pressure
feedwater reducing (at deaerator inlet).
A number of alternate reducing agents have been introduced in the past several years and are in
use at some power stations. The main concern with the use of these alternate chemicals is their
thermal decomposition ( breakdown) products, which usually include organic acids and carbon
dioxide. The use of these chemicals must be carefully considered and the breakdown products
carefully evaluated before use in the cycle is allowed. Cation conductivity typically will be
elevated above the normal target value of 0.3 S/cm around the cycle when using alternate
treatments.
The cycle pH should be controlled in the range of 9.0 to 9.3 using ammonia. Ammonia should be
fed at the same location as with hydrazine. Separate lines are preferred.
Reagent grade chemicals are recommended to avoid any unknown contamination from chemical
additions (see Section 6.3 for further discussion).
A number of alkaline organic chemicals have been utilized to control pH. The same
admonishments apply to these chemicals as to hydrazine and alternatives, as previously
discussed. However, it should be remembered that the overriding philosophy of the EPRI
guidelines is that organic amines and organic reducing agents are not needed, required or
recommended in the fossil plant cycle.
The following target values at the deaerator inlet and the economizer inlet are required for proper
copper control:
Reducing agent (hydrazine or alternate) - to maintain an ORP of between -300 and -350mV
at the deaerator inlet (use minimum amounts of reducing agent to achieve the desired ORP)
(see Appendix B for further discussion on ORP and how reducing ORP levels depend on a
number of variables).
Maintenance of these parameters at the above levels should produce the desirable feedwater
copper level of 2 ppb or less.
4-47
4-48
4.4 REFERENCES
1. Cycling, Startup, Shutdown and Lay-up Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for
Operators and Chemists, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: August 1998. TR-107754.
2. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Phosphate Treatment for Drum Units, EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: December 1994. TR-103665.
4-49
5
CYCLES WITH DRUM BOILERS ON CAUSTIC
TREATMENT
Compared with AVT, the small amounts of sodium hydroxide added with CT, increase the
amount of chloride that can be tolerated, without initiating boiler corrosion. However, it is still
important to limit the chloride ingress and ensure that there is sufficient sodium hydroxide to
prevent potentially acidic conditions forming, whilst preventing excessive carryover into the
steam. Experience has shown that reducing the limits for chloride with increasing pressure
reduces the risk of initiating corrosion. Sodium hydroxide is required to raise the pH of the boiler
water to the desired range and additional sodium hydroxide is added to take account of the
chloride present, using a semi-empirical relationship NaOH = 2.5 Cl. It is well understood that
uncontrolled concentrations of sodium hydroxide may lead to caustic gouging in the boiler,
dryout is particularly dangerous. Excess carryover into the steam may result in damage to the
turbine and austenitic components in the steam circuit. Although far less common than phosphate
hideout, it is still possible for caustic to hideout. If this occurs, the reasons for it should be
investigated, since it might indicate dryout.
5-1
The core parameters are indicated with an asterisk (*).The instruments should be on-line and
monitored continuously. This is shown by C in the sample column.
There are a number of other parameters, which also have the designation C, since they
provide useful confirmation of the unit condition.
There are a number of parameters designated T for troubleshooting. They can be used if
other parameters are out of their normal guideline values.
The dissolved oxygen at the condensate pump discharge should be <10 ppb.
There is a limit for copper at the economizer inlet for units with copper alloys.
A reducing agent (hydrazine preferred) is required for units operating under reducing
conditions (essential when copper alloys are present in the feedwater heaters).
Sodium and cation conductivity at the condensate pump discharge provide cycle
contamination control in the event of condenser leaks and makeup malfunctions.
Dissolved oxygen control at the condensate pump discharge ensures optimum feedwater
redox potential (ORP) and provides an indication of air in-leakage.
Deaerator inlet ORP ensures reducing conditions to minimize copper transport when
operating with AVT(R).
Economizer inlet sodium (or condensate polisher effluent sodium) guards against polisher
malfunction and cycle contamination.
Boiler water cation conductivity is the main control for boiler water contaminants.
5-2
Figure 5-1
Cycle Chemistry Diagram for a Drum Unit on Caustic Treatment. All-ferrous and mixed-metallurgy feedwater systems. Operating with a reducing environment (reducing agent added) in the feedwater, AVT(R).
5-3
Figure 5-2
Cycle Chemistry Diagram for a Drum Unit on Caustic Treatment. All-ferrous feedwater systems. Operating with an oxidizing environment (no reducing agent) in the feedwater, AVT(O).
5-4
Boiler water pH, specific and cation conductivity are the main controls for ensuring
appropriate conditions for dealing with contaminants and minimizing corrosion.
Saturated steam sodium monitoring is required to monitor carryover, identify drum internal
failures and to prevent contamination of the steam to the turbine.
A series of curves have been developed which give smooth, continuous relationships for boiler
water target values as a function of pressure up to 17.2 MPa (2500 psi), the current limit of
operating experience for caustic treatment. These curves are designed to provide boiler
protection and ensure steam limits of 2 ppb sodium, chloride and sulfate, and 10 ppb silica.
The following boiler water limits are presented:
5-5
Figure 5-3
Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water pH vs. Operating Pressure. The dashed line indicates the
lower limit for pH to ensure that the pH of the boiler water is at least a minimum value to
reduce the risk of boiler corrosion.
5-6
Figure 5-4
Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Cation Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure
5-7
Figure 5-5
Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Specific Conductivity vs. Operating Pressure. The dashed
line indicates the lower limit for specific conductivity corresponding to the minimum pH
and NaOH concentration shown in Figures 5-3 and 5-6.
5-8
Figure 5-6
Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Sodium Hydroxide vs. Operating Pressure. The dashed
line indicates the lower limit for NaOH in the boiler water.
5-9
Figure 5-7
Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Sodium vs. Operating Pressure
5-10
Figure 5-8
Caustic Treatment: HRSG Boiler Water Chloride vs. Operating Pressure
5-11
Figure 5-9
Caustic Treatment: Boiler Water Sulfate vs. Operating Pressure
5-12
Figure 5-10
Caustic Treatment: Drum Boiler Water Silica vs. Operating Pressure
5-13
The boiler water control limits for chloride are based on 0.3 ppm for 17.2 MPa (2500 psi) plants,
as used by various operators of caustic treatment (see Table 1-4). Although higher chloride limits
have been used for low heat flux plants, this increases the risk of caustic gouging in high heat
flux areas, and makes it unlikely that 2 ppb limits for sodium, chloride and sulfate in steam
would be achieved. Table 1-3 shows how the limits for chloride in the boiler water at 16 MPa
(2400 psi) can be increased by factors of 2 at 10 MPa (1500 psi) and 3 at 6 MPa (900 psi),
respectively, while still minimizing the risk of initiating corrosion. The chloride concentrations
of 0.3 ppm at 17.2 MPa (2500 psi), 0.6 ppm at 10 MPa (1500 psi) and 0.9 ppm at 6 MPa (900
psi) have been used to construct the boiler water control curves for chloride (Figure 5-8).
The control curves for sulfate (Figure 5-9) are twice those of chloride. Both sets of curves are
below those calculated using the EPRI predictive model for 2 ppb chloride and 2 ppb sulfate in
steam (see Figures 3-15 and 3-16). A cation conductivity curve has been calculated from the
chloride and sulfate curves and is shown in Figure 5-4.
With caustic treatment a certain amount of sodium hydroxide is required to achieve the required
pH. In addition, there should be sufficient sodium hydroxide to combat the chloride. NaOH = 2.5
x chloride is commonly used. Curves for the minimum and maximum concentrations of sodium
hydroxide (Figure 5-6) can be obtained by allowing a factor of two, between maximum and
minimum, whilst still encompassing the NaOH = 2.5 x chloride factor. The maximum NaOH
concentrations correspond to 1.0 ppm at 17.2 MPa (2500 psi), 1.8 ppm at 10 MPa (1500 psi) and
2.5 ppm at 6 MPa (900 psi). pH (Figure 5-3) and sodium (Figure 5-7) curves can be calculated
from the NaOH concentrations. The sodium curves also allow for at least half the chloride and
sulfate being associated with sodium. The curve for sodium is just below that calculated using
the predictive model for 2 ppb sodium in steam (see Figure 3-14), demonstrating that higher
concentrations of chloride, sulfate and sodium hydroxide should not be present, if the 2 ppb
sodium limit in steam is to be obtained.
Curves for specific conductivity (Figure 5-5) can be calculated from the sodium hydroxide,
chloride and sulfate curves. The silica curves (Figure 5-10) are similar to the silica curves for
PC(H) and PC(L). Curves have also been prepared showing the relationships between specific
conductivity, cation conductivity and pH (Figure 5-11), and pH and equivalent sodium hydroxide
concentration (Figure 5-12).
Figure 5-12 clearly shows that, when applying CT, particularly at low NaOH levels, the
measured pH readings in the boiler water will be affected by any ammonia present and should
therefore be corrected. This may be accomplished by using the information in Figure 5-12.
Figure 4-5 is also applicable for making the correction with CT, providing the measured pH and
ammonia data are accurate and the boiler water sodium hydroxide concentration is 0.4 ppm
(equivalent to pH 9.0) or greater.
Specific and cation conductivities of the boiler water should be regarded as the main control
parameters for drum boilers operating on caustic treatment. Sodium in steam should be regarded
as the main protection against excessive impurities in steam.
5-14
Maintaining the boiler cation conductivity within the limits will provide boiler corrosion
protection and includes the effects of chloride and sulfate. It should be noted that chloride and
sulfate are designated as T parameters in the cycle chemistry diagram. Curves have been
provided for chloride and sulfate (Figures 5-8 and 5-9). The chloride curves are designed to
minimize the risk of initiating corrosion. Sulfate represents a lesser risk than chloride in initiating
corrosion, so the concentration of sulfate has been taken as twice that of chloride. Both sets of
curves are provided so that an organization can check chloride and sulfate levels, in cases where
the cation conductivity limits are exceeded. The chloride curves can be used directly, if there is a
continuous chloride analyzer. This is the preferred method, particularly where sea water is used
for cooling the condensers and should be designated as a C parameter in the cycle chemistry
diagram.
Monitoring specific conductivity, in conjunction with the cation conductivity, and pH can be
used as an indication of the sodium hydroxide concentration. Figure 5-11 shows the relationship
between specific conductivity and pH in samples cooled to 25C. Figure 5-12 shows the
relationship between sodium hydroxide and pH at 25C.
The curves for sodium in boiler water (Figure 5-7) are based on the sodium hydroxide required
to achieve the pH, plus an allowance for sodium associated with the chloride and sulfate.
Maintaining operation within the boiler water sodium limits should prevent excessive carryover
of sodium, chloride and sulfate into the steam. However, sodium in steam should be monitored
online. The curves for silica (Figure 5-10) are based on the need to limit the amount of silica
carried over into the steam and are derived from partitioning data. Silica is also designated a T
parameter.
Figures 5-3 to 5-10 contain curves for Action Levels 1, 2 and 3 above the normal operating zone.
Figures 5-3, 5-5 and 5-6 show curves for pH, specific conductivity and sodium hydroxide
concentration, respectively. The dashed lines in Figure 5-3, 5-5 and 5-6 indicate the lower limits
for pH, specific conductivity and sodium hydroxide. The area between the dashed line and
Action level 1 should be regarded as the normal operating zone.
Figures 5-1 to 5-8, modified if necessary to reflect specific unit characteristics and Figures 5-11
and 5-12, could be included in the plant operating procedures and displayed in the control room,
steam sample room and chemistry laboratory.
5-15
Figure 5-11
Relationship Between Specific Cation Conductivity, Cation Conductivity and pH at 25C for
Boiler Water with Caustic Treatment
5-16
Figure 5-12
Caustic Treatment: Drum Boiler Water Relationship Between pH and Equivalent Sodium
Hydroxide Concentration at 25C, Showing Effect of Ammonia Concentrations. The lowest
curve is at zero ammonia. The highest curve is at 2 ppm ammonia.
5-17
5-18
5-19
5-20
If the sodium hydroxide used for dosing is lost from the boiler, this is serious and it may be
necessary to stop adding NaOH. As a minimum it is necessary to:
h) Monitor hideout during load changes and carryover into steam.
If excessive hideout or loss from the boiler is occurring, this is also very serious and it may be
necessary to stop adding NaOH. It may be necessary to:
24
i) In very special cases a trial using a radioactive trader (Na OH) can be used to
determine the extent and location of the hideout.
5-21
Figure 5-13
Road Map for Conversion of Plants to Caustic Treatment
5-22
Figure 5-14
Road Map to Optimize Plants on Caustic Treatment
5-23
5.5 REFFERENCES
1.
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All-Volatile Treatment, Electric Power
Research Institute, Palo Alto, CA., 1004187, November 2002.
2.
Interim Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Combined Cycle Heat Recovery Steam Generators
(HRSGs), Electric Power Research Institute, Palo Alto, CA., TR-110051, November 1998.
3.
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All-Volatile Treatment, Electric Power
Research Institute, Palo Alto, CA., TR-105041, April 1996.
4.
Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: Phosphate Treatment, Electric Power
Research Institute, Palo Alto, CA., TR-103665, December 1994.
5.
Interim Consensus Guidelines on Fossil Plant Water Chemistry, Electric Power Research
Institute, Palo Alto, CA., CS-4629, June 1986.
6.
Cycling, Startup, Shutdown and Layup Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for
Operators and Chemists, Electric Power Research Institute, Palo Alto, CA., TR-107754,
August 1998.
5-24
6
PC AND CT CHEMISTRY CONTROL AND CORRECTIVE
ACTIONS
6-1
Traditionally, ammonia and hydrazine, added to increase the pH and remove residual oxygen,
have been used as the method of conditioning the feedwater. Oxygenated treatment (OT), where
a small amount of oxygen is added to the feedwater instead of a reducing agent, is now
frequently used for once-through boilers. OT is also being used for drum type boilers. Higher
purity feedwater is required for OT and for this reason such units should be equipped with
condensate polishing plants.
The experience gained with OT demonstrates that the traditional strict limits of low oxygen are
not required for the feedwater, provided that there are no copper containing alloys in the
feedwater heating systems. Indeed, the presence of traces of oxygen in the feedwater reduces the
risk of flow-accelerated corrosion in all-ferrous feedwater heaters. Where the concentrations of
residual oxygen are not excessive, it is also possible to condition the feedwater using only
ammonia, to increase the pH, without adding a reducing agent. This can also have the benefit of
reducing the risk of flow-accelerated corrosion in the feedwater system and connecting
pipework.
Mixed-metallurgy feedwater heating systems are unsuitable for use with OT and ammonia
without reducing agent. Low feedwater oxygen concentrations must be maintained by the use of
a reducing agent (hydrazine) in order to minimize the dissolution of copper and carryover and
deposition in the superheater and HP turbine.
All-volatile treatment (AVT) can be used for drum type boilers with no further addition of
conditioning chemicals, but being volatile, the alkalizing agent is rapidly lost from the boiler
water into the steam and very little remains as a buffer against the ingress of impurities. Also,
volatile additives are hardly dissociated at boiler water temperatures and, therefore, do not
provide much alkaline pH correction under these conditions.
The addition of solid alkalis to the boiler water, trisodium phosphate and/or sodium hydroxide
with PC and CT, allows operation with higher concentrations of impurities, without corrosion,
than is possible with AVT, because of the improved pH buffering capacity of trisodium
phosphate and sodium hydroxide towards potentially acidic impurities. Sodium hydroxide has a
lower buffering capacity than phosphate and the aim is to match the amount with the
concentration of impurities present. Such additions can be increased as a temporary protective
measure to protect the boiler during excursions in water purity, for example due to condenser
leaks. Even with PC, it may be necessary to add some sodium hydroxide to control the pH.
However, great care is needed to control the buildup of impurities and alkalizing agents to
prevent damage to the boiler and excessive carryover into the steam.
Even under apparently similar operating and water chemistry conditions, some plants are far less
tolerant than others and are more susceptible to corrosion and failures. Condenser leaks are often
the main source of impurities and, therefore, their incidence and nature of the cooling water has
an important bearing on the plant chemistry and corrosion. Similarly, some plants are much more
susceptible than others to carryover of impurities into steam. As indicated earlier, total carryover
is now a core parameter for units with drum boilers. Regular measurements of carryover and the
results, together with the actual history of the plant should to be taken into consideration when
implementing the guidelines.
6-2
Makeup water can also be a source of contamination, as can off-site sources of condensate and
contamination during storage. Condensate polishers are valuable in improving the quality of
condensate. Makeup plant and condensate plant malfunctions can also be sources of
contamination.
Target and Action Levels have been developed for makeup water quality, condensate, feedwater,
boiler water and steam. Information on sampling points, frequency of sampling, core and
diagnostic parameters, limits and action levels are given in earlier sections of the guidelines.
These should be adhered to and used as the basis of chemical control. It is essential that a full
QA/QC program is in place for recording, evaluating and storing the data (see Appendix E).
6-3
Ammonia
Feed
System
Insufficient
Boiler
Blowdown
Condenser
Leakage
Condensate
Polisher
Makeup
Demineralizer
1. Sodium
2. Chloride
3. Sulfate
4. Silica
Parameter
5. pH
6. Cat/Spec
Conductivity
7. Oxygen
8. TOC
9. Na:PO4
Ratio
10. Free
Hydroxide
11. Ammonia
12. Phosphate
Air Inleakage
Deaerator
Feedwater
Oxygen
Feedwater
pH
X
X
X
X
13. Iron
14. Copper
15. ORP
6-4
Polisher
Resin
Leakage
X
X
Reducing
Agent
Feed
System
Corrective Action
Condenser Leak Detection Trays
Sodium
Sodium*
Cation Conductivity*
Condensate Polisher Effluent
Cation Conductivity*
Silica
2. Regenerate polishers.
Sodium*
* Core parameters
6-5
Corrective Action
Deaerator Inlet
Dissolved Oxygen
Reducing Agent
ORP
Dissolved Oxygen
pH
Ammonia
Specific Conductivity
Cation Conductivity*
Iron
Copper
Reducing Agent
Dissolved Oxygen*
*Core parameters
6-6
Corrective Actions
Boiler Water or Blowdown
Sodium
Chloride
Sulfate
Silica
Cation Conductivity*
1. Increase blowdown.
2. Check phosphate, sodium to phosphate ratio, free sodium hydroxide,
adjust chemical feed as appropriate.
3. Identify source of contamination by checking makeup treatment system
effluent quality; condensate polisher effluent quality; condenser tube
leakage.
pH*
1. Check pH, sodium, free sodium hydroxide, adjust chemical feed within
allowed limits. Avoid over-dosing.
2. Monitor sodium in steam.
3. Increase blowdown, if appropriate.
*Core parameters
6-7
Corrective Actions
Saturated, Superheated and Reheated Steam
Sodium*
Chloride
Sulfate
Silica
Total Organic Carbon
Cation Conductivity*
*Core parameters
6-8
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
6-9
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
6-10
As 2, 3, 4 and 5 above.
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
As indicated, pH depression is symptomatic of contaminant ingress due to cooling water ingress via
condenser tube leaks in the vast majority of plants. However, there are a few plants where the cooling
water is alkaline, contains relatively low levels of chloride and sulfate and may not exhibit this tendency.
6-11
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
6-12
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
6-13
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
6-14
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
As 1 and 2 above.
3. Minimize air in-leakage by
eliminating sources.
4. Optimize layup procedures for
copper bearing components, e.g.
condenser & feedwater heaters.
5. Find root cause of copper alloy
corrosion and plan actions.
6. Replace copper alloys in high
pressure feed heaters asap.
7. Operate with reduced boiler
pressure when Cu concentration in
boiler water is above 50 ppb.
As 1 above, plus
superheater.
As 2 above.
3. Copper deposits in the HP
turbine and reduced MW
generating capacity and
efficiency.
Carbon Steel
1. Analyze iron in feedwater during
normal operation and startups:
high during cold startups show
layup corrosion.
2. Inspect shell condenser, shell
and tube sides of feedwater
heaters (particularly tube inlets),
audit FAC, audit of feedwater &
wet steam systems.
3. Check the concentrations of
oxygen, reducing agent and pH,
and their latest changes in
condensate and final feedwater.
Increased concentration of
reducing agent and reduced pH
can be the cause of the problem.
Copper Alloys
As 1 above for Cu, Ni and Zn.
2. Inspect copper alloy tubing used
in condensers and feedwater
heaters.
3. Check with maintenance for use
of copper-bearing thread
lubricants.
4. Verify the concentration of
reducing agent, oxygen, ammonia
and pH in condensate and final
feedwater.
5. Check air in-leakage and its
recent trends.
+
6-15
Actions to be Taken
1. Reduce load.
2. Increase blowdown to reduce
sodium phosphate concentration
in the boiler water and, at the
same time, bring pH within
recommended limits by chemical
additions.
Consequences+
1. Severe hideout can lead to
corrosion of waterwall tubes.
2. High concentration of sodium
hydroxide can lead to increased
boiler carryover.
6-16
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
1. Reduce load.
2. Increase blowdown to reduce
sodium phosphate concentration
in the boiler water and, at the
same time, bring pH within the
recommended limits by chemical
additions.
As 1 above.
2. Increase blowdown to reduce
sodium phosphate concentration
in the boiler water.
1. Concentration of sodium
phosphate in waterwall tubes in
high heat flux zones and
horizontal tubes.
2. Phosphate hideout and
possible waterwall tube
corrosion.
3. Increased sodium phosphate
in steam and deposition in
reheater and turbine leading to
overheat failures of reheater
tubes and MW loss.
6-17
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
Table 6-16
High Sodium Hydroxide Concentration in Boiler Water (Caustic Treatment)
Diagnosis
1. Check boiler water pH*,
conductivity*, sodium* and OH.
2. Check NaOH chemical
addition rate.
3. Check blowdown.
4. Check pH*, conductivity* and
sodium* in condensate, makeup
effluent and storage tanks.
5. Check pH, conductivity and
sodium in condensate polisher
effluent.
6-18
Actions to be Taken
1. If makeup and condensate
polisher effluent OK (no high
sodium or acid), increase
blowdown and reduce NaOH
feed rate.
2. Reduce load.
Consequences+
1. Caustic gouging corrosion of
boiler tubes in the areas of the
high local heat flux and steam
blanketing.
2. Foaming and increased boiler
carryover, particularly if organics
present.
3. Sticking turbine valves and
possibility of turbine destructive
overspeed, if deposits are built
up in the valve bushing.
4. If elevated NaOH in steam
persists, possibility of stress
corrosion cracking of LP blade
attachments, in the superheater
and elsewhere.
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
Phosphate Carryover
1. Take duplicate samples of
boiler water, saturated and
superheated steam and
condensate; analyze for Na*,
PO4, pH and conductivity.
2. Review chemical charts,
particularly pH, conductivity* and
sodium* in steam.
3. Check with control room
operators about boiler pressure,
drum level control and use boiler
circulation pumps (where
applicable).
4. Check with control room
operators and turbine engineers
about the turbine efficiency and
generating capacity and IP
turbine exhaust pressure trends.
5. Check the makeup and
polisher effluent sodium.
1. Reduce load.
2. Reduce boiler water
phosphate concentration to the
minimum normal limit.
3. Where boiler separation and
drum level control are causing
the problem, maintain the
reduced pressure and load until
the problem can be fixed.
4. Inspect superheater and
reheater for deposits.
5. Wash turbine as needed
(without disassembly at reduced
rpm).
1. Deposition of sodium
phosphate in the reheater and
turbine leading to overheat
failures of reheater tubes.
2. Loss of turbine MW and
efficiency.
3. Sticking turbine valves.
As 1 to 5 above.
1. Deposition of sodium
hydroxide in the reheater and
turbine leading to overheat
failures of reheater tubes.
2. Austenitic steels can crack
within hours.
3. Deposits and overheat failures
of reheater and superheater
tubes.
4 and 5 as 2 and 3 above.
6-19
Table 6-18
High Boiler Carryover and Contaminated Steam (Caustic Treatment)
Diagnosis
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
1. Reduce load.
2. Adjust drum level control as
needed.
3. Decrease sodium
concentration in the boiler water.
4. Analyze boiler water and
feedwater for organic
contamination and eliminate the
source.
6-20
Diagnosis
1. Analyze steam before and
after attemperation.
2. Discuss with Operations the
use of attemperating sprays.
3. Check feedwater sodium,
cation conductivity and copper,
and latest trends.
Actions to be Taken
Consequences
Table 6-20
High Concentrations of Acids and Salts in Steam
Diagnosis
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
1. Reduce load.
2. Correct drum level control, if
needed.
3. Find and correct the source of
acid impurities.
4. Reduce air in-leakage.
6-21
Consequences+
Diagnosis
Air In-leakage above the Hotwell Line
1. Check air eject of vacuum
exhaust air flow and its history.
2. Check condensate pump
discharge oxygen* and cation
conductivity* and their trends for
different recent loads.
3. Where air in-leakage is high
and oxygen is low, it is an
indication of air in-leakage above
the water line.
6-22
As 1 and 2 as above.
3. Frequent air in-leakage
locations are suction of
condensate pump, various
hotwell connections, improperly
designed makeup addition, pits
and holes at the bottom of the
condenser hotwell.
As 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5 as above.
Table 6-22
Colloidal Silica and Iron through the Makeup System
Diagnosis
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
Colloidal Silica
1. Compare silica (iron) in makeup
effluent, condensate storage tank,
condensate polisher in and out,
blowdown & saturated or hot reheat
steam. Feedwater silica (iron) higher
than polisher effluent or condensate
pump discharge indicates colloidal
silica (iron).
2. Analyze grab samples for total
organic carbon at the makeup system
effluent and condensate storage tank.
High TOC may be due to presence of
organic colloids containing silica (iron).
3. Filter makeup system and
condensate storage tank samples and
analyze filtrates.
4. Audit the pre-treatment and makeup
treatment system and measure
variation of the source water iron, silica
and organics.
As 1, 2, 3 and 4 as above.
Colloidal Iron
As 1, 2, 3 and 4 as above.
6-23
Actions to be Taken
Consequences+
1. Boiler corrosion.
2. Corrosion-generated iron and
copper oxides will precipitate and
redeposit in the boiler. Some will
be carried into the superheater
and turbine during startup.
3. Possible effects on turbine
MW generating capacity and
efficiency.
4. Iron and copper fouling of
condensate polishers.
1. Restore pH by injecting
ammonia and circulating boiler
water.
2. If there is a high concentration
of suspended oxides in the boiler
water, drain and refill the boiler.
6-24
Analysis of condensate (or feedwater) samples collected on each side of the chemical
injection point(s)-this approach is not likely to be beneficial except in cases of fairly
significant excursions that have no other apparent cause.
Isolation of the suspect chemical feed system(s) for a brief period and observing the impact
on cycle chemistry-this approach is most effective when the unit has satisfactory levels of
reliable on-line instrumentation, however, other chemistry parameters such as pH and ORP
will also be affected by this action.
Isolation of the suspect chemical feed system(s) and simultaneous startup of backup feed
system(s) with treatment chemicals of satisfactory purity-this is clearly a preferred practice in
units that provide redundant feed systems.
6-25
In cases where sampling of the treatment chemical for analysis is desired, consideration should
also be given to dilution water purity. This means that in units where the treatment chemicals
are diluted on-site prior to injection to the cycle, samples of diluted and undiluted chemical
solution should be collected. The last approach indicated can most easily be followed if a new
supply of the chemical is applied to the unit before all of the existing supply has been consumed.
As stated previously, cycle chemistry deviations caused by impurities in the treatment chemicals
are generally infrequent events of very minor magnitude. Therefore, the possibility exists that
extended and undetected unit operation with low levels of impurities present in the treatment
chemicals applied could ultimately result in or contribute to chemistry related damage in the
boiler and turbine. Traditionally, organizations have avoided such concerns through
development of chemical purchase specifications and through testing of chemicals received
from suppliers to verify compliance with specifications. However, in todays competitive
business climate, this approach is all too commonly minimized or eliminated. In those
organizations that purchase treatment chemicals on the open market and emphasize price rather
than purity, the importance of operating a unit with a new chemical supply and evaluating the
chemistry prior to consuming all of the previous supply should be readily apparent.
Ultimate responsibility for development of optimum treatment chemical specifications
applicable to individual fossil plants must remain with the organization. One reason for this is
that there are differences in chemical manufacturing, processing, dilution, packaging and
labeling practices around the world and there is no single chemical purity specification that can
adequately encompass the variety of product strengths and grades that may be available at any
given location. Also, the organizations chemical purity specification usually becomes part of a
legal agreement between the organization and the chemical supplier. Again, there are clearly no
general product specifications that will be universally applicable to all conceivable business
arrangements for provision of the needed chemical treatments.
In developing individual treatment product specifications, the ultimate goal is to ensure that
normal usage of the treatment chemical will not result in deviations from any of the plant
specific chemistry limits. This is applicable to normal operating conditions as well as chemistry
limits for any other operating conditions, such as wet layup, for which the chemical is to be used.
This goal is, in general, readily attainable providing that only fully deionized water is used to
dilute the active chemical. However, it is most reliably attained when ammonia is used for
feedwater pH control and hydrazine (when not prohibited and for reducing AVT in cycles with
copper) is used as the reducing agent. Use of neutralizing amines for pH control and of
alternative reducing agents, whether due to site prohibitions on hydrazine usage or for other
reasons, makes it more difficult to attain guideline chemistry values, particularly cation
conductivity, by virtue of the fact that these treatment chemicals are subject to thermal
degradation, resulting in formation of carbon dioxide and/or organic acids. Special care must
therefore be taken when establishing customized chemistry limits and action levels for fossil
units that are treated with these chemicals. Also, it should be recognized that the effects these
treatments have on the cycle chemistry tend to make it more difficult to identify the responsible
cause of minor deviations from normal chemistry.
6-26
A
OXYGEN REMOVAL TECHNIQUES FOR TREATED
MAKEUP
Previous Sections have described the importance of maintaining strict control to prevent
dissolved oxygen and carbon dioxide from entering the heat cycle in order to minimize iron and
copper corrosion and transport. It was noted that 40% of utilities surveyed by EPRI put aerated
water directly into the cycle, while 66% put makeup into storage tanks which are vented to
atmosphere.(1) It is obvious that these types of operating procedures are counter- productive if
corrosion is to be fully controlled.
This appendix describes methods by which makeup water can be deoxygenated (and some of
these methods also remove carbon dioxide) and stored in such a way as to prevent further
aeration.
Another important source of ingress of oxygen and carbon dioxide is air in-leakage via
negative pressure in the condenser and low end of the heat cycle. This subject is addressed in
Appendix C.
A-1
Water inlet
Packing
material
Packing removal
connection
Vapor removed
by vacuum pump
Degasified water
storage
Figure A-1
Vacuum Degasifier
The process of vacuum degasification is based on Henrys Law, which states that the
concentration of an ideal gas in solution is proportional to its vapor pressure (or partial pressure).
Therefore, if the pressure over a solution is reduced by a vacuum, dissolved gases must leave the
water and enter the vapor phase to establish a new equilibrium. Increasing the vacuum increases
the degree of gas removal.
The vacuum supply to the degasifier can either be steam jet ejectors or vacuum pumps. The
degasifier is typically located preceding the first anion unit of a demineralizer train in order to
minimize the ionic loading to the anion unit by removing carbon dioxide. Forced draft
decarbonators effectively remove carbon dioxide but saturate the water with oxygen.
Typical removal levels for a vacuum degasifier are: carbon dioxide to 5 ppb and oxygen to 10-20
ppb. Increasing the packing height in the tower and increasing vacuum will result in higher gas
removal.
The vacuum degasifier is quite tall, typically in the range of 25-40 feet (7.612.2 m). One reason
for this is to provide room for the packing material and the other is to provide sufficient suction
head for the transfer pump. Because of its height, vacuum degasifiers may be difficult to backfit
into an existing power plant arrangement. This equipment requires considerable maintenance in
order to maintain constant vacuum conditions. In addition, the vacuum equipment is relatively
energy intensive to operate.
A-2
(eq. A-1)
The reaction is stoichiometric, requiring equal amounts of hydrazine and oxygen for the reaction
to proceed to completion. At ambient temperatures this reaction proceeds very slowly. However,
in the presence of a catalyst, such as activated carbon, the reaction proceeds rapidly. Therefore,
this technology can and is being used to remove oxygen from makeup water. The equipment
consists of a vessel containing activated carbon to which hydrazine is fed using a positive
(3)
displacement chemical pump. The process is patented and is said to achieve makeup oxygen
concentrations less than 10 ppb.
Overall costs for the catalytic process are about $1.25 to $1.75 per 1000 gallons depending on
system flow rates.
This catalytic process can treat the water either going to storage or coming from storage.
However, when large quantities of water are required, such as during startups, it may be
impractical to provide equipment of sufficient size to meet such demands when processing water
from storage.
One disadvantage of this catalytic process is that carbon dioxide is not removed. Therefore, when
used in demineralizer systems treating waters high in bicarbonate alkalinity, operating costs can
be expected to be substantially higher than when using a vacuum degasifier, for example.
However, when the catalytic systems are used in conjunction with a membrane system, both
carbon dioxide and oxygen can be simultaneously removed (see discussion which follows under
membrane systems).
Another disadvantage associated with the carbon bed system is that an ion exchange bed is
(3)
required to remove excess hydrazine and carbon leachables from the effluent stream .
A-3
Vacuum and/or
sweep gas
Distribution
tube
Baffle
Cartridge
Aqueous
stream
Aqueous
stream
Hollow fiber
membrane
Collection
tube
Housing
Figure A-2
Components of a GTM Unit
By altering the partial pressure of a gas at the air/water interface, a driving force is created which
results in the mass transfer of a gas into or out of solution. There are three ways to alter the
partial pressure of a gas in a GTM system:
Use a sweep gas, usually nitrogen, which effectively lowers the partial pressure of other
gases such as oxygen and carbon dioxide
A-4
Water temperature
With a suitably designed system, oxygen levels of less than 1 ppb in the effluent water stream are
said to be achievable. An example of a GTM system used to remove oxygen from boiler feed
(4)
water at a petroleum refinery is shown in Figure A-3. In this case, two parallel trains of GTM
units are provided, each having 3-10 inch (7.625.4 cm) membrane contactors connected in
series. The nitrogen sweep gas is 99.9% pure, and flows at a rate of 1.5-2.0 scfm. Vacuum
requirements are ~ 25 acfm at 28 inches of mercury. The 200 gpm (760 litres/min) of product
water contains less than 15 ppb of dissolved oxygen.
An example of a hybrid system which combines both GTMs for carbon dioxide and a catalytic
(5)
oxygen removal system is shown in Figure A-4. This is an outsourced plant in use at a nuclear
facility.
99.9% N2
Reverse
osmosis
1
Municipal water
150 - 390 gpm
Concentrate
Product
water
200 gpm
GTM Skid #1
Vacuum
Ion
exchange
softening
Activated
carbon
5
depth
filter
99.9% N2
Reverse
osmosis
1
Concentrate
GTM Skid #2
Vacuum
Figure A-3
GTM System Process Flow Diagram (Note: 1 gal = 3.785 litres)
A-5
Anthracite
filters
Well
water
Reverse
osmosis
Storage
tank and
pump
RO reject
Up to 300 gpm
<5 ppb D.O.
Figure A-4
GTM System Process Flow Diagram (Note: 1 gal = 3.785 litres)
This GTM system consists of three skid-mounted contactors in parallel, a vacuum pump, valving
to allow an air sweep, and instrumentation to monitor vacuum level and air sweep volume. The
membrane system is primarily for carbon dioxide removal, but also removes some oxygen. (The
use of an air sweep rather than nitrogen probably limits the extent to which oxygen can be
removed in this part of the system).
Hydrazine injection occurs at the GTM effluent using a small, diaphragm positive displacement
pump. Any remaining oxygen in the RO permeate water reacts with the hydrazine as it passes
through two activated carbon vessels connected in parallel. The water then enters a three-bed ion
exchange system for further polishing. This system consists of a strong acid cation, strong base
anion and a mixed bed unit.
This hybrid system produces up to 300 gpm of purified water at less than 5 ppb of dissolved
oxygen. It is significant to note that the deoxygenated water is stored in a tank with a nitrogen
blanket. The tank effluent is tested daily for dissolved oxygen, which consistently measures
below 5 ppb.
A southwestern electric utility plant chose to utilize gas transfer membrane technology (GTM) to
reduce their dissolved oxygen levels to below 20 ppb prior to their demineralized water storage
(6)
tank . Their system consists of conventional ion exchange plus GTM to produce 500 gpm of
demineralized and deoxygenated water to storage. A unique feature of this system is that the
GTM is located after the strong acid cation and before the strong base anion unit. Thus, the GTM
is acting as a replacement for a forced draft decarbonator to remove the carbon dioxide generated
in the strong acid cation unit. Locating the GTM at this point appreciably reduces the load on the
anion unit while also removing oxygen.
A-6
These GTM systems can be skid mounted and installed easily in a minimum of space. One such
system(7) consists of two 1x1x1 (3 in series) arrays on two skids which produce a combined
effluent of 200 gpm at 15 ppb (or less) of dissolved oxygen. The two skids each occupy less than
370 cubic feet of space.
Overall costs for the GTM process are about $0.65 to $1.25 per 1000 gallons (3785 litres)
depending on the degree of oxygen removal required and the systems flow rate.
Floating covers
The use of plastic or rubber diaphragms to protect condensate storage tanks from oxygen ingress
has been very limited in the electrical generating industry. This is the result of relatively high
installed costs, high maintenance costs and the fear (perhaps justly so) that the diaphragm might
fail causing a major disruption in power plant operations. Also, diaphragms would be difficult,
and possibly impossible to install in existing tanks.
Floating covers have been in use, especially in petroleum refinery tanks, for many years. Their
purpose in this case is to prevent undue evaporation of volatile liquids. Here again, installation of
floating covers has not been popular at electrical generating plants for some of the same reasons
as given above for diaphragms. Backfit of floating covers on existing condensate tanks, while
perhaps possible, would certainly require considerable engineering and would undoubtedly be
quite expensive.
Probably the most feasible means to prevent oxygen ingress to condensate storage tanks is to
provide a nitrogen blanketing system. Such a system is relatively easy to install on existing tanks
and inexpensive to operate, given the low cost of nitrogen and the modest amount of nitrogen
required to operate the system.
(8)
One such system is shown in Figure A-5. This system has a nitrogen bottom sparger (A), inlet
pipe sparger (B), nitrogen supply and controls (D), oxygen or conductivity analyzer (F), tank
pressure control (C), and an overflow pipe (E). The sparging itself is through sintered stainless
steel sparging elements. Two pressure regulators control the nitrogen pressure to the spargers;
one for the bottom sparger and one for the inlet pipe sparger. This is followed by a passive
critical orifice flow element. This element prevents the nitrogen flow from exceeding the
capacity of the tank pressure control siphon, which vents the excess pressure.
A-7
By having a sparger in the inlet water supply to the tank, any residual dissolved oxygen in that
water should be effectively removed. The sparger in the bottom of the tank will prevent the
ingress of air.
The following costs are estimated to be associated with the system shown in Figure A-5(8) in year
2003 dollars:
Capital Cost: $22,000 to $32,000
Installation Cost: $5,500 to $11,000
Nitrogen Consumption Costs: $110 per month assuming storage tank inflows and outflows are
not excessive.
The system in Figure A-5 would most probably use cylinder nitrogen, because of the relatively
low consumption. The purity of cylinder (or cryogenic) nitrogen is 99.995%.
Other, simpler nitrogen blanketing systems merely provide a slight positive pressure in the
storage tank by using a small continuous flow of nitrogen applied at the top of the tank. This
design, as compared to the above, probably requires a larger consumption of nitrogen and lacks
the obvious advantage of the purge system for incoming water to the tank.
While removal of oxygen from makeup may appear costly at first glance, it is essential to the
proper control of iron and especially copper in the feedwater cycle. In the overall picture, the use
of deaerated makeup water will produce savings, since iron and copper corrosion and transport
will be reduced.
An innovative use for GTM systems involves minimizing oxygen ingress to an existing
(9)
demineralized water storage tank at a nuclear power generating facility . In this installation the
inlet water to the tank has been previously deoxygenated to less than 10 ppb. The tank is
equipped with a bladder to miinimize oxygen ingress. However, without continuous oxygen
removal, storage tank levels would gradually reach 1-2 ppm. A GTM system was installed on a
constantly recirculating kidney loop in a full-flow 100 gpm pilot plant test. Dissolved oxygen
levels in the storage tank were then consistently maintained to less than 10 ppb.
The conclusion reached from the full flow pilot plant test was that a recirculating GTM system is
a viable alternative to installing a nitrogen blanket, floating roof or diaphragm for maintaining
low levels of dissolved oxygen in a storage tank.
A-8
Sparging
element
E
Top View
Pipe
support
Sparging element
Inlet
B
A
Outlet
Orifice
F
Regulator
Option
Figure A-5
A Storage Tank Nitrogen System and Sparging Elements(8)
A-9
A.5 References
1. Survey of 63 Utilities. Fifth International Conference on Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry.
EPRI Proceedings. Edited by B. Dooley and J. Matthews TR-108459. December 1997.
2. S. Dominick, U.S. Filter Corporation, Personal Communication to A. Aschoff, August 2000.
3. R. C. Dickerson, W. S. Miller. U. S. Patent 4,556,492, Deoxygenation Process. December
3, 1985.
4. P. H. Kinghorn and W. E. Haas, Low Level Deoxygenation of Boiler Makeup Water Using
Gas Transfer Membranes. Proceedings of the International Water Conference, p. 527,
October 18-20, 1999.
5. S. B. Gorry, W. E. Haas, and J. W. Mahaffee, Effective Deoxygenation by a Process
Combining Gas Transfer Membranes with Catalytic Oxygen Reduction. Proceedings of the
International Water Conference, p. 535, October 18-20, 1999.
6. R. M. Mode, W. E. Haas and W. Greene, Dissolved Oxygen Reduction by Membrane
Technology to Reduce Feed Water Corrosion. Proceedings of the International Water
Conference, p. 406, October 20-24, 2002.
7. Ecolochem, Inc. Application Bulletin, December 5, 1999.
8. O. Jonas, Jonas Inc., Personal Communication to A. Aschoff, April, 2000.
9. J. Helmrich, W. E. Haas and J. E. Staton, Maintaining Storage Tank Dissolved Oxygen
Levels Utilizing Gas Transfer Membranes. Proceedings of the International Water
Conference, p. 207, October 22-26, 2000.
A-10
B
OXIDATION-REDUCTION POTENTIAL (ORP)
B.1 INTRODUCTION
Research investigating the electrochemistry of copper alloys under feedwater heater conditions
suggests that maintenance of a stable cuprous oxide layer requires tight control of oxidationreduction potential (ORP), also referred to as redox potential, plus dissolved oxygen and pH.
(As explained later, ORP, as measured in fossil plants, reflects a balance between the
concentrations of dissolved oxygen and reducing agent in the feedwater, although the value
measured in a given unit is also dependent on other factors.) Results of these research activities
are summarized in a guideline document for copper (1). The practical implications of the copper
research are reflected in the new target values for mixed metallurgy cycles indicated in this
(2)
report and in an earlier guideline report for all-volatile treatment (AVT) . Further,
electrochemical corrosion experiments have pointed out that, during unit shutdowns, elemental
copper and cuprous oxide will be converted to cupric oxide in a matter of hours, unless reducing
chemistry is maintained; research assessments of various copper alloys used in fossil plants has
(3,4)
indicated that cuprous oxide is most stable at ORP values of around 350 to 300 mV .
Effective implementation of reducing AVT feedwater chemistry in drum type fossil units where
the boiler water is treated with phosphate or caustic therefore requires that on-line surveillance of
ORP be practiced and that action be taken as needed in response to deviations from target values
for this parameter in the cycle.
EPRI has, for many years, been interested in real time measurements of corrosion rates in
generating plants and considerable effort has been devoted to development of analyzers for this
purpose. Commercially available monitors are available for surveillance of the electrochemistry
of the operating environment of interest. Field experience with these devices is most extensive
in the nuclear power industry, with both in situ and sidestream analyzers in use, but generally
limited in the fossil industry to ORP analysis of conditioned samples. Most of the early field
experience in fossil plants has been with ORP surveillance of final feedwater at the economizer
inlet. However, findings of EPRIs Program Copper clearly indicate the deaerator inlet to be the
preferred monitoring point for ORP due to the difficulty of maintaining reducing conditions in
(1)
the low pressure heaters .
B-1
Fossil plant experience with ORP measurement has shown the benefits of using ORP analysis as
part of the control strategy to minimize corrosion and transport of copper-based feedwater heater
materials. This experience also indicates that confusion exists, with respect to the physical
meaning of ORP measurements, interpretation of ORP data and its relation to other chemistry
data and, in some cases, how to set up an ORP monitoring capability. This appendix, adapted
from a technical paper (5) prepared by a team of electrochemistry, materials and corrosion experts,
provides the information fossil plant personnel need to be aware of when establishing ORP
monitoring capabilities in the mixed metallurgy units for which they are responsible.
B-2
In a sense, this is always the case, because all engineering alloys suffer general corrosion, but
most systems also display simultaneously or under slightly different potential conditions, one or
more forms of localized corrosion. This is an important issue, because the blind application of
potential control techniques may simply substitute one problem for another.
Table B-1
Classification of Corrosion Processes Showing the Potential Conditions for their
Occurrence (5).
Form of Corrosion
Critical Potential
General Corrosion
E gc
Pitting Corrosion
E cp
c
E scc
c
Ecorr > Escc
Localized attack in the presence
E cfc
c
E FAC
c
Ecorr > EFAC
. Localized attack, generally of
E cc
c
Ecorr > Ecc
. Localized attack within a high
E Hc
B-3
Unfortunately, confusing terminology has evolved with regard to the term potential, with the
result that the term is often incorrectly used or is taken to mean different things in different fields
of power plant technology. Suitable working definitions of various potentials that are reasonably
consistent with other fields of electrochemistry and corrosion science are summarized in Table
B- 2. The potential of a metal exposed to a condensed, ionically conducting medium measured
against a suitable reference electrode in the same system is referred to in the broad sense as the
electrochemical potential.
It should be noted that this terminology is in unfortunate conflict with similar terminology used
in electrochemical thermodynamics in referring to the chemical potential that has been modified
to include electrical work. The problem has been compounded in recent years by researchers and
workers in the nuclear power industry referring to the corrosion potential as an electrochemical
(5)
corrosion potential (ECP), particularly in studies dealing with BWRs . Another example is
the use of the term oxidation/reduction potential (ORP) in fossil fuel power plant technology
to describe what is in reality the redox potential of the system. The term redox potential has a
specific, well-defined meaning in electrochemistry that is synonymous with ORP, as used in
fossil plant technology.
Table B-2
Definitions of Various Potentials Encountered in Corrosion Science and Engineering,
Particularly in Thermal Power Plant Technology (5)
Term
Electrochemical Definition
Potential
Electrochemical
Potential
Corrosion potential.
Equilibrium
Potential
Equilibrium potential
Standard
Hydrogen
Electrode
Potential
Reference
Potential
B-4
Redox Potential
Corrosion
Potential
Open Circuit
Potential
Critical Potential.
B-5
As noted earlier, ORP is defined as the potential that is measured at an inert indicator electrode
(e.g., platinum) in contact with a solution containing electrochemically active, redox species(6).
Generally, the system is not at equilibrium and, furthermore, the redox species generally are not
2+
3+
conjugately related (for example, if the solution contained Fe and Fe , the species are referred
3+
to as being conjugate, because they are related by the charge transfer reaction, Fe + e
2+
Fe ). Indeed, complex aqueous systems generally contain many conjugate pairs. These include,
2+
3+
1+
2+
for example, in the case of mixed metallurgy fossil unit feedwater systems, Fe /Fe , Cu /Cu ,
+
H2/H , and O2/H2O in a partially aerated aqueous solution contained within carbon steel and
cuprous materials (pipe or tube), with H2 being produced by corrosion, for example.
The Nernst equation (discussed further later) is often used incorrectly to calculate ORP in
complex systems containing multiple conjugate redox couples; however, the use of the Nernst
equation is possible only if a single conjugate couple is present, because, only in this case, can
the system be in electrochemical equilibrium. Even then, the Nernst equation can be used only if
the redox reaction is reversible and the system is in equilibrium. Reactions that are notoriously
irreversible or quasi-reversible, for which the use of the Nernst equation is excluded, include the
oxygen electrode reaction (OER). If more than one conjugate couple is present, the system is not
(8)
in equilibrium, and the potential is calculated as a mixed potential . The basis of this issue is
examined below.
In Figure B-1, is plotted the partial and total currents for two independent redox couples in the
system, each characterized by an equilibrium potential ( E1e and E 2e , respectively) and an
exchange current density ( i0,1 and i0, 2 , respectively). The curves were generated using the
general Butler-Volmer equation for a redox reaction, R O + ne , as (8):
i=
e (EE
) / ba
e
e ( E E
) / bc
1 e ( E E ) / ba e ( E E
+
i0
il , f
il , r
) / bc
(eq. B-1)
where ba and bc are the anodic (forward direction) and cathodic (reverse direction) inverse Tafel
constants for the redox reaction, and il , f and il ,r are the corresponding mass transfer limiting
currents. In fossil power _plant systems, Subscript 1 might refer to the hydrazine electrode
reaction, N 2 + 4 H + + 4e N 2 H 4 , and Subscript 2 to the oxygen electrode reaction (OER),
O2 + 4 H + + 4e 2 H 2 O , but it is stressed that the reactions could be any of a large number of
possible charge transfer processes involving redox species, depending upon the composition of
the system. Equation B-1 is strictly valid for i0 << il,f, il,r., but it is a very good approximation if i0
is no greater than about 0.1 times the limiting current densities. This is normally the case in
corrosion and redox systems.
B-6
1e-5
o
T = 25 C
[H2] = 10 ppb
HER
OER
Total Current
1e-6
1e-7
[O2] = 5 ppb
pH = 7
d = 10 cm
v = 5 cm/s
e
E her = -0.351 Vshe
e
E oer = 0.757 Vshe
Eredox = 0.139 Vshe
1e-8
1e-9
1e-10
Eredox (ORP)
1e-11
1e-12
1e-13
-1.0
e
her
-0.5
0.0
0.5
1.0
e
oer
1.5
Potential, Vshe
Figure B-1
Calculated current-voltage curves for the hydrogen electrode reaction (HER), the oxygen
electrode reaction (OER) and the total polarization curve (sum of those for the HER and
OER) for a system containing 10 ppb H2 + 5 ppb O2 at 25 C. Note that the ORP must lie
between the equilibrium potentials for the HER and the OER.
B-7
A more accurate approach is to express the partial reactions for the forward and reverse
directions as:
if =
e ( EE
) / ba
(eq. B-2)
1 e ( E E ) / ba
+
i0
il , f
and
ir =
e ( E E
) / bc
1 e ( E E
i0
il , r
) / bc
(eq. B-3)
with
i = i f + ir
(eq. B-4)
Note that if and ir are positive and negative quantities, respectively, while the exchange current
density, i0, is a positive quantity. Thus, the total current density for two redox reactions in the
system becomes:
i = (il , f + il ,r )1 + (il , f + il ,r ) 2
(eq. B-5)
where subscripts 1 and 2 signify the two reactions. Solution of Equation B-5 for E at i = 0
(8)
yields the redox potential (ORP) .
Before proceeding further, it is necessary to express the parameters in Equations (2) and (3) in
terms of specie concentrations. Thus, the exchange current densities for the two conjugate
reactions can be expressed as:
C
i0 = i R0
CR
0
0
CO
0
C
O
(eq. B-6)
where i00 is the standard exchange current density, C R0 and CO0 are the concentrations of the
reactant and product, respectively, in the standard state (assigned values of unity), and and
are constants that are related to the reaction orders, which can be determined experimentally
(common) or by examining viable reaction mechanisms (less common), and the stoichiometric
coefficients for the reaction.
B-8
The limiting current densities are most conveniently expressed as dimensionless correlations
between the Sherwood number and the Reynolds and Schmidt numbers for a particular flow
geometry/regime in a specified solution (9). The dimensionless correlations are of the form:
Sh = A Re a Sc b
(eq. B-7)
(eq. B-8)
where Cb is the bulk concentration of the species under consideration, n is the number of
electrons involved in the oxidation or reduction reaction, and F is Faradays constant. Note that
Re, Sc, and Sh are dimensionless quantities and that correlations of the type in Equation (B-7)
have been developed for many systems. For example, the correlation for pipe flow under
(10)
turbulent conditions is given as :
(eq. B-9)
Thus, in fossil plants, corrosion processes, once initiated frequently proceed until failures are
experienced unless the electrochemical environment is changed.
An important rule-of-thumb in analyzing ORP data is that the redox potential lies closest to the
equilibrium potential for the fastest conjugate pair. It is sufficient to note at this juncture that
the speed of a charge transfer reaction is measured by the exchange current density and the
Tafel constants, with the faster reactions having larger values for the exchange current density
and smaller values for the Tafel constants. If the components of one conjugate pair are at
sufficiently high concentration, the redox potential may approximate the equilibrium potential of
that couple. This is illustrated in Figure B-2 at low [O2] values, where the measured redox
potential, as would be detected by a platinum indicator electrode, approaches the hydrogen
(5)
equilibrium potential . Note that because the oxygen electrode reaction (OER) is a very slow
reaction, even on platinum, the ORP does not approach the equilibrium potential for the OER,
even at oxygen concentrations as high as 10 ppm.
1.0
Eeoer
Potential, Vshe
0.8
0.6
o
T = 25 C
[H2] = 10 ppb
0.4
[O2] = X ppb
0.2
pH = 7
d = 10 cm
v = 5 cm/s
0.0
Oxidizing
ORP
Reducing
-0.2
Eeher
-0.4
-0.6
1e-4
1e-3
1e-2
1e-1
1e+0
1e+1
1e+2
1e+3
1e+4
1e+5
[O2], ppb
Figure B-2
Calculated equilibrium potentials for the Hydrogen Electrode Reaction (Eeher) and the
Oxygen Electrode Reaction (Eeoer) and the calculated redox potential (ORP) for the system
10 ppb H2 + X ppb O2 at 25 oC. Note that, generally, the ORP approaches the equilibrium
potential for the HER at very low oxygen levels, but does not approach the equilibrium
potential for the OER at very high oxygen levels.
B-10
Upon increasing [O2], and hence upon increasing the ratio [O2]/[H2], the potential is observed to
shift sharply in the positive direction as oxygen exerts an increasingly strong effect over the
potential of the electrode. This sigmoid dependence of the potential on the ratio of redox
species is highly characteristic of redox systems and is a feature that strongly differentiates redox
systems from equilibrium systems, where the potential varies linearly with the logarithm of the
ratio of the electro-active species concentrations within a single conjugate system at equilibrium
(i.e., as described by the Nernst equation).
Figure B-2 provides a clear interpretation of the meaning of ORP as measured in a fossil plant
feedwater system. Thus, the ORP reflects the balance between various conjugate redox systems,
such that the resulting potential (ORP) is the potential at which the total interfacial current is zero
(8,11)
. Since the partial current for any given reaction (e.g., R1 O1 + n1e) is a function
(commonly linear) of the concentration of the reactant (in this case, R1), the ORP reflects the
composition of the system with respect to electro-active species. Of prime importance, however,
is the impact that these species have upon corrosion. While the ORP (which is measured using a
platinum indicator electrode) must not be confused with the corrosion potential, the value of the
ORP is a useful indicator of the corrosivity of the environment.
Fe Fe 2+ + 2e
(eq. B-1)
1 / 2O2 + H 2 O + 2e 2OH
(eq. B-11)
B-11
For instance, the partial oxidation reaction corresponding to Reaction B-11 would be:
2OH H 2 O + 1 / 2O2 + 2e
(eq. B-12)
However, the rates of the forward and backward reactions of the oxygen electrode reaction
(OER) are usually quite small, so that the oxygen electrode usually displays poor reversibility,
even on platinum, and the redox potential seldom agrees with the equilibrium potential
calculated from thermodynamics. On the other hand, the hydrogen electrode reaction is fast
and the calculated and measured potentials are normally in excellent agreement, as indicated in
Figure B-2 at very low oxygen concentrations with reducing agent present.
When the substrate also oxidizes (corrodes), the picture is altered significantly in that the current
due to that oxidation reaction must be added to the total current flowing across the interface. In
the mathematical sense, this is equivalent to adding another redox reaction to the system, in
which the reduced conjugate species is the metal substrate. Thus, charge balance at the interface
can be expressed as:
N
icorr ( E ) + iO / R , j ( E ) = 0
(eq. B-13)
j =1
where icorr ( E ) is the current density for the oxidation of the metal substrate and iO / R , j ( E ) is the
current density for the jth redox couple, as given by Equation (1). The E contained in
parentheses emphasizes that the currents are functions of the potential. Indeed, solving Equation
B-13 for E yields the desired corrosion potential, commonly referred to by power industry
personnel as the electrochemical potential (ECP).
Equation B-13 forms the basis of the Mixed Potential Model (MPM), which has been used
extensively and successfully for many years to calculate corrosion potential (ECP) values in
(12)
power plant coolant circuits (particularly in nuclear units) . This work, directed towards
understanding and control of corrosion processes that effect nuclear plant components, in
particular steam generators, has resulted in considerable interest in and application of ECP
techniques. ECP measurement and the MPM, while certainly applicable in principle to fossil
cycles, have not been evaluated or applied extensively to the operating environment which exists
in these units. However, the value and benefits of the MPM and ECP monitoring to fossil units
may be considered under EPRIs Program Boiler Corrosion activities.
In summary, while ORP and corrosion potential are measured in a similar way, the former
reflects the oxidative/reductive power of the environment, while the latter reflects the corrosion
reaction occurring on the metal surface. The corrosion potential normally (but not always)
reflects the ORP, in that an increase in ORP will normally be accompanied by an increase in the
corrosion potential, but ORP and corrosion potential seldom have the same value. ORP
measurement is a useful tool for control of the feedwater chemistry in fossil units with copper
alloy heaters. ECP has no clear role within the context of Cycle Chemistry Guidelines at this
time but could become important in the future as work under Program Boiler Corrosion
proceeds.
B-12
AgCl + e Ag + Cl
(eq. B-14)
2.303RT
log(aCl )
F
(eq. B-15)
o
where E Ag
/ AgCl is the standard potential and a Cl is the activity of chloride ion in the internal
o
solution of the electrode. The standard potential is given as a function of temperature (t, C) as:
o
E Ag
/ AgCl =
0.23732-5.28194x10-4t-2.440055x10-6t2
(eq. B-16)
where R is the gas constant (R = 8.31441 J/K.mol), F is Faradays constant (F = 96,487 C/equiv),
and T is the temperature in Kelvin (t C + 273.15).
B-13
Activity is often referred to as being the thermodynamic concentration (as opposed to the
real concentration) and is defined as:
aCl = Cl (mCl / mClo )
(eq. B-17)
where Cl is the activity coefficient (a dimensionless quantity), mCl is the molal chloride ion
concentration, and mClo is the molal concentration of chloride in the standard state ( mClo = 1
mol/kg). The activity coefficient may be measured experimentally (e.g. from solubility or
isopiestic studies) or may be calculated using various models for electrolyte solutions (14). At any
rate, Cl is a function of the ionic strength of the solution, which, for a solution of a 1:1 salt
such as KCl, is equal to the concentration.
Examination of Equation B-15 reveals that the only independent variable is the activity of
chloride. Accordingly, if this quantity is not controlled, considerable error may be incurred in
using a silver/silver chloride reference electrode. The errors commonly arise from the fact that
the electrode contains a liquid junction for electrolytic communication between the electrode
internal environment and the external (test) environment. Flow of solution through this junction,
commonly as a result of pressure changes in the environment, can result in considerable changes
in chloride concentration in the internal environment and hence in significant errors in the
reference potential.
This problem is effectively overcome by using a saturated solution of a chloride salt (e.g., KCl)
+
+
+
in the inner compartment. Thus, for a saturated solution of MCl (commonly, M Li , Na , K ),
in which solid MCl is in equilibrium with the solution, the equilibrium solution process may be
described as:
MCl ( s ) M + + Cl
(eq. B-18)
(eq. B-19)
(eq. B-20)
1/ 2
, and substitution of this
(because m M + = mCl for the solution of a 1:1 salt). Thus, aCl = K sp
relationship into Equation (15) yields the Nernst equation as:
o
E e = E Ag
/ AgCl
B-14
2.303RT
log10 ( K sp )
2F
(eq. B-21)
However, Ksp is a system constant that is not a function of composition (but does depend on
temperature and pressure) and hence no independent variable now exists in the Nernst equation.
Accordingly, for a given temperature and pressure, Ee is fixed unequivocally, provided that solid
KCl remains in the inner reference electrode compartments. At the saturation vapor pressure of
pure water, the temperature dependence of the equilibrium potential for the Ag/AgCl/KCl(sat) on
the SHE scale is given by:
2
3
Esssce=0.3835-2.1251e-4*T-1.4894e-6*T +2.1927e-10*T
(eq. B-22)
(eq. B-23)
B-15
When making corrosion potential and ORP measurements, it is important to use a voltmeter with
an input impedance that is sufficiently high that current does not flow through the reference
electrode. Current flow would cause the reference electrode to polarize and give inaccurate
readings. This is particularly important in test environments (such as high purity water) that have
12
very low conductivities. An electrometer with an input impedance exceeding 10 ohms is usually
adequate in these low conductivity solutions, but higher input impedances may be necessary in
some cases. The selection of a higher input impedance is often accompanied by an increased
sensitivity to AC pick-up and noisy measurements. Where the electrometer allows selection of
the input impedance, the optimum setting can be achieved by starting at a very high input
impedance, then reducing the input impedance stepwise until the corrosion potential reading
begins to drift or change in an unexpected fashion, indicating polarization of the electrodes. At
this juncture, the input impedance should be increased immediately to a somewhat higher value
so as to eliminate the polarization.
Factors Influencing Fossil Plant ORP Readings
Two important reactions that influence the ORP of a fossil power plant environment can be
written as follows:
+
O2 + 4H + 4e 2H2O, E eoer =1.228 - 0.0591pH + 0.0148log(pO2)
(eq. B-24)
(eq. B-25)
where E eoer and E eher are the equilibrium potentials for the oxygen electrode reaction and the
hydrogen electrode reaction, respectively, at 25C, stated with respect to a standard hydrogen
electrode (SHE); and pO2 and pH2 are, respectively, the partial pressures of oxygen and hydrogen
in the environment. The two-directional arrows in Equations B-24 and B-25 indicate the
reversibility of the reactions, but it is emphasized that the OER seldom, if ever, displays the
(16)
equilibrium potential given by Equation B-24 .
As previously discussed, the ORP lies closest to the equilibrium potential for the principal redox
couple in the system (that with the greatest exchange current density), with the
thermodynamically mandated relationship E eher < ORP < E eoer . So, it is clear that environments
containing dissolved oxygen have a higher ORP than those containing hydrogen at all pH values.
Furthermore, while the equilibrium potentials decrease by about 59 mV for each increase of 1 pH
o
unit at 25 C (77 F), the ORP may change at quite different rates, depending upon the pH
dependencies of the exchange current densities for the various redox reactions in the system, as
shown in Equation B-6. The ORP also decreases as the partial pressure of oxygen decreases and
the partial pressure of hydrogen increases, although not necessarily as indicated by the
equilibrium Equations B-24 and B-25, because the ORP is, fundamentally, a kinetic property of
the system.
B-16
Nevertheless, the ORP may be used to control or monitor the oxidizing power of fossil plant
feedwater on oxygenated treatment and to control flow-accelerated corrosion, or, most
importantly, to assure the desired reducing environment in the feedwater of mixed-metallurgy
systems, which can only be accomplished by keeping the oxygen level low (<10ppb) and adding
a reducing agent..
Designation of a feedwater system being oxidizing or reducing is somewhat subjective,
because the use of those terms requires careful definition of the metallurgy in the circuit and in
particular the susceptibility of the metallurgy to various forms of corrosion. Thus, for a
feedwater system that contains copper alloys, the recommended practice (1) is to operate under
reducing conditions by adjusting the water chemistry to yield a redox potential of 300 mV
[Ag/AgCl/KCl(sat)] or 101 mV (SHE), or lower. (Note that the conversion from the
Ag/AgCl/KCl(sat) scale to the SHE scale at ambient temperature is affected by adding 199 mV
to the former also see Table B-3). This is normally done, by adding a reducing agent, such as
hydrazine, to the feedwater, which contains a low level of oxygen (<10 ppb). Assuming that
hydrazine acts electrochemically like hydrogen, the molar ratio required to achieve this condition
-3
is calculated to be about 10 , based on the hydrogen equivalence of hydrazine of 2 (N2H4 N2 +
2H2) (Figure B-3). In this figure, the calculated redox potential is plotted versus the molar ratio
of oxygen to hydrogen for four different hydrogen concentrations. The redox potential describes
a sigmoid variation with the molar ratio, and is predicted to be insensitive to the hydrogen
concentration except under reducing conditions, where the hydrogen electrode reaction
dominates the redox behavior. One important feature displayed by these calculations is the high
sensitivity of the redox potential to small amounts of oxygen in the system. Thus, noting that the
equilibrium potential for the hydrogen electrode reaction is of the order of 0.39 Vshe, the addition
of 0.0001 mole of oxygen per mole of hydrogen at very low molar ratios has the effect of
shifting the redox potential in the positive direction by 200 mV. This feature has been observed
(8)
experimentally in simulated BWR environments .
B-17
0.4
0.3
2ppb H2
5ppb H2
0.2
10ppb H2
20ppb H2
0.1
0.0
-0.1
T = 25 oC
d = 10 cm
v = 5 cm/s
-0.2
-0.3
-0.4
1e-5
1e-4
1e-3
1e-2
1e-1
1e+0
1e+1
1e+2
In any event, achieving a redox potential as low as 0.3 Vshe requires very low oxygen levels
(Figure B-3), and the use of a reducing agent. On the other hand, oxidizing conditions are now
(17)
recommended for all-ferrous feedwater systems , primarily to produce a dissolution-resistant
Fe(III) oxide (e.g., -Fe2O3) in the outer layer of the passive film. This requires the redox
potential, as measured at ambient temperature, to be 0.2 Vshe or greater (Figure B-3). At lower
potentials, the steel is covered by a magnetite (Fe3O4) barrier layer and a magnetite outer layer,
which is susceptible to both oxidative and reductive dissolution, depending upon the exact value
of the redox potential. It should be noted that it is also possible to define oxidizing and
reducing conditions in terms of the molar ratio of the oxidizing and reducing species in the
coolant, as shown in Figure B-3. A redox neutral system has a molar ratio of 0.5, as indicated
by the arrow and corresponding to the complete consumption of both species should reaction
occur between them (2H2 + O2 2H2O). Because of the differences in molecular weight
between oxygen and hydrogen, the weight-based (ppb) concentration ratio (ppbO2:ppbH2) is 8.
B-18
Finally, it is important to note that the practical classification of systems being oxidizing or
reducing for a given molar ratio is sensitive to temperature, because of the effects of
temperature on the kinetics of the redox reactions. Accordingly, great care must be exercised
when using redox potentials measured at ambient temperature to infer the state of the system at
temperatures that are several hundred degrees higher. It is for this reason that redox and
corrosion potentials need to be obtained for the high temperature regions of interest, either by
direct measurement or by correcting the ambient temperature values to elevated temperatures by
(8)
using a mixed potential model of the type that was employed for constructing the figures in this
paper and of the kind that has been used extensively for calculating ECP in BWR coolant circuits
(6-8, 12)
.
Returning now to Figure B-3 and noting that to convert a potential reading from the SHE scale to
the Ag/AgCl, KCl(sat) scale it is necessary to subtract 200 mV; accordingly, the redox neutral
potential (RNP) defined above is about 0 V [Ag/AgCl, KCl(sat)]. However, in this region, the
ORP is very sensitive to small changes in the balance between reducing and oxidizing species
and the potential may swing one way or the other, depending upon the monitoring system design.
Interpretation of Fossil Plant ORP Data
The implication for fossil units may be stated as follows: If the oxygen concentration in the
feedwater is low (<10 ppb) and a reducing agent (e.g., hydrazine) is added to the cycle then the
ORP [Ag/AgCl, KCl(sat)] will be somewhere around 200 to 300 mV, and the reading clearly
indicates that the fluid is reducing. Then, with the other extreme of no reducing agent but adding
oxygen, the ORP will be around 100 mV (300 mV SHE) or higher. The feedwater is then clearly
oxidizing. However, if only the reducing agent is eliminated with no additional oxygen, then the
ORP will be somewhere between 100 mV and +50 mV [Ag/AgCl, KCl(sat)] depending on the
oxygen and conditions as above. Under these circumstances, it is difficult to specify
categorically the redox state of the system, because the coolant is poorly redox buffered and even
trace amounts of redox species (including corrosion products), often below the limits of
detection, can cause the ORP to deviate from the redox neutral state. Furthermore, the redox
neutral potential (RNP) is known to depend upon the relative exchange current densities of the
OER and the HER and it is possible that, for any given sensor, the RNP may be negative, even
though the system is actually oxidizing in nature. It is for this reason that the redox sensor
should be internally calibrated on known plant coolant conditions, if the opportunity arises. In
principle, fitting the MPM to the plant data and calculating the potential for the appropriate mole
ratio of oxidizing to reducing species will then yield the RNP.
As might be expected, the ORP is similarly influenced by the presence of other redox reducing
agents, such as hydrazine, carbohydrazide, and hydroquinone, and ORP measurements are often
(18, 19)
used to ensure that hydrazine levels are maintained at correct levels
. Further details of how
and why ORP and corrosion potential measurements are made in power plants can be found
elsewhere (20,21).
B-19
Reference electrodes should never be allowed to dry out. They should be kept immersed in
saturated KCl solution at all times between applications.
The KCl internal solution must be maintained in the saturated state by ensuring that solid
KCl is present at all times.
Reference electrodes should be maintained in groups, with all electrodes being connected to a
common bus and all being maintained in the same saturated KCl electrolyte. Thus, if any
difference exists between two electrodes, shorting of the leads will cause the two to discharge
to a common (correct) voltage.
Ideally, all reference electrodes should be calibrated periodically, because they tend to change
with time. The apparatus needed to make such a calibration using a hydrogen electrode as the
(22)
standard is described in ASTM G5-87 . The rate that a reference electrode degrades depends
partly on the type of service it sees and the contaminants it picks up from the service
environment. For instance, a silver/silver chloride (Ag/AgCl) electrode, commonly used for both
corrosion potential and ORP measurements at temperatures up to 300 C (572 F), is susceptible
to irreversible damage if contaminated with sulfide. The formation of silver sulfide on the
electrode surface causes a permanent change to occur that cannot be fixed by recalibration.
Calibration may also be impossible if the silver chloride component has been reduced to silver
by hydrogen that has diffused through the reference electrode internal electrolyte from the bulk
environment. Dilution of the internal electrolyte (usually potassium chloride, KCl) with the bulk
environment may also occur, especially at high temperatures (e.g. above 200 C or 392 F) and
when there is a pressure differential between the inside and outside of the reference electrode
chamber, as noted previously in this paper. Dilution of the KCl will cause the reference potential
to drift from the initial value, so periodic replacement of this solution is recommended in
electrode designs that allow this.
B-20
Convert From
Potential (mV)
Versus Reference
Electrode #1*
(Listed Below)
To SCE
To Ag/AgCl
(3M KCl)
To Ag/AgCl
(sat. KCl)
To SHE
20C
68F
25C
77F
30C
86F
20C
68F
25C
77F
30C
86F
20C
68F
25C
77F
30C
86F
20C
68F
25C
77F
30C
86F
From SCE
+34
+35
+36
+45
+45
+45
+247
+244
+241
From Ag/AgCl
(3M KCl)
-34
-35
-36
+11
+10
+9
+213
+209
+205
From Ag/AgCl
(sat. KCl)
-45
-45
-45
-11
-10
-9
+202
+199
+196
From SHE
-247
-244
-241
-213
-209
-205
-202
-199
-196
*
Ag/AgCl = silver chloride; SCE = saturated calomel electrode; SHE = standard hydrogen electrode.
Note: the presence of liquid junction potentials may result in the listed conversion factors being in error by 1 or 2 mV.
B-21
ORP Probe
As noted earlier, the great majority of ORP probes used in fossil power plants use one type of
reference electrode: the Ag/AgCl reference electrode. Also, fortunately, the internal electrolyte in
the reference electrode, which influences the electrode potential, is typically a solution of
potassium chloride having a concentration in the range 3M to saturated. An increase in the
chloride concentration over this range would decrease the reference electrode potential by no
more than 11 mV for a temperature in the range 20C to 30C (68 to 86 F); see Table B-3.
Since an error of 11 mV would be considered small for most practical ORP measurements,
knowledge of the precise KCl concentration is usually not an issue at near-ambient temperatures.
Corrections for KCl concentration may be necessary if the ORP is measured at higher
temperatures. Nevertheless, confusion has arisen when ORP values measured versus a Ag/AgCl
reference electrode are inadvertently compared with others measured versus an SCE or converted
to the SHE. (Note that there is no such thing, physically, as a Standard Hydrogen Electrode.
Instead, the SHE scale is simply a hypothetical scale that was developed in thermodynamics to
permit various electrodes to be compared against one another). Consequently, it is essential that
the reference electrode used for the measurement is always specified along with the measured
ORP values [e.g., ORP = 100 mV (Ag/AgCl, KCl(sat))].
Again, when comparing ORP measurements, they should be referred to the same reference
electrode scale. As described above, the conversion factors shown in Table B-3 can be used to
convert from one reference electrode scale to another.
The instrument used to measure ORP may be calibrated using standard solutions that have
known ORP values. For instance, one possible set of standard ORP reference solutions are based
on pH 4 and pH 7 buffer solutions, similar to those used for pH meter calibration. However, for
ORP standards, quinone and hydroquinone of specified concentrations are added to the buffer
solutions, giving rise to a reversible redox couple. Hydrogen ions participate in the reaction
between the quinone and hydroquinone, creating a pH dependent equilibrium:
+
C6H4O2 + 2H + 2e C6H6O2
Quinone (Q)
(eq. B-26)
Hydroquinone (HQ)
with
B-22
The quinhydrone solutions are prepared by dissolving 10 grams of quinhydrone in one liter of
pH 4 or pH 7 buffer solution (24). Quinhydrone is not very soluble, so only a small amount will
dissolve in the buffer solution, changing it to an amber color. However, it is important that
excess quinhydrone be used, so that solid crystals are always present. The quinhydrone powder
poses a moderate health risk, causing irritation of the lungs with prolonged exposure to the dust.
The calibration solutions are fairly innocuous unless ingested in large amounts.
For the pH 4 and 7 quinone solutions, ORP values of about 263 mV and 86 mV, respectively,
o
can be expected at 25C (77 F) when measured against a Ag/AgCl, KCl(sat) reference electrode
(21, 24, 25)
. These values are consistent with a change of 59.0 mV per pH unit, which in turn is
consistent with the calculated value of 2.303 RT/F (= 59.2 mV at 25 C or 77 F) in Equation B27. ORP values for the standard solutions at other temperatures and for other reference
(24)
electrodes are provided in ASTM D1498-93 and are reproduced in Table B-4.
Table B-4
Expected ORP Values for Reference Quinone Solutions at pH 4 and pH 7 (Source:
Reference 23).
Reference
Electrode*
pH 7 Buffer Solution
20C
(68F)
25C
(77F)
30C
(86F)
20C
(68F)
25C
(77F)
30C
(86F)
Ag/AgCl
268
263
258
92
86
79
SCE
223
218
213
47
41
34
SHE
470
462
454
295
285
275
The quinhydrone standards are easily made, but they are stable for only about 8 hours and are not
expected to yield highly reproducible ORP values at longer times. Nevertheless, ORP values in
freshly prepared solutions are expected to be within 10 mV of the values listed in Table B-4, and
an ORP value measured with a probe in one of these standards can usually be considered
acceptable if it lies within 30 mV of the listed value. If the electrode does not respond as
expected or has a slow response, it should be cleaned and the calibration procedure repeated.
Removal of oily or organic deposits can be achieved by washing with a detergent or, if
necessary, methanol or isopropyl alcohol. For removal of inorganic contaminants or mineral
deposits, the electrode should be soaked in 10% nitric acid for 10 minutes. Alternatively, ASTM
(24)
D1498-93 suggests the use of warm (70 C or 158 F) aqua regia for about one minute . As a
last resort, the platinum surface can be polished with a 600 grit wet-dry emery cloth or a 1-3
micron alumina polishing powder to remove any stubborn coatings or particulates. The electrode
will need to soak in tap water or purified water for at least 30 minutes after performing any of
these cleaning procedures.
B-23
A single point calibration (or standardization) like this is often considered adequate, because
ORP meters, unlike pH meters, do not (yet) have slope calibration to allow adjustment of the
response to a specified change in ORP. Nevertheless, it is usually good practice to verify that the
ORP probe (platinum/reference electrode combination) is operating in a predictable fashion by
measuring the ORP in a second standard solution. If the electrode potential does not change by
the expected amount, the electrode should be cleaned and re-calibrated, as described above.
Other ORP calibration solutions are available based on the ferrous/ferric cyanide
[ Fe(CN ) 36 / Fe(CN ) 64 ] or ferrous/ferric sulfate equilibrium reactions, but the quinhydrone
standards are more widely used. Also, it has been suggested that a saturated sodium sulfite
(26)
solution could be used to verify instrument response to negative ORP readings .
B-24
B.8 REFERENCES
1. Guidelines for Copper in Fossil Plants, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2000. 1000457.
2. Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Fossil Plants: All-Volatile Treatment: Revision 1, EPRI, Palo
Alto, CA: 2002. 1004187.
3. Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2002. 1000456.
4. Influence of Water Chemistry on Copper Alloy Corrosion in High Purity Feedwater, EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: 2002. 1004586.
5. B. Dooley, D. Macdonald, and B. C. Syrett, ORP The Real Story for Fossil Plants,
PowerPlant Chemistry, vol. 5, No. 1, pp. 5-15 (Jan. 2003).
6. D. D. Macdonald, I. Balachov, and G. Engelhardt, PowerPlant Chemistry, 1(1), 9 (1999).
7. R. B. Dooley and D. E. Hubbard, Latest Developments in Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry.
Power Plant Chemistry, 2000, 2(7), pp 389-395.
8. D. D. Macdonald, A. C. Scott, and P. Wentrcek. Redox Potential Measurements in High
Temperature Aqueous Systems. J. Electrochem., Soc., 128, 250-257 (1981).
9.
10. J. R. Selman and C. W. Tobias, Adv. Chem. Eng., 10, 211 (1978).
11. T. Tsuruta and D. D. Macdonald. Measurement of pH and Redox Potential in Boric
Acid/Lithium Hydroxide Buffer Solutions at Elevated Temperatures. J. Electrochem. Soc.,
128, 1199-1203 (1981).
12. D. D. Macdonald, Viability of Hydrogen Water Chemistry for Protecting In-Vessel
Components of Boiling Water Reactors. Corrosion, 48(3), 194-205 (1992).
13. D. D. Macdonald, A. C. Scott, and P. R. Wentrcek. External Reference Electrodes for Use
in High Temperature Aqueous Systems. J. Electrochem. Soc., 126, 908-911 (1979).
14. D. D. Macdonald, Reference Electrodes for High Temperature Aqueous Systems - A
Review and Assessment. Corrosion, 34(3), 75-84 (1978).
15. D. J. G. Ives and G. J. Janz, Reference Electrodes, Theory and Practice, Academic Press,
1961.
16. J. P. Hoare, The Electrochemistry of Oxygen, Interscience, NY, 1968.
17. R. B. Dooley, The Relationship between Cycle Chemistry and Performance of Fossil Plants.
Power Plant Chemistry, 2002, 4(6), pp 320-327.
B-25
18. S.J. Shulder. Using ORP Measurements to Control Hydrazine Feed. Presented at the 1999
Southwest Chemistry Workshop, Steamboat Springs, Colorado, August 11-13, 1999.
19. S.J. Shulder, M.A. Janick, E.C. Gwin and S.T. Filer. Measuring Oxidation-Reduction
Potential (ORP) and Its Use In Controlling Oxygen Scavenger Injection. EPRI. Presented at
the Sixth International Conference on Cycle Chemistry in Fossil Plants, Columbus, Ohio,
June 27-29, 2000.
20. S. Filer, Power Plant Chemistry Measurement Advancements: Oxidation Reduction
Potential, Australia Power Station Chemistry Conference, New Castle, New South Wales,
Australia (March 1998).
21. S. Filer, A.S. Tenney III, D. Murray and S.J. Shulder, Power Plant ORP Measurements in
High Purity Water, NUS International Chemistry On-Line Process Instrumentation Seminar,
Clearwater Beach, FL (November 1997).
22. ASTM G5-87, Standard Reference Method for Making Potentiostatic and Potentiodynamic
Anodic Polarization Measurements, ASTM, Philadelphia, PA (1987).
23. B.C. Syrett and W.C. Micheletti, Reference Manual for On-Line Monitoring of Water
Chemistry and Corrosion: 1998 Update. EPRI, Palo Alto, California. TR-112024, April
1999.
24. ASTM D1498-93, Standard Practice for Oxidation-Reduction Potential of Water, ASTM,
Philadelphia, PA (1993).
25. L. McPherson, Chemical Engineering, p. 143-145, March 1994.
26. Personal Communication with S.J. Shulder, Constellation Power Source Generation Inc,
August 2000.
B-26
C
AIR IN-LEAKAGE MONITORING AND CONTROL
C.2 ROTAMETERS
Excess air in-leakage not only affects iron and copper corrosion and subsequent deposition, but
can also increase turbine backpressure, which directly reduces electrical generating capacity. A
complete analysis of the effects of air in-leakage on condenser efficiency was made (2, 3) using a
multisensor probe. This multisensor probe and its use in measuring air in-leakage is further
described later in this Section.
Typically, utilities employ a rotameter at the exhaust of the steam jet air ejector or mechanical
vacuum pump to quantify air in-leakage. This was the standard approach at the time plants were
designed and constructed. Manual readings were planned to be taken, normally once a day,
however, current manpower often restricts this. Air in-leakage can increase and remain at
potentially damaging levels for hours or possibly days before the excess in-leakage is discovered,
since turbine backpressure may not have increased significantly or noticeably.
C-1
Under certain conditions, rotameters provide adequate flow rate measurements of air in-leakage.
However, many factors can affect the accuracy of the readings so obtained, such as debris,
exhauster pulsations, water carryover, etc. Rotameters also have limited range, generally 10:1.
Therefore, most problematic air in-leakages cause the rotameter to be pegged against the high
level stop. Rotameters receive essentially very little maintenance and are checked very
infrequently at many plants. In these situations, the operator has no idea of the extent of the air
in-leakage, given the fact that the turbine backpressure rise may appear to be rather small and
insignificant.
In an attempt to mitigate these inherent problems with rotameters, a series of instruments were
developed which featured continuous readouts of air in-leakage. These earlier developments had
some serious drawbacks, such as not being able to distinguish between water vapor and air; and,
operating under the principle that the condenser exhaust gases were always at saturation, when in
fact, they were not.
Air in-leakage
Volumetric flow
Air density
Total pressure
Temperature
C-2
Pressure
port
Temp.
reference
RS
sensor
port
Flow
sensor
Figure C-1
Multisensor Probe (courtesy of Intek, Inc)
Air in-leakage, as measured by the MSP(2) is the sum of all leak sources entering the
subatmospheric pressure system and subsequently flowing through the exhauster line upstream
of the sensor location. The MSP, however, does not measure air entering the low-pressure
system beyond that (downstream), such as at valves, input connections, and shaft seals. The MSP
does measure the exhauster capacity, which is useful to gauge the effectiveness of the exhausters
to remove the gas mixture from the condenser.
C-3
Evaluation and analysis of condenser system performance and measurement of in-leakage is best
accomplished with the use of multiple MSP probes such as shown in Figure C-2. Each probe is
identified by a number that is used to categorize performance information and to help pinpoint
possible leak locations since air in-leakage is removed primarily through the air removal section
closest to the leak. As illustrated in Table C-1 and Table C-2, a self validating arrangement can
be established that will allow the accuracy of all probe locations to be identified.
Condenser
Figure C-2
Multisensor Probe Instrument Schematic
C-4
Exhauster 2
Exhauster 1
Table C-2
MSP Probe Indications for Various Probe Positions
Leak Location
1 = 2.5 SCFM
2 = 2.5 SCFM
3 = 5 SCFM
4 = 0 SCFM (exhauster 2 not in service)
5 = 5 SCFM
1 = 15 SCFM
2 = 18 SCFM
3 = 33 SCFM
4 = 16.5 SCFM
5 = 16.5 SCFM
1 = 20 SCFM
2 = 20 SCFM
3 = 40 SCFM
4 = 20 SCFM (Differences due to reversed flow
5 = 60 SCFM through shaft seal being sensed)
C-5
C-6
Moisture
outlet
Sample
flowmeter
Hydrogen
metering
valve
Pump
Catalyst
assembly
Hydrogen
flowmeter
Water
trap
Dessicant
dryer
Sample
inlet
Exhaust
flowmeter
Solenoid
valve
Air
metering
valve
7mm
filter
Exhaust
Electron
capture
cell
Pressure
regulator
Hydrogen
supply
Figure C-3
Flow Schematic for SF6 Analyzer System
C-7
Sample inlet
Dessicant
tower
Copper cooling
coil
Water trap
Air mover
To exhaust
system
SF6 analyzer
Water
discharge
Strip chart
recorder
Figure C-4
Schematic Diagram of SF6 Sampling System
C-8
Exhaust
Hydrogen
tank
SF6 can generally be used wherever helium can be used, although the converse may not always
be true and there are situations in which use of helium is preferred. The following guidelines
may be applied:
If unit air in-leakage is in excess of 10 CFM, either gas may be used. If less, SF6 is preferred.
If the unit is running at greater than 20% turbine power, either gas may be used. If the unit
has no turbine power and the leak is so bad that the unit can not be brought up to any turbine
power level, standard procedure would dictate the use of helium.
The search for the cause of air leakage below the steam space requires the use of SF6 as the
standard procedure.
Inspections of units of less than 50MW capacity should always use helium.
The determination of air in-leakage using tracer gases requires a great deal of experience and a
considerable outlay of capital if the necessary equipment is to be purchased. There are, however,
consulting firms specializing in the evaluation of air in-leakage. These firms have their own
equipment and are well versed in this technology. A typical study is estimated to cost between
(5)
$3500 and $5000 in todays market .
C-9
At the first indication of increased air in-leakage (scfm readings above the established base,
increased backpressure, higher dissolved oxygen), a leakage test is initiated. An important part of
the program is the establishment of a checklist, which delineates all of the various sampling
points and their location at each plant elevation. For example, the turbine room sample points are
broken down by directions- north, south, east and west relative to the turbine.
The equipment used for air in-leakage detection is a helium mass spectrometer. The detector is
located at the vacuum pump or steam ejector exhaust. A unique feature of the program is the use
of a wireless video camera, which constantly focuses on the readings of the air in-leakage
detection unit. The results (leakage or no leakage) are transmitted to the operator via a remote
wireless receiver. Thus, only one person is required to conduct a test, minimizing manpower.
The detection instrument has an internal vacuum pump and requires a dry sample for proper
operation. The inlet sample tubing is passed through a cooling coil embedded in ice, followed by
two water traps in series prior to entering the instrument.
Tests start at the top of the unit, working down, since helium, being lighter than air, will rise. If
testing started at the bottom of the unit, the rising helium would be sucked into leaks further up,
severely hampering interpretation of results.
Most tests are conducted at medium, or preferably, at full load, to maximize condenser vacuum
and, subsequently, potential air in-leakage. At times, however, it is necessary to test at low loads
to determine leakage at those areas of the low end of the cycle that are under pressure at high
loads but under vacuum at low loads. An example would be the low pressure feedwater heaters.
Some examples of sampling points which are emphasized in the test procedure are condenser and
condensate pump expansion joints, various flanges and pipe fittings, turbine horizontal shell
flanges, turbine rupture diaphragms, turbine shaft seals, various turbine penetrations, pipe plugs,
valve packings, etc.
Helium is sprayed at each test area at low pressure, about 10 psi, for only about 2-3 seconds to
prevent too much helium from escaping, which could result in false readings and
misinterpretations. It is necessary to note any extraneous air currents at a particular sampling
location to prevent helium from spreading out and causing false leak indications.
Generally, to save time, a group of adjacent test points are sprayed with helium at the same time.
If there are no leaks found, the next group of test points is sprayed. However, if leaks are
recorded, further tests are required to isolate the offending location. A record of leak location is
made together with the relative intensity of the leak.
Another practice, which is followed on a periodic basis, about once per year, is to flood the
condenser with water to above the tube sheet and to look for water leaks from possible cracks in
the condenser shell, attached piping welds or valve packings. Before performing this operation it
will be necessary to determine explicitly whether the structural supports provided are sufficient
to hold the extra weight of water within the condenser.
C-10
Results of all testing are submitted to the maintenance staff at the plant for necessary repairs,
replacements, etc.
This program has been very effective in reducing oxygen and carbon dioxide from entering the
cycle. Corrosion and corrosion transport have been reduced substantially since the program has
been initiated.
Another utility experience highlighting the economic value of finding and repairing air leaks was
(7)
reported at a recent EPRI Conference .
Recent developments in understanding the shell side dynamics of condensers(8) have shown that
condenser defects cause air blanketing, affecting the condensers effective heat transfer
coefficient. These regions are subcooled and have a significant concentration of noncondensable
gases with high partial pressure. Therefore, they can contribute greatly to dissolved gases and
corrosion even though air in-leakage is low.
C-11
C.6 REFERENCES
1. D. W. Reynolds, Dynegy Midwest Generation, Personal Communication to A. Aschoff,
April 2002
2. J. W. Harpster, Intek Inc., On Understanding Mechanisms that Control Dissolved Oxygen in
Condenser Condensate. Proceeding of the 21st Annual Electric Utility Workshop, University
of Illinois, Champaign, IL, May 8-10, 2001.
3. W. H. Stroman and J. W. Harpster Continuous Monitoring for Condenser Air In-Leakage
Presented at the 2002 Spring Meeting, ASME Research Committee on Power Plant and
Environmental Chemistry, Charleston, SC, March 11-13, 2002
4. La Porte and R. E. Putman, The Practical Application of SF6 and Helium for Condenser
Tube and Air In-leakage Detection. Proceedings of the 19th Annual Electric Utility
Chemistry Workshop, University of Illinois, May 11-13, 1999.
5. La Porte, Conco Services Corp., Personal Communication to A. Aschoff, April 2000.
6. Condenser In-Leakage Guideline. Electric Power Research Institute, Palo Alto,CA.:
TR-112819, 2000.
7. W.A. Kaufman, Experiences with Steam Cycle Air Ingress at Alliant Energy Fossil Plants:
Case Studies Documenting the Effects of Air In-Leakage on Steam Plant Operations,
presented at the EPRI Condenser Technology Seminar, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: September
2002. 1004116.
8. J.W. Harpster, An Overview of a Comprehensive Study of Condenser Shell Side
Dynamics, EPRI Seminar, San Antonio, TX, Sept. 1012, 2002.
C-12
D
BENCHMARKING A UTILITYS CHEMISTRY
ORGANIZATION
D.1 INTRODUCTION
Utility chemists often ask how good or bad they are in terms of their cycle chemistry operation
and organization, and where do they rank with other utilities for a utility of their size. If such
questions were answerable then they would be able to use the information as the first step in
justifying new cycle chemistry equipment, or improvements to their current ability.
Insufficient quantitative data exist to rank utilities in terms of chemically influenced availability
loss, reliability and performance degradation. For example, the NERC/GADS database has not
continued to collect boiler tube failure (BTF) mechanistic data since the finish of EPRIs Boiler
Tube Failure Reduction Program (BTFRP) in 1991.
An initial attempt was made with EPRIs Cycle Chemistry Improvement Program (CCIP) to
measure a utilitys improving cycle chemistry by monitoring a series of direct and indirect cost
indices. This was very successfully used by the CCIP participating utilities.
Currently most utilities require short payback periods with associated accurate savings to justify
cycle chemistry equipment and improvements.
Much thought has been given to this topic and the current assessment methodology will provide
an initial assessment for rating a utilitys chemistry organization. Participation and survey by a
large number of utilities over the next year will solidify the rating. It could also be used by
individual utilities to monitor improvements.
D-1
D-2
> 30,000 MW
20-30,000 MW
10-20,000 MW
< 10,000 MW
Factor
Weighting
3
A.
Points
Total
0%
< 5%
5-15%
15-30%
> 30%
0
1
2
3
4
B.
2
0
2
0
D-3
Weighting
2
Factor
C.
Points
Total
100 %
90-99 %
70-89 %
< 70%
0
1
2
3
0
1
2
Chemical Cleaning
Frequency of cleaning boilers with
mixed-metallurgy feedwater heaters
< 5 years
5-10 years
> 10 years
3
2
1
Weighting
E.
D-4
< 5 years
5-10 years
> 10 years
3
2
1
Points
Total
$/1000 gals)
0
1
<0.3 %
0.3 0.5 %
>0.5 %
0
1
2
<0.2 %
>0.2 %
0
1
Rating System
Excellent/World Class
Very good
Good
Average
Below Average
<5
6-10
11 15
1630
>30
D-5
Hydrogen damage
Caustic gouging
Corrosion fatigue
Fireside corrosion
Short-term overheating
Pitting (economizer)
Short-term overheating
For further information on BTF Mechanisms, see Boiler Tube Failures: Theory and Practice.
B. Dooley and W. McNaughton. TR-105261.
D-6
Measurement Locations
Cation Conductivity
CP Discharge
Cation Conductivity
Cation Conductivity1
Blowdown or Downcomer
Cation Conductivity
Dissolved Oxygen
CP Discharge
Economizer Inlet
pH (Drum Boilers)
Blowdown or Downcomer
Sodium
CP Discharge
Sodium
Sodium
D-7
E
CYCLE CHEMISTRY DATA QUALITY
E.1 INTRODUCTION
Effective fossil plant cycle chemistry programs consist of several components. These include:
Provision of a suite of on-line analyzers consistent with the selected treatment approaches
Implementation of operating practices and procedures that allow for maintaining desired
chemistries under all operating conditions
These aspects have been addressed in detail as they apply to fossil units with drum type boilers
operating on phosphate and caustic treatments. In this section, other important aspects of cycle
chemistry surveillance and control are discussed, including the following.
Monitoring methods
Quality assurance and control requirements, including on-line analyzer chemistry data
validation practices
These important aspects of cycle chemistry programs are addressed in ensuing subsections.
However, it should be noted that this appendix represents a summarized account of best available
practices in these areas. Users of these guidelines seeking additional details are strongly
encouraged to consult the source documents on which this presentation is based.
E-1
E-2
The frequency with which a grab sample is taken is another factor affecting its
representativeness. Samples should be taken at a frequency high enough to sufficiently monitor
critical conditions that could reach intolerable limits. Also, the sampling frequency should be
influenced by periods of load changes. For example, during startup, thermal transients release a
variety of contaminants throughout the cycle that should be closely monitored. Also, the increase
in the makeup requirement during these load swings introduces a greater risk of obtaining high
oxygen levels unless provision is made to remove oxygen as part of the treatment (Appendix A).
At such times, oxygen should be very closely monitored.
E.2.2 Potential Problems in the Design and Operation of Sampling Systems
It is important to be aware of the potential problems in the design and operation of sampling
systems. The causes of sample degradation and contamination within the tubing are numerous.
One factor contributing to contamination is crud bursts caused by sudden increases in velocity.
In addition, if the velocity of sample flow is not high enough and if suspended particles are
present, deposition may occur. Chemical reactions within the tubing may also contribute to
sample degradation. Some of the chemical reactions that can occur include
reaction of oxygen with hydrazine (or proprietary reducing agents), corrosion products,
and/or base metals;
E-3
Another source of potential problems in a sampling system is the sample cooling equipment.
Avoiding cooling water shell-side deposits and corrosion and maintaining a constant sample flow
rate through the cooling devices are important considerations.
There are also many possibilities for the degradation of a grab sample during collection and
storage. Such potentials for sample degradation are especially critical for pH, conductivity,
dissolved oxygen, and hydrazine analyses. Special preparation of grab samples and/or sample
containers may be required, depending upon the type of analysis being performed. Chemicals are
often added to the container before the sample is added to prevent sample degradation. Also,
collection methods for samples to be analyzed for pH, conductivity, dissolved oxygen, ammonia,
hydrazine, or organics must exclude any contact between the sample and the air. In addition,
storage methods and holding times of samples from collection to analysis require special
consideration to avoid degradation of samples. Applicable procedures for collection, preparation
of sample containers, and sample storage and preservation are given in ASTM D 3370-95
(26)
Standard Practices for Sampling Water , and in ASTM D4453-02, Standard Practice for
Handling of Ultra-Pure Water Samples(27).
E.2.3 Sample Collection
Obtaining a representative sample of superheated steam requires special sampling techniques.
The goals are to avoid deposition of suspended and dissolved solids from the superheated steam,
avoid effects caused by pipe surfaces, and withdraw representative amounts of all phases (steam
vapor, solid particles, and water droplets).
Sampling of steam and water for on-line and grab sample chemical analysis can represent a
major source of errors. Changes of up to several orders-of-magnitude in concentration of
dissolved and suspended impurities have been observed when sample withdrawal, cooling,
and/or transport are not properly performed. Recognizing this problem, EPRI established
research project RP2712-8 to define priorities for sampling points and monitored parameters. By
analyzing collected samples from a supercritical unit, the project team found that particulates
(magnetite) in steam can transport significant amounts of contaminants. On the basis of their
findings, the team designed a new isokinetic sampling nozzle, which can collect particulates in
superheated steam and impurity-rich water droplets in saturated steam. The team evaluated the
sampling system using the new nozzle at four utility plants.
Investigations demonstrated that the preferred sampling location for fossil cycles with reheat is
(3)
the hot reheat steam pipe. This report describes the following in detail:
the optimum location of a sampling nozzle in a long vertical section of a steam pipe
the method of nozzle attachment of a steam pipe and nondestructive inspection methods
the location of depressurizing valves and placement of sample coolers as close to the valves a
possible
E-4
In all, evaluations showed that the EPRI Nozzle provides a representative total sample of the
impurities involved.
The nozzle extracts isokinetically a homogeneous sample from a flow region removed from the
pipe inner surface and representative of the average flow velocity of the sample fluid. This
arrangement results in the withdrawal of the sample with representative concentrations of
dissolved, suspended, and volatile constituents. Isokinetic nozzles are equally applicable for
liquid samples (condensate), especially when sampling for particulates, such as magnetite or
copper oxides.
An appropriate nozzle is selected for the desired sample flow and typical conditions of the
sample fluid. When the flow rate (velocity through the pipe) changes, sample flow should be
adjusted to maintain isokinetic sampling.
A summary of sampling criteria is depicted in Table E-1.
E-5
Criteria
Saturated Steam
from Steam Leads
Superheated Steam
E-6
E-7
Temperature Regulation
Temperature reduction should always be carried out before pressure reduction to prevent
flashing, which results in deposit formation. Roughing coolers, located as close to the sample
point as possible, are used to cool the sample to approximately 100F (38C). Isothermal baths,
placed as close to the analyzers and grab sample points as possible, should be used to cool the
sample and maintain it at 77F1F (25C0.5C). This eliminates the necessity of making
temperature corrections for pH and conductivity, thus improving the accuracy of these
measurements. Isothermal baths are available from several vendors specializing in the custom
manufacture of sampling panels and related equipment.
Flow Rate and Pressure Regulation
Most continuous analyzers are sensitive to sample flow rate, and the appropriate manufacturers
specifications must be followed. Usually, on-line instruments are designed to include flow
regulating devices to serve as a check for those devices located upstream, but these on-line
devices must not be relied upon.
A minimum recommended flow rate for grab samples is 300 mL/min (4.8 gal/hr). However, the
actual flow rate should be governed by the rate required to maintain adequate and constant
sample line velocities. The design velocity can be maintained by routing excess flow either to
waste or the condenser hotwell, as appropriate.
Pressure regulating devices must be designed to maintain constant flow to the analyzers during
normal, startup, or changing load conditions. Of the many pressure-regulating devices that exist,
available types that have been used successfully are described:
needle valves
rod-in-capillary devices
Needle valves are sufficient for reducing sample pressures from up to about 500 psig (3.45
MPa). However, at pressures nearing the critical pressure, needle valves have been found to
cause the dissociation of water. This is an undesirable situation, causing a rise in the hydrogen
and oxygen content of the water. Also, at higher pressures, needle valves are subject to wiredrawing.
Rod-in-capillary devices are available in two designs: the fixed rod-in-capillary device and the
variable rod-in-tube capillary device. Fixed rod-in-capillary devices have a tendency to plug, and
are difficult to clean. A variable rod-in-tube device is effective over a larger pressure range than
a fixed rod-in-capillary device because it provides an adjustable pressure drop. In addition, the
variable rod device is more easily cleaned.
E-8
Most on-line analyzers require inlet pressure to be 5-20 psig (34-138 kPag) for proper operation.
The outputs from most instruments are also flow sensitive, so flow rate should be maintained as
constant as possible. These flow and pressure requirements can be met by using a back pressure
regulating device or a head cup. A head cup is a relatively simple device (see Figure E-1) and
has been used successfully to supply pH and conductivity cells. Immediately upstream of the
analyzer, a vertical leg is used to develop an 8 to 10 foot (2.4 to 3.0 meter) head. A trough for
collecting overflow is placed at the top of this vertical leg. An overflow is required at all sample
conditions to avoid atmospheric sample contamination. They are very reliable but they suffer a
major disadvantage: they provide only a very low inlet pressure so usually they cannot be used
with analyzers requiring a 5-20 psig (34-138 kPag) sample pressure. Consequently, a back
pressure regulator is normally preferred over a head cup when the analyzer requires constant
flow at pressure.
Use of an orifice installed in a sample flow line is not recommended for pressure and flow
control because the orifice size cannot be modified easily to allow flow rate adjustments, and the
orifice size changes as it wears, and therefore would have to be replaced frequently to maintain
the desired flow rate and pressure, even under baseload operating conditions.
Figure E-1
Head Cup for Constant Sample Flow (pressure in psi at discharge equals the head, H
inches of water, divided by 27.6)
E-9
Sample Filters
Filters are placed before the pressure and flow regulators to prevent fouling of analyzers in those
sample lines not being tested for turbidity or used as grab samples. Closer attention is needed for
filters used in cycling plants; because of the heavy accumulation of scale and corrosion products,
these filters require frequent maintenance. For some analyzers, filters are included in the internal
design. Some analyzers also require the use of micron filters immediately upstream.
Manufacturers specifications should be checked for special requirements concerning filters.
(3)
Because of the interactions of soluble impurities with suspended metal oxides , filtered samples
may not represent total concentrations. The metal oxides retained on the filter may either adsorb
or desorb trace levels of soluble impurities or change the sample composition or its properties,
i.e. temperature, pH, etc.
Sample Panels
In fossil plants, it is quite common to direct all sample lines from one or more units to a common
location, often within or adjacent to the laboratory.
Most sample panels include the following components:
pressure reducers
relief valves
constant temperature baths
valves to control flow rate
sample pressure, temperature, and flow rate indicators
analyzer cells and elements
sample sink for grab samples
A recorder-analyzer panel is typically provided as a separate unit. Sample panels are usually
centrally located for convenience. In addition, the surrounding environment is more easily
controlled when a central location is chosen for the panels.
E-10
The air in the sample room should be filtered. The room should have a positive pressure to
maintain low dust levels. In addition, relative humidity should be between 50% and 70% and
temperatures between 65-78F (18-26C). Adequate electrical shielding is required, and
refrigeration units should be located outside the sample room, whenever possible, to keep
vibrations to a minimum.
Local satellite panels should be considered for new plants and for existing plants requiring
supplemental instrumentation. Local sample panels provide advantages over a centrally located
panel such as shorter sample lines and troubleshooting capabilities. However, these panels must
have a central display. Some of the major problems concerning sample panels are the difficulties
encountered during servicing and adjustment. Piping, tubing, and fittings should be arranged so
instruments or devices may be removed, serviced, or calibrated without disturbing adjacent
piping or tubing.
The sampling system configuration used in the RP2712-3 monitoring project is shown in
(2)
Figure E-2 . This configuration proved to be quite effective, and generally caused few
maintenance problems during the projects four monitoring periods.
E-11
Figure E-2
Sampling System Configuration Used During RP2712-3 Project(2)
E-12
a means to measure other chemical parameters not measurable with on-line instrumentation
optimization of treatments
Grab samples can be taken at local sampling sites using portable conditioning units. More often,
however, grab samples are taken centrally.
Sample Containers
The selection of appropriate (noncontaminating) sample containers and closures, in addition to
the container cleaning procedures, depends upon the parameter being tested and the method of
analysis.
Before taking samples, the sample container should be properly labeled. This procedure helps to
maintain meaningful records. A typical sample label should have the space for and include the
following information:
sample number
source of sample
point of sampling
E-13
E-14
The fluid path should be simple and use a minimum amount of small-bore plastic tubing.
The analyzer should have simple purge and flush requirements for startup and shutdown
The analyzer should be able to compensate for variations in sample flow and temperature
A very desirable feature is that the instrument sample manifold provides a means by which
independently prepared standard samples may be introduced continuously, wherever desired, for
the normal sample flow. Periodic checks of samples represent the surest means of determining
the precision and bias of continuous instrumentation.
The monitoring and control system must furnish the laboratory with a representative sample,
provide dependable feedback of measurements, and automatically protect important system
constituents. The control system must also provide local grab sample lines in appropriate
locations to evaluate specific pieces of equipment and to sample corrosion products.
E-15
Selection of the appropriate equipment is essential in the control of water chemistry, which is a
mandatory requirement for longterm operation of all power plants.
E.3.2 Analyzer Calibration Techniques
Calibration of monitoring equipment is essential for accurate and precise analysis. The frequency
and method of calibration will vary among different types of analyzers; therefore, specific
vendor instructions should be followed as closely as possible. Calibration frequency may also
depend on the concentration of the particular parameter, the accuracy requirements of the
analysis, and the stability of the instrument used for the measurement. All types of analyzers will
lose accuracy when measuring zero or very low levels of concentrations over extended periods of
time, in which case the analyzer should be calibrated more frequently. A calibration frequency
should be established and rigorously followed for each individual instrument.
Another aspect of calibration accuracy is the reliability of the standards used for interlaboratory
and intralaboratory comparisons. Chemical quality and the care exercised in preparation of
standard solutions greatly affect chemical calibrations.
E.3.3 Analyzer Operation and Maintenance
Sufficient priority must be given to proper operation and maintenance to ensure reliable results.
The analyzer is only one part of the system and all parts must be functioning properly to
guarantee reliable operation.
Manufacturers usually supply specific operating and maintenance instructions for their
equipment. Failure to utilize this information will result in unsatisfactory performance and
equipment downtime. A preventive maintenance schedule should be established initially and
then strictly followed until sufficient performance data exist to warrant modification of the
schedule. Such programs vary with respect to the type of analyzer and the nature of its
environment.
E-16
data collection
computerized systems
sample temperatures
plant load
comments
Comments should include information such as the status of the plant at the time of data
collection, action levels reached, and corrective actions taken. Examples of successfully used
data sheets are provided in EPRIs Cycle Chemistry Improvement Program.(4)
Data from continuous analyzers may be collected manually by periodically logging values from
local indicators, or by interpreting strip charts if the plant does not have a data acquisition
system. Individual values logged from local indicators will generally be more accurate than
values read from strip charts; however, local indicators do not provide the thorough summary of
parameter fluctuations that the strip charts do.
E.4.2 Automatic Data Collection and Storage
Continuous analyzers can be configured to send information directly to data acquisition systems,
personal computers, or control room computers. Automatic data collection provides the same
information as a strip chart but with greater precision and eliminates both the time necessary to
evaluate strip charts and the element of human error.
E-17
E-18
Supervisory personnel are responsible for a more detailed review of chemistry and trends. They
must be able to explain recorded occurrences and make suggestions for corrective actions to be
taken and then report their findings to management.
It is the responsibility of the operating personnel to be aware of sudden changes in operating
parameters and to interpret and take corrective actions when conditions needing immediate
attention arise. The operators must be adequately trained so they are able to perform the
described duties.
E.4.6 Expert Systems for Water Chemistry Management
An EPRI project was initiated for the development and demonstration of an expert system to
gather and analyze plant chemistry data in such a way as to result in significant conclusions
relative to the need for corrective actions, as well as what those corrective actions should be. The
resulting software package, known as EPRI ChemExpert, offers a variety of capabilities and
features of considerable value to fossil plants(9). These include:
Cycle arrangement
Sample points and chemical feed points
On-line analyzers (location, current readings and status)
Management of chemistry data
E-19
Personnel training
The ChemExpert software package currently consists of four separate programs. A customization
program allows the user to define unit characteristics and cycle chemistry. Either two or three
action levels may be specified by the user. A diagnostic program provides verification of
analytical data, warning of chemistry readings outside of limits (including problem identification
and recommendation of actions that should be taken), determination of pressure and carryover
dependent limits for impurities in the boiler water of drum type units, and data storage, plotting
and report preparation. A cycle description and maintenance program may be used as a database
of unit equipment characteristics and for planning and scheduling of operation, maintenance and
calibration functions related to the chemistry program. The training program is designed for
beneficial use by plant operators and technical personnel responsible for cycle chemistry.
E-20
The needs for data validation are by no means unique to the fossil electric industry. QA/QC
programs are applied in innumerable applications, many of which have far more rigorous
requirements than those of fossil plants. Important and obvious examples include medical
technology, the aerospace and aeronautics industry, pharmaceuticals production, computer
components and communications technology, defense applications, food processing, security
systems, and nuclear power generation, to name but a few. As a result, the language of QA and
QC features an extensive vocabulary, which often, unfortunately, constrains its application to
areas where such action is elective, rather than mandatory. Fortunately, application of effective
validation techniques to fossil plants requires familiarity with a relatively small number of terms
and concepts, as summarized in the working definitions of Table E-2. Recognition of the
importance of cycle chemistry data validation and quality has resulted in considerable effort on
the parts of utility organizations, consultants, and instrument manufacturers to evaluate
requirements of fossil plants and to establish manageable programs capable of meeting these
(10-12)
needs . Ensuing discussions provide guidance on this important subject.
E-21
The agreement between the amount of a component measured by the test method and the amount
actually present. Accuracy includes both precision and bias of the method.
Precision:
The reproducibility of a method when repeated on a homogeneous sample under controlled conditions,
regardless of whether or not the observed values are widely displaced from the true value as a result of
systematic or constant errors (also sometimes referred to reproducibility).
Bias:
Note.
Both accuracy and precision can vary as a function of the concentration being measured. They
can also vary due to other factors such as temperature, concentrations of interferences, etc.
Therefore, statements of precision and accuracy should be expressed in terms of the
concentration over the range of concentrations to which they apply. If precision and accuracy are
stated in percent, the range over which the relative precision or accuracy applies should be
explicitly stated (e.g. a relative accuracy of 10% if the amount present is achieved over a span
of 0.01 to 10 mg/L).
St
So
The persistent positive or negative deviation of the method average value from the assumed
or accepted true value.
Note:
Both precision and bias vary as a function of the concentration being measured. They
can also vary because of factors such as temperature, concentrations of interferences,
etc. Therefore, statements of precision and bias should be related to the
concentrations to which they apply.
Sensitivity:
The minimum observable difference in very small amounts of a component in a sample. Also,
sometimes totally incorrectly referred to as detection limit or detectability.
Range:
Response Time:
The period of time required for an analyzer to properly measure the components in a sample
from the time the sample enters the analyzer. Also known as analyzer dead time.
Note:
Sampling Error:
The deviation between the true concentration, pH, conductivity, etc. in the stream prior to
sampling and the concentration in the sample presented to the analyzer; or contained, in the
sample container prior to preservation or transportation for analysis.
Analytical
Interference:
Analytical errors caused by interference from some chemical compounds in the mixture being
analyzed. Interferences should be listed for all water treatment chemicals used and for their
decomposition products.
E-22
Figure E-3
Normal Distribution Curve for Random Data
E-23
A measurement of precision is given by the standard deviation (Sx) of the data set. Standard
deviation can be used to express the distribution (or spread) of the data around the average value
of the data set (X ). In many cases, it is convenient to express the standard deviation relative to
the concentration as a relative standard deviation (RSD), sometimes expressed as the percent
relative standard deviation (%RSD):
RSD = [S X / X ]
(eq. E-1)
%RSD = [S X / X ] 100%
(eq. E-2)
and
In this way, precision can be compared at varying concentrations and %RSD can be used to
quantify changing precision as a function of concentration. Understanding %RSD can provide
insight into instrument detection limits and instrument linearity. The %RSD tends to be very
large for very low analyte concentrations. For example, for concentrations at the decision limit
(LC), %RSD 60%; at the detection criteria (LD), %RSD 30%; at the determination limit (LQ),
(14)
%RSD 10 (as specified by Currie ).
ASTM defines bias as the persistent positive or negative deviation of the average value of a test
method from the assumed or accepted true value.(15) If the data are randomly distributed,
accuracy expresses the deviation from the expected value as shown in Figure E-4. Bias is called
recovery when expressed as a percentage of the true value. Thus, accuracy may be expressed as a
combination of recovery and relative standard deviation at a given true value.
Figure E-4
The Relationship Between True Value, Measured Value, and Bias. The bias in the example
shown is negative, but a positive bias is also possible.
E-24
(eq. E-3)
Many measurement methods are more accurate at the high end of the range covered, leading to
percent deviation values that change over the dynamic range of the measuring instrument. For
convenience, average values may be cited for specific ranges of the parameter measured, e.g.,
20% for 1-100 ppb and 10% for 100 ppb - 1 ppm.
In some cases, a lower limit of accuracy may also be cited, e.g., 0.5 ppb or 10%, whichever is
larger. Clearly, using percent deviation limits in this is imperfect and does not address the overall
capability of the instrument.
A more scientific approach utilizes the Students t test.(16) This approach measures accuracy as
a function of the deviation from the expected value at a specified confidence coefficient, usually
95%. The test assesses the instruments accuracy based on observed instrument behavior and is
most appropriate for instruments that are used for diagnostic purposes. The Students t test
mathematically determines whether a statistically significant bias exists at a specified confidence
coefficient. In this way it can be said conclusively that a statistically significant bias does or does
not exist.
Several commercially available programs can be used to calculate statistics (such as percent
deviation or the Students t test), make data comparisons, and archive information. Selection of
a specific program will depend upon a number of factors, including a users data acquisition
capabilities and data management needs.
Special testing can be performed to verify accuracy and precision of instrumentation or grab
sample analyses over various working ranges based on the needs of the user. The precision and
accuracy of a measurement may be affected by many factors, such as temperature, concentration
of reagents, interferences, availability of traceable calibration standards at the concentration
expected in the samples, calibration procedure, and sample size, as well as variations that
develop from one instrument, operator, or laboratory to another. Consequently, accuracy and
precision statements should include the range of conditions over which they apply.
While the accuracy of an instrument can be determined immediately when it is placed into
service, drift develops over time. Drift may be defined as the change in bias in a specified period
caused by changes in the electronic zero of the instrumentation but, more particularly, by
deterioration of the sensor. The American National Standards Institute (ANSI) defines drift in
ANSI Standard C85.1-1963 as an undesired change in output over a period of time, which
(17)
change is unrelated to the input, environment, or load. Drift is an important example of
systematic errors (Figure E-5), which must be minimized to ensure data quality.
Instrument manufacturers do not always provide precision, accuracy, bias and drift information.
Such information must therefore be determined by the user.
E-25
Figure E-5
Random and Systematic Errors
E-26
Sample withdrawal error can be determined by using alternate sampling taps and nozzles or a
different sampling location. Experiments have shown that for superheated and wet steam
sampling, an isokinetic sampling nozzle is needed, correctly located in the steam pipe, such as
(3)
described in EPRI TR-100196, Development of a Steam Sampling System. The same type of
nozzle is needed for feedwater when sampling for suspended oxides. (Also see E.2.3 and E.2.7)
In sampling boiler water from the steam drum, the sample could be mixed with the incoming
feedwater or separated moisture and thus be different from the water in the boiler tubes.
E.5.3 QA/QC for On-Line Instruments
Instrument Calibration and Standardization
Establishment of effective calibration and standardization procedures are the starting point of the
QA/QC program. Since manufacturers procedures vary widely in their ability to ensure
traceable accuracy, it is advisable to independently calibrate the instrument components,
especially the sensing elements, after the manufacturers procedures have been followed.
Independent calibration is particularly advised for temperature sensing elements in conductivity,
pH, and other instruments where automatic temperature compensation is an integral part of the
instrument measurement process.
E-27
For high-purity water, conductivity instrument cell calibration by comparison with a standard
reference conductivity cell and measurement bridge (without temperature compensation and on
the same sample flow) is recommended initially and possibly at various later intervals,
depending on the fouling characteristics of the particular sample stream. For pH, calibration is
best accomplished with flowing standards using two concentrations, as discussed below, one
above and one below the desired measurement range, following completion of the
manufacturers initial procedures.
Validation of On-Line Monitoring Instruments
At least four approaches to validation of on-line monitoring instruments are available: the
reference sample procedure, the line sample procedure, instrument comparison, and the standard
(18)
injection method. The first two approaches are described in ASTM D3764 , a standard practice
that was developed for validation of process stream analyzers in petroleum or petrochemical
product steams, but which is equally applicable to power plant water streams. The last two
methods are perhaps better suited to calibration of instruments but they have been used on
occasion for validation purposes.
The reference sample procedure involves introduction of reference standard samples into the
analyzer and subsequent comparison of the measured values with the reference values. For
instance, to validate a pH monitoring device, the plant water stream could be diverted and
replaced with a standard buffer solution flowing for a period long enough to allow the pH
measurement. This approach is particularly useful for validating new and replacement analyzers
to ensure they have been installed and commissioned in accordance with the manufacturers
recommendations.
The line sample procedure makes use of a plant water stream of interest and involves taking at
least seven grab samples for laboratory analyses and comparing these results with those obtained
from the on-line analyzer at the times of sampling. The data are evaluated statistically (Students
t test) to validate the analyzer. Suitable statistical software packages are available from some
instrument suppliers to help perform this task. The line sample procedure is used more as an
operational check on an analyzer that has been previously validated, and is useful in establishing
the ongoing precision and bias of an analyzer in service.
The third approach involves comparing the results obtained from the on-line analyzer (A) with
those obtained from a second on-line analyzer (B) exposed simultaneously to the same water
stream. The latter may be a high quality, portable unit that is first validated and calibrated in the
laboratory, then attached to the plant water stream system when needed to validate or calibrate
analyzer A. Measurements on analyzer B are assumed to be correct and the accuracy of analyzer
A can be assessed by comparing measurements on the two instruments. This method is useful for
validating and verifying analyzers that measure very low analyte concentrations where the grab
sampling process may introduce significant error. However, in such cases, analyzer B must first
be calibrated using a water having analyte constituent concentrations near those needing
measurement in the plant water stream. Clearly, the value of this method is very dependent on
the precision and lack of drift in instrument B during the validation period.
E-28
The standard injection method can be considered a variation of the reference sample procedure in
that it involves the introduction of standard solutions into the analyzer. However, the standard
injection method does this by injecting the standard solution at a controlled rate into the plant
water stream, also flowing at a known rate, such that the concentration of the resulting diluted
standard solution can be calculated accurately. The method is otherwise similar to the reference
sample procedure. In high-purity water systems, it has the great advantage of presenting the
standard sample without contamination and permitting measurement with similar matrix and
flow.
A general protocol for establishing the validity of on-line water analysis instruments is provided
(19)
(20)
in ASTM D3864. More specific protocols, detailed in EPRI Report GS-7556 , were followed
in a collaborative validation program at four power plant sites. As with the grab sample methods,
on-line instruments must be validated by collecting a minimum of six data sets at each
concentration level. For the four-plant collaborative study, this minimum requirement was
satisfied for all of the methods except three: on-line ion chromatography, total organic carbon,
and dissolved oxygen. Nevertheless, these latter three methods should be considered for use,
although treated with appropriate caution.
The successful validation of on-line instrumentation requires: proper installation of water and
steam sample lines; close control of sample temperature, pressure, and flow rate; preparation of
standard samples; and accurate analysis of grab samples. These requirements are discussed in
more detail below.
Synthesizing Standard Samples
Validation of the measurement methods can be accomplished using standard solutions (samples),
over a range of well defined concentrations, produced in a continuous flow. Grab samples can be
taken from this flow or the flowing standard solution can be directed to the on-line monitoring
equipment under test. A method of synthesizing flowing standard solutions was described in
(2)
EPRI Report GS-7556 Volume 1. It involves the continuous production of very high quality
reagent water, flowing at a constant, continuously measured rate, into which one or more
concentrated standard solutions are injected continuously with metering pumps.
The very high quality reagent water is prepared from steam condensate which is passed through
a de-oxygenation exchange bed, a carbon bed, a mixed bed and a 0.2-micron filter. If source
water of lower quality than steam condensate (e.g. makeup storage tank water) is used, additional
purification steps may be needed. To avoid precipitation of the chemicals in the concentrated
standards, Cl, SO4, and organic acids are prepared in an acid solution, and Na, HCO3, N2H4, NH3,
and SiO2 are prepared in an alkaline solution; oxygen is injected as air-saturated (STP) pure
water. Standard concentrations are calculated from the continuously logged standard solution
flow, the metering pump flow, and the assayed concentration of the concentrated standard
solutions. The metering pump flow is calculated from calibration curves, established from the
rate of change of weight of the vessels containing the concentrated standards, as measured by an
electronic analytical balance.
Sample synthesizers that are capable of delivering sample streams of known chemical
composition to several analyzers are also commercially available.
E-29
E-30
Figure E-6
Laboratory Quality Control Charts
E-31
Figure E-7
Cation Conductivity Control Chart, RR%, CC = 0.5 S/cm
Figure E-8
Cation Conductivity Control Chart, RSD%, CC = 0.5 S/cm
E-32
Proposed Method of Test for Low-Level Sodium in High Purity Water by Graphite Furnace
Atomic Absorption Spectrophotometry (ASTM Draft 3)
Proposed Method of Test for Low-Level Calcium in High Purity Water by Graphite Furnace
Atomic Absorption Spectrophotometry (ASTM Draft 1)
Proposed Method of Test for low-Level Magnesium in High Purity Water by Graphite
Furnace Atomic Absorption Spectrophotometry (ASTM Draft 1)
Standard Test Methods for Trace Anions in High Purity Water by Ion Chromatography
(ASTM D5542(22), Method A: Chloride, Phosphate, and Sulfate)
Standard Test Methods for Trace Anions in High Purity Water by Ion Chromatography
(ASTM D5542(22), Method B: Fluoride, Acetate, and Formate)
ASTM practice calls for a minimum of six data sets at each concentration level in order to derive
valid estimates of performance. Because insufficient data were generated in the study for the
following grab sample methods, they could not be properly validated but, with appropriate
caution, they should be considered for future use:
Proposed Method of Test for Trace Cations in High Purity Water by Ion Chromatography
(ASTM Draft 1)
Standard Test Method for Low-Level Total Silica in High Purity Water by Flameless
Atomic Absorption Spectroscopy (ASTM D4517-85(23))
Standard Test Method for Low-Level Total, Organic, and Inorganic Carbon in High
Purity Water by Ultraviolet (UV) or Persulfate Oxidation, or Both, and Infrared Detection
(ASTM D4779(24))
(25)
The results of this validation study were reported in 1988 and presented in detail in Appendix
E of EPRI Report GS-7556 Volume 1. In this program, grab samples were collected in special
sample bottles from flowing synthetic standards (prepared as described above), then refrigerated
until they were analyzed.
E-33
Performance Determination
Seven replicate presentations at the same desired test level are necessary to develop a satisfactory
estimate of intrainstrument (single instrument) standard deviation (So) for comparison with
established precision standards for a particular instrument at that level.
E-34
The presentation of each of the seven flowing standard replicates must be preceded by a
reasonably short period of stable instrument reading on the regular sample source (or other
source) where the concentration is different from that of the flowing standard. This interlude
should be of such length that >90% of the expected reading is attained.
Seven replicates are required at a particular concentration in order to develop meaningful
acceptance limits by which to determine if the instrument measurements are in controlthat
they perform with the expected precision and accuracy. The large number of replicates required
for statistically useful limits led to the above recommendation that only one test level be selected
for the initial QC program for each instrument. When using only one test concentration for the
QC test for each instrument, it is important that the same test level be employed for the QC test
each month, or other chosen interval, since the acceptance limits vary considerably with test
concentration for some instruments while remaining nearly constant for others.
Acceptance Limits
The standard deviation and mean of the seven replicate instrument measurements can be
compared to the expected precision and mean previously determined for the particular instrument
being evaluated. Since the flowing standard method may not produce exactly the same numerical
results when performed at different times, (whether at the same plant or at different plants), a
useful procedure is to express both the standard deviation and the mean in terms relative to the
true value of the standard used. Thus, the relative recovery (RR) is the measured mean
concentration of the seven replicates divided by the true concentration (T) expressed in percent,
X/T x 100. Similarly, the intrainstrument relative standard deviation (RSDo) is the standard
deviation of the seven replicates divided by the mean concentration expressed in percent, So/X x
100. Both the RR and RSDo determined from the QC test can then be compared with values
shown in Table E-4 for the nearest true concentration, since both RR and RSDo can be
considered constant for a reasonable range on either side of the selected value. The calculated
value of RR actually obtained for a validation should not be greater than the upper value nor less
than the lower shown in Table E-4 for RR at the selected true value. Similarly, the calculated
RSDo should not exceed the upper nor be less than the lower value shown for RSDo in Table E-4.
Use of Acceptance Limits in QC
A QC test of a particular cation conductivity (cc) instrument, for example, would start with
presenting the instrument with a flowing standard sample, with a desired target cc of say 0.5
S/cm. The standard would be presented seven times in alternate succession with a nonstandard
sample with a different cc, say 0.25 or 1.0 S/cm. Sufficient time would be allowed for the
reading to stabilize. The true conductance of the flowing standard was found to be say 0.55
S/cm based on the analysis of the concentrate, and the dilution ratio used to produce the flowing
standard. If the mean of the seven replicate cc results, X, was 0.34 S/cm, the RR would be X/T
x 100, or 62%. Reference to Table E-4 shows cc = 0.5 S/cm is the closest to the 0.55 S/cm
standard. The corresponding RR shows an upper acceptance limit of 130% and a lower limit of
59%. Therefore, it was concluded the instrument bias was within control.
E-35
Table E-4
Continuous Instrument Acceptance Limits, 95% Confidence Interval (Based on Seven
Replicates)
True
Concentration
Specific cond.
(S/cm)
Cation cond.
(S/cm)
Na
(g/L)
NH3
(g/L)
Lower
Upper
Lower
Upper
79
119
3.7
7.4
89
109
3.6
7.4
93
105
3.6
7.4
10
94
104
3.6
7.4
0.1
79
115
6.5
14.3
0.2
70
121
4.4
9.7
0.5
59
130
3.1
6.8
1.0
53
135
2.6
5.8
372
5.8
11.2
243
4.7
9.0
57
153
3.7
7.1
10
74
124
3.3
6.4
100
61
145
7.5
18.7
200
86
110
7.6
18.8
500
92
97
7.6
18.9
1000
93
94
7.6
18.9
Likewise, assume the seven replicate ccs yield a So of 0.22, and an RSDo of 6.5% ((0.22/0.34) x
100). Examination of Table E-4 for cc = 0.5 S/cm shows that the RSDo should not be less than
3.1% nor greater than 6.8% for the instrument to qualify as producing acceptable results. Since
both the RR and the RSDo are within the acceptance limits, the instrument is operating in control.
Where continuous water quality instruments of a given type can be supplied simultaneously with
an alternative high-quality water supply, useful information can be gained on multipleinstrument precision. Multiple-instrument precision has been shown to be generally smaller than
true interinstrument precision but greater than instrainstrument precision. Thus, the RSDs
obtained from alternative water supply tests normally can be expected to exceed slightly the
range of acceptance limits in Table E-4, which are based on intrainstrument precision. No
information can be obtained from alternative water supply tests, however, on relative recovery
unless the composition of the alternative water supply can be established independently and with
sufficient accuracy.
E-36
E.6 SUMMARY
A quality assurance (QA) program for cycle chemistry data is essential if comparisons are to be
made between measurements at different points within the cycle, between the same point in the
cycle in different plants, and between specific points in the cycle and the plants operating
chemistry limits and action levels. The QA program must include quality control (QC)
procedures for both grab sample and continuous instrument measurements. To follow the
instrument manufacturers calibration procedures is generally not sufficient, as these procedures
seldom employ traceable standards. More importantly, they do not determine reproducibility
(intra-instrument standard deviation) or recovery so that instrument performance may be
documented and trends in performance readily observed. Periodic validation of measurement
procedures, especially continuous instrument performance may be documented and trends in
performance readily observed. Periodic validation of measurement procedures, especially
continuous instrument procedures, by making replicate measurements on a continuously flowing
standard generates a record than can be compared readily with suggested acceptance limits as
derived from the EPRI RP2712-3 program. Charting the record of validation results allows early
detection and correction of problems with instrument accuracy. Close control of cycle chemistry
requires accurate chemistry measurements.
Analytical quality control must be incorporated into laboratory procedures if reliable results are
to be obtained. A quality control program provides for the detection/correction of problems and
statistical verification of performance. The objective of such a program is to reduce measurement
errors to a minimum so data can be used reliably to monitor and control cycle chemistry.
Unacceptable analytical variability arises from many sources. These include:
calibration errors
improper sampling procedures, contamination of the sample during collection and storage,
reaction of the sample with the sample container
Quality control programs must provide guidelines for calibration and standardization of all
laboratory equipment and reagents; and, they must establish procedures for estimating precision,
bias, and sensitivity for the analytical methods performed. Limitations in the availability of
equipment, number of samples, or time and experience of personnel can affect the reliability of
the data obtained. Therefore, quality assurance procedures must be developed specifically in
consideration of each plants needs and abilities.
E-37
Systematic and random errors must be controlled to the maximum practical extent before
evaluating precision and accuracy. Random error is present in any set of analyses in which
repeated measurements are taken on the same sample. Random errors are the scatter of
measurements about the true value. Systematic errors are referred to as bias and result from a
tendency for the data to be greater or smaller than the true value.
Reduction in systematic errors can be accomplished through proper analytical procedures,
traceable calculations, optimum personnel performance, and proper purity of reagents used in all
analyses. Reagent water is a major source of systematic error; therefore, care should be used in
its preparation to avoid contamination.
Various methods of evaluation of performance are available. A convenient way of monitoring
the precision and accuracy of a method is to construct control charts. Control charts are used to
evaluate the quality of the measurement process. Individual, multiple sample, and X-R control
charts can be generated. Individual and multiple control charts operate similarly; however,
multiple control charts span a range of concentrations, which avoids potential bias. The X-R
control chart incorporates changes in the mean, X, and changes in the standard deviation, S,
thereby making it the most useful of the three charts available.
Confidence in measurements in strengthened by inter-laboratory as well as intra-laboratory
comparisons. Inter-laboratory programs should be used to establish agreed-upon requirements
and laboratory procedures necessary to achieve desired quality standards. An independent
facility should then inspect laboratory equipment and evaluate performance. Intra-laboratory
programs identify the variability of measurement obtained when a single laboratory measures a
sample repeatedly. System audits also provide valuable quality assurance information. A system
audit is an investigation of the interaction of all laboratory procedures. The audit should be
performed at appropriate intervals to guarantee that each aspect of the QC program is operating
efficiently. A performance audit of an individual instrument is based on the outcome of the
analyses of a blind standard sample, either on an inter-laboratory or intra-laboratory level.
A quality control program must be implemented for all analyses and must be evaluated on a
regular basis to be effective. A formal quality assurance program, with written instructions and
formal documentation of its implementation, is required. Plant chemistry manuals should also
reflect quality control provisions. Analytical procedures and analytical evaluation methods must
be established to detect quality control problems early and correct them as soon as possible.
When properly executed, a quality assurance program will provide measurements of the desired
precision and bias, together with the associated documentation.
A final point that must be made on cycle chemistry data quality is that in far too many fossil
(28)
plants this important issue has been given a very low priority . Changes in the industry to
reduce staff size and, in many cases, experience levels have often resulted in situations where
routine chemistry monitoring and control is performed by inexperienced personnel with no
relevant education or training in chemistry. For organizations operating under the new paradigm,
procedures and other measures designed to ensure chemistry data quality should be regarded as a
high priority issue; implementation of suitable quality control and assurance provisions are
essential to day to day operation of fossil units in which high levels of availability and reliability
are required.
E-38
E.7 REFERENCES
1.
Guideline Manual on Instrumentation and Control for Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry.
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: April 1987. CS-5164.
2.
3.
Development of a Steam Sampling System. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA, December 1991. TR100196.
4.
Cycle Chemistry Corrosion and Deposition: Correction, Prevention and Control. EPRI,
Palo Alto, CA: December 1993. TR-103038.
5.
Reference Manual for On-Line Monitoring of Water Chemistry and Corrosion: 1998
Update, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 1999. TR-112024.
6.
Guidelines for Copper in Fossil Plants, EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2000. 1000457.
7.
Guideline Manual on Instrumentation and Control for Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 1987. CS-5164.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
E-39
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
ASTM D3864-96, Standard Guide for Continual On-Line Monitoring Systems for
Water Analysis, Annual Book of ASTM Standards: Water and Environmental
Technology, Volume 11.01 (Water I), ASTM International, Philadelphia, PA: January
1996.
20.
Monitoring Cycle Water Chemistry in Fossil Plants, Vol. 1 Monitoring Results, by A.F.
Aschoff, D.M. Sopocy, D.T. Eglar, O. Jonas, J.K. Rice, C.C. Stauffer, and W.E. Allmon.
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: October 1991, GS-7556, Volume 1.
21.
ASTM D2777-85 , Standard Practice for Determination of the Precision and Bias of
Applicable Methods of Committee D-19 on Water, Annual Book of ASTM Standards:
Water and Environmental Technology, Volume 11.01 (Water I), ASTM International,
Philadelphia, PA. (Updated November 1998)
22.
ASTM D5542-94, Standard Test Methods for Trace Anions in High Purity Water by Ion
Chromatography, Annual Book of ASTM Standards: Water and Environmental
Technology, Volume 11.01 (Water I), ASTM International, Philadelphia, PA: November
1994.
23.
ASTM D4517-85 (1994)e1, Standard Test Method for Low-Level Total Silica in High
Purity Water by Flameless Atomic Absorption Spectroscopy, Annual Book of ASTM
Standards: Water and Environmental Technology, Volume 11.02 (Water II), ASTM
International ,Philadelphia, PA: January 1985.
24.
ASTM D4779-93, Standard Test Method for Total, Organic, and Inorganic Carbon in
High Purity Water by Ultraviolet (UV) or Persulfate Oxidation, or Both, and Infrared
Detection, Annual Book of ASTM Standards: Water and Environmental Technology,
Volume 11.02 (Water II), ASTM International, Philadelphia, PA: November 1993.
E-40
25.
J.K. Rice, G.T. Upperman, A.F. Aschoff, R.B. Dooley, Interlaboratory Performance of
Methods of Analysis for Trace Substances in High Purity Water, Ultra Pure Water, Vol.
5, No. 5, p. 36 (July/Aug. 1988).
26.
ASTM D3370-95, Standard Practices for Sampling Water from Closed Conduits,
Annual Book of ASTM Standards: Water and Environmental Technology, Volume 11.01
(Water I), ASTM International, Philadelphia PA: November 1995.
27.
28.
E-41
F
UNIT SHUTDOWN, LAYUP, STARTUP, CYCLING AND
PEAKING
Initial efforts by EPRI to establish cycle chemistry guidelines for fossil units emphasized normal
unit operations, including baseload operation, load cycling, and peaking service. Implementation
of these guidelines in fossil plants around the world led to significant improvements for many
organizations. At the same time, however, it also became apparent that the chemistry must be
properly monitored and controlled during shutdown and layup, and that doing so was the only
way in which organizations applying the guidelines could attain all of the cycle chemistry
program goals (Section 1). EPRI benchmarking activities further reflect the relationship between
effective shutdown, layup and startup procedures and the ranking of individual cycle chemistry
programs.
In the absence of proper shutdown and layup procedures, the cycle is vulnerable to
contamination and corrosion activity.
For example, during off-load conditions, deposited impurities may have been released into the
circuit or have entered from outside, e.g. condenser leaks, carbon dioxide (CO2) with air inleakage. Therefore, it is important to consider the effects on the feedwater and steam cation
conductivity, silica, sodium, chloride and sulfate concentrations during startup. If there is a leak
in the reheaters, CO2 and, more importantly, flyash and sulfur dioxide, (SO2), may be drawn in,
resulting in acidic condensed steam in the reheaters. There is some evidence that silica is washed
off turbines during shutdown and startup. Oxygen concentrations in the feedwater require special
consideration. Restriction will need to be applied to this parameter, but some relaxation from the
normal EPRI guideline values should be possible until steady state operating conditions are
achieved.
During unit startup, the effect of chemistry control impacts on the potential for fluid-side
deposits, corrosion and impeding of heat transfer (furnace tube metal overheating). Focus should
be directed towards the identification and correction of the root cause of the chemical control
problem.
F-1
F.1 SHUTDOWN
The shutdown periods should be viewed as a continuum of the good practices used during
normal operation. For mixed-metallurgy systems, it is necessary to maintain reducing conditions
in the condensate and feedwater. Having a negative ORP near the optimum value of -300 to
-350 mV best ensures this and will maintain the protective cuprous oxide (Cu2O) layer on the
surface of copper-based feedwater heater tubes.
The shutdown period is a prelude to the layup of the unit. Layup procedures are determined by
the duration of the layup, whether short or longer term. The use of nitrogen blanketing the shell
side of feedwater heaters to protect feedwater heaters is presently practiced by only 13% of the
(1)
recently surveyed utilities . Nitrogen blanketing serves an essential purpose in preventing
oxygen ingress during short or longer-term layups.
Nitrogen blanketing is an especially significant topic, since it plays an important role in the
control of copper in fossil fired power plants. In order to produce an effective nitrogen blanket
for oxygen exclusion from electricity generating units, comprising boilers, turbines, heaters, and
all interconnecting systems, both the appropriate nitrogen supply/delivery system and the
appropriate application procedures are required. The final key to success is to follow the
established procedures implicitly at the time the application is needed.
Nitrogen supply systems need to be large enough to sufficiently supply nitrogen to steam
systems while pressure is collapsing during cooling in order to prevent any sub-atmospheric
condition from occurring; and, to preclude any air ingress into the systems being blanketed.
If cryogenic storage systems are used, they should be of about twice to three times the gaseous
volume of all the equipment that is being protected per application. The vaporizing equipment
must be sized to keep pace with the evacuating demand produced by the cooling and draining of
the various pieces of equipment.
Membrane systems are also commercially available to generate nitrogen on-site. These units are
typically skid-mounted and can easily be moved from place to place on the site. These units are
available in a wide variety of sizes to accommodate most requirements of nitrogen blanketing.
The units use compressed air as an inlet stream. Nitrogen purity ranges to 99.9%, and is a
function of the air pressure to the unit. As the purity requirements increase, the capacity to
generate nitrogen decreases. The nitrogen which is produced is very dry, with a dew point of
90 F. The units are simple to operate with no moving parts. Membrane systems may be feasible
at a cost savings over cryogenic systems. However, due consideration must be given to final
purity of the product gas, volume of gas production and the operating power requirements and
associated auxiliary power costs.
There is little information in the literature relative to the required purity of nitrogen gas to be
used for blanketing. Oxygen is the largest impurity in commercial or on-site generated nitrogen.
This oxygen has a great propensity for dissolving in water, particularly deoxygenated water,
which will enhance corrosion to metal surfaces.
F-2
Based upon considerable experience with nitrogen blanketing systems, the suggested minimum
purity for nitrogen used for blanketing purposes is 99.5%. This agrees well with the practice of
feedwater heater manufacturers which use 99.6% purity nitrogen when shipping their heaters.
Nitrogen supply piping must be connected separately to all circuits and components that are
normally isolated by shut-off, stop or stop/check valves during normal shutdown. Exception to
this can be made if non-routine valve positioning is explicitly stated in the blanketing procedures
and is accomplished during the application process. This is to ensure that all parts of all circuits
can be blanketed with nitrogen.
All nitrogen piping connections must be per code requirements of the component or circuit
involved. Connections can be made permanently, with welded connections and appropriate
isolation and check valves; or, using the quick connect type that can be disconnected to prevent
blanketing by accident if the unit is going to be inspected instead of blanketed.
The valves on the permanent type connections can be of the manual type or (preferably) can be
motor-operated in order to automate the blanketing process. These valves can be wired into the
control system so as to admit nitrogen as soon as the specified pressure set point for that
component or circuit is reached. If the system is manual, care must be taken to monitor the
pressures and to valve-in the nitrogen supply to that component at the appropriate time in order
to prevent sub-atmospheric pressure from occurring, which would nullify the effectiveness of the
nitrogen blanket.
Shutdown procedures that previously had been established for the unit will need to be reviewed
and revised as necessary to facilitate application of the nitrogen blanket. The objective is always
to replace the collapsing steam with nitrogen to prevent air ingress into the system, including the
condenser.
As the turbine comes off line, the condenser and reheater need to be flooded with nitrogen to
achieve positive pressure as fast as possible before shutting down the air removal system. Care
must be taken not to violate any turbine cooling requirements and to not over-pressure the
condenser, which may cause the rupture discs to blow.
The extraction system, which is frequently neglected, needs as much attention as any other
system. The heater shells and drains need appropriate blanketing. The deaerating heater and its
associated storage tank can be pegged with nitrogen as the steam pressure collapses. The
superheater vents and drains should be open and nitrogen admitted at such pressure as necessary
to effect a purge prior to isolation.
The boiler should be drained under nitrogen pressure if draining is desired; or, capped under a
continuous nitrogen pressure if it is to remain full. The boiler can be flash drained (drained
while above boiling temperature) to produce a dry condition, all the while under nitrogen
pressure, if such a condition is desired.
F-3
If the condensate, feedwater and associated heaters are to be drained, this should be
accomplished under positive nitrogen pressure. A slight positive pressure should be maintained
on the isolated system once the drain is accomplished. If these systems are to remain full of
condensate, a positive nitrogen pressure must exist at all times to prevent any air ingress and to
replace any water that may have leaked from seals, flanges, etc.
If the unit being blanketed contains any non-drainable components or circuits, these must be
identified and an appropriate nitrogen supply made available to them in order to have an
effective nitrogen blanket.
Once all systems are drained and blanketed, all vents and drains should be closed. Then, a
slightly positive nitrogen pressure of 2-5 psig (13.834.5 kPa) should be maintained on all
components.
In the case of the main condenser, once the steam seals are off and the air removal systems are
stopped, a positive flow of nitrogen should continue to the condenser. If a slight pressure can be
maintained without excessive nitrogen consumption, this procedure is feasible. Again, care must
be taken not to blow the rupture disks. A continuous small flow through the condenser and out
the turbine seals is totally sufficient to keep air out of that area in almost any situation.
Cost effective and physically effective nitrogen blanketing of steam electric generating systems
can be accomplished. There are certain prerequisites that cannot be circumvented if effective
blanketing is to be the desired result. The nitrogen supply system has to be capable of delivering
the appropriate volume and purity in the required time frame. The nitrogen application points
must be located in all necessary components and circuits. The nitrogen blanket application
procedures, as well as unit shutdown procedures must address all of the necessary conditions and
situations. Finally, the performance of the process must be exacting in order to be successful to
accomplish the ultimate objective, which is to exclude oxygen from the equipment during
downtime and lay-up.
F.2 LAYUP
The following guidelines will give desirable results for iron and copper control during short and
longer-term layups. Additional information can be found in EPRIs Startup, Shutdown and
Layup Guidelines.(3)
F-4
F-5
F.3 STARTUP
Again it is necessary to prevent oxygen ingress, if iron and copper are to be controlled to
acceptable levels. The use of deaerated makeup will appreciably reduce oxygen levels during
startup (see Appendix A). Air in-leakage must be controlled, as additional parts of the heat cycle
are under vacuum during low load operation (see Appendix C). The use of auxiliary steam to peg
the deaerator (if available) will enhance oxygen removal at this point in the cycle.
Detection and repair of condenser leaks during startup is critical to prevent ingress of harmful
contaminants such as chlorides and sulfates.
F-6
The use of a cleanup loop, in conjunction with condensate polishers and/or filters (if available)
was considered in the 1980s to be helpful in reducing contaminants during startup, however they
are quite expensive to back-fit; and, therefore are not in widespread usage today. There have
been some back-fit installations made for those units which have been converted from base
loaded to cyclic operation, and, therefore are expected to have frequent startups. Even without
cleanup loops, condensate polishers and/or condensate filters can markedly decrease startup
times.
F.3.1 Corrosion Product Filters
A recent development, condensate filters for copper(2) shows promise for markedly reducing
copper in feedwater. Results from the application of such a unit are shown in Figure F-1. Field
testing of this copper-reducing filter, as reported, indicates that copper can be reduced in
feedwater by more than 95%, from 600 ppb to less than 20 ppb. Iron concentrations are also said
to be reduced.
1200
1000
800
Inlet copper
concentration
600
400
Outlet copper
concentration
200
0
0
200
400
600
800
1000
1200
1400
1600
F-7
The copper filter is a design derived from filters already being applied in condensate filtration for
particulate iron removal. The filter is a cartridge type utilizing a proprietary melt blown filter
media that has a unique affinity for copper. It has no leachables, different from other plastic filter
media of similar construction. Maximum operating temperature is 180F (82C), and maximum
(4)
differential pressure is 50 psi. Other design features are shown in Table F-1 .
After the initial tests at Chesterfield Station, the copper filter was fitted with an improved
cartridge design, and retested at Chesterfield with improved results(5). Additional tests were
performed at Pacificorps Naughton Plant using the improved cartridge design. As a result of the
satisfactory test results, a full set of copper reducing elements were ordered for installation at
(7)
Naughton .
A primary limitation of condensate filters is that they cannot remove iron and copper which enter
the feedwater. (Condensate polishers exhibit comparable filtration capabilities and limitations.)
Development of filter elements capable of working in the feedwater environment would increase
the usefulness of their devices. However, it should also be kept in mind that the need for
corrosion product removal is minimized when the chemistry is controlled to minimize corrosion
of materials in the cycle.
F.3.2 Units With Drum Boilers
In general and to the extent practiced, it may be desirable to discard heater drains during initial
startup operations (first 2-4 hours after turbine synchronization) to reduce the amount of iron and
copper entering the boiler.
Initial startup depends on the layup procedures followed prior to startup. If the layup was shortterm, and the unit filled with water treated for typical normal operations, startup can proceed
without delay. If the feedwater system was full of water treated for longer-term layup (pH 9.0 to
9.6, hydrazine 40-50ppm) some water may have to be dumped to reduce hydrazine and ammonia
to more appropriate values.
If the unit was laid up dry, the feedwater system for mixed-metallurgy systems must be filled
with deaerated water from the makeup system treated with ammonia to pH 9.0-9.3, and
hydrazine to achieve an ORP in the range -300 to -350mV, prior to startup. For all-ferrous
systems, pH would be 9.2 to 9.6.
During startup, the boiler feedwater should be closely monitored. The following limits for the
boiler feedwater have been used prior to firing the boiler:
F-8
By following the guidelines and procedures in Sections 4 and 5 of this document, it is expected
that these limits can (and should) be reduced.
Attainment of these prefiring limits will be more difficult in units not equipped with condensate
polishers and / or filtration equipment. Best control will require close compliance with the
guidelines for unit shutdown and layup. However, for mixed-metallurgy systems the Program
(6)
Copper research has indicated that transition of protective cuprous oxide will occur to nonprotective cupric oxide in a matter of hours in oxygenated water. Thus it is important to quickly
reach ORP levels between 350 and 300 mV for these systems.
F-9
Filter Length
(in/mm)
Max. Flow
(gpm/lpm)
6 / 152.4
40 / 1016
83 / 321
6 / 152.4
60 / 1524
130 / 492
Housings
Number of Filters
Aqueous Rated
Flow (gpm/lpm)
130
260
390
520
910
12
1560
19
2470
After firing the boiler, monitoring of the condensate and feedwater must be continued, both for
chemistry parameters and to ensure that temperature ramps are maintained according to
equipment manufacturers specifications.
Boiler water chemistry concentration levels vs. pressure curves (see Sections 4 and 5) can be
utilized to control sodium, silica, chlorides and sulfates to provide protection to the steam
turbine. Boiler pressure should remain at reduced levels such that these contaminant values, as
shown on the curves, are not exceeded before pressure can be increased to the next level.
Maximum use of blowdown and condensate polishing (if available) will minimize startup times.
Several organizations with mixed-metallurgy systems have established boiler water holds for
copper during startups, similar to the philosophy established very much earlier for holds on
(7)
silica boiler water levels during startups. One such startup curve is shown in Figure F-2 . The
first version was established in 1987, but was modified in 1993 in an effort to shorten unit startup
times. The revised curve for 1993 reduced startup times from 48-60 hours (1987) to about 12
hours.
F-10
Figure F-2
Boiler Water Copper Concentration/Drum Boiler Pressure Control Curves Developed at
Miami Fort Station(7)
Figure F-3 shows a boiler water copper control curve derived for a 2 ppb copper limit in steam,
(6)
which was developed for the EPRI Copper Guidelines. Since it is difficult to quantify
analytically the individual species (cupric or cuprous) in the boiler water, it was suggested that
total copper be used for control purposes. The curve shown in Figure F-3 is based on the
volatility of cuprous oxide, and could be used to provide an approximation of the total copper
level in the boiler water which should minimize the copper in steam.
The startup curves in Figure F-2 are similar to the total copper curve of Figure F-3 in the higher
operating pressure ranges, as shown in Table F-2.
Of course it should be recognized that use of a curve implies that the good control philosophies
for boiler water, which ensure reducing conditions are maintained during a shutdown, have not
been adopted. A key example may include a maintenance outage to work or internally inspect the
boiler. On the other hand, if reducing conditions are rigorously maintained then such a figure
should not be needed. In this regard, it can not be emphasized more strongly that, according to
the Program Copper research (Sections 1.2.4 and 3.3.1), the copper oxides will partition into
(6)
steam from boiler water at high levels even during the early startup. Applying these guidelines
to control the chemistry under all conditions is the best approach to avoidance of copper
transport problems.
F-11
6.2
7.6
9.0
10.3
11.7
13.1
14.5
15.8
17.2
18.6 19.6
2000
1000
800
600
500
400
Total Copper (ppb) in Boiler Water
300
200
100
80
60
50
40
30
20
Normal
10
8
6
5
4
3
600 700
900
1100 1300 1500 1700 1900 2100 2300 2500 2700 2850
F-12
1993 DATA(1)
1987 DATA
1950 (13.4)
275
110
85
2000 (13.8)
160
100
75
2100 (14.5)
140
75
65
2200 (15.1)
100
70
50
2300 (15.8)
75
50
45
2400 (16.5)
60
45
35
2500 (17.2)
40
40
30
2600 (37.7)
25
25
25
During startup, any chemical excursions must be dealt with quickly and effectively to return the
unit expeditiously to normal operating values. Target values at the deaerator inlet and the
economizer inlet are given in Figures 4-1 and 4-2.
Short-term layup presumes that the unit will be required to operate within a relatively short
timeframe. In consideration of this, no major changes are required from normal operating
conditions, with the exception being that the unit must be protected from air ingress. The
condenser vacuum and turbine seals are maintained; the deaerator, heater shells and boiler are
inerted with nitrogen or steam; and, the feedwater chemistry is maintained according to the
requirements of the treatment philosophy employed.
F-13
Step 1
No
Intermediate and
long term
Yes
Yes
Step 6
Step 5
Low O2 scavenger
Traditional
Yes
Break reheater
vacuum with
Nitrogen purge
No
Dry layup
Yes
Step 3
Establish boiler
Nitrogen cap of 5 psi
(0.03 MPa)
No
Step 4
No
Yes
Drain condenser
under Nitrogen
Maintain chemical
limits per guidelines
Drain system to
remove all water
Yes
Drain system to
remove all water
Wet layup
Yes
Evacuate reheater
with condenser
vacuum
Maintain condenser
vacuum and turbine
seals
Dry air
No
Maintain small
Nitrogen flow through
condenser, turbine
and deaerator
Notes: *No Hydrazine for AVT(O) or OT units
**Limit pH to 9.0 to 9.3 if units
have copper alloys in cycle;
maintain Hydrazine at
40-50 ppm
Isolate reheater
Step 7
Step 9
For maintenance:
purge with air all N2
from equipment to be
maintained.
Test to ensure safe
environment.
Figure F-4
Road Map to Develop Shutdown and Layup Guidelines Common to Most Units
Notes: * No hydrazine for AVT(O) or OT units.
** Limit pH to 9.0 to 9.3 if units have copper alloys in cycle; maintain hydrazine at 4050 ppm
F-14
Step 2 - Intermediate and Longterm Layup Common to Dry and Wet Layup
Intermediate and longterm layup require additional steps to be taken to prevent corrosion during
intermediate periods of layup, such as for maintenance and indeterminate cycling or peaking
requirements; and during longterm layup for indefinite periods of time. Certain procedures are
common regardless of whether the units are to be laid up dry or wet. There is a danger of offload corrosion (pitting) if there are salts present. Consideration needs to be given to whether the
reheater supports can take the weight if the reheater is to be filled with water.
During shutdown, the turbine, condenser (steam side) and reheater are generally considered
together because, unless special facilities are incorporated, there is no practical way to isolate
them. With special facilities incorporated, the reheater can be isolated from the turbine and may
be stored wet (see Step 8). The turbine, however, can only be laid up dry. The condenser may be
flooded and laid up wet, but several factors limit the feasibility of this procedure:
The condenser must be supported from the bottom to handle the extra weight of a flooded
condenser.
The expansion joints between the turbine and condenser are not designed to support the
weight of a flooded condenser.
Water in the condenser may cause moisture vapor to enter the turbine causing corrosion.
For these reasons, the steam side of the condenser is normally laid up dry.
For Step 2, during shutdown, the reheater is evacuated by utilizing the vacuum in the condenser.
The vacuum is then broken using nitrogen pressure. The condenser is drained under nitrogen.
If the turbine steam is supplied from a header system, all valves must be tight to prevent moisture
entrance into the turbine.
Step 3 - Dry Air Layup
The dry air layup procedure requires that all components of the system be drained. There are
several methods of maintaining dry air flow through the equipment. The advantages and
disadvantages of dry air layup and the equipment required have been previously described in
other EPRI documents(3,6).
Step 4 - Dry Layup with Nitrogen
Nitrogen can be used for blanketing equipment, which is drained but not completely dry, or for
blanketing equipment either filled with water or not, to prevent air ingress.
Step 4 is similar to Step 3, except nitrogen is used for a positive pressure on all components
rather than a dry air purge. A small continuous purge of nitrogen is required, however, to protect
the turbine and deaerator storage tank.
F-15
For those units having copper alloy condenser tubes and/or feedwater heaters, feedwater pH
should be limited to 9.0 to 9.3 by reducing ammonia. Hydrazine is held at 40-50 ppm. For these
units, it is most important to maintain reducing conditions (ORP < 0 mV and preferably to -350
mV) to prevent increased attack of the copper alloys associated with a change of the surface
oxide layers from cuprous to cupric oxide.
A nitrogen cap of 5 psi (0.03 MPa) is maintained on the boiler.
Step 6 - Wet Layup: Low Oxygen Scavenger Method (Boiler and Feedwater Heaters)
Many alternatives to the traditional wet layup method have been used successfully by markedly
reducing the level of hydrazine. These procedures may not require boiler draining prior to
startup, thereby protecting the environment and not requiring special disposal techniques or
permits. In one procedure, 5 to 10 ppm of hydrazine equivalent is injected into the boiler when
the boiler pressure decays to 200 psi (1.4 MPa) (typically 3 days). The chemical injection is
made using the normal chemical feed system. Natural boiler circulation at 200 psi (1.4 MPa) is
sufficient to mix adequately the chemicals in the boiler water. No other changes need be made to
the boiler or to the feedwater chemistry. When the boiler pressure decays to 5 psi (0.03 MPa)
(typically 7 days) a nitrogen cap is applied to the boiler.
Upon return to service, the boiler may be fired without draining the layup solution. Also, since it
typically take 3 days before the boiler pressure decays to 200 psi (1.4 MPa), weekend outages
normally do not require a chemical injection treatment.
Step 7 - Wet Layup (Balance of Cycle)
As the turbine spins down, nitrogen is added to the condenser, which also purges the reheater
system. A continuous purge of nitrogen is necessary to account for leakage through the turbine
steam seals.
Nitrogen is added to the deaerator and storage tank while this system is still hot. A small flow of
nitrogen is provided to purge this system.
A nitrogen cap is maintained on the shell side of the feedwater heaters. The superheater is back
filled with a solution of up to 200 ppm of hydrazine and 10 ppm ammonia and a nitrogen cap
maintained.
Step 8 - Very Long Storage
For very long storage periods, the reheater is isolated from the turbine, and back filled with a
solution of up to 200 ppm hydrazine and 10 ppm ammonia, and capped with nitrogen. The
superheater is treated similarly.
F-16
Step 9 - Maintenance
Only equipment requiring maintenance should be drained (wet storage only), and nitrogen (if
used) purged with air to provide an environment suitable for entry of personnel. Since nitrogen
does not support human life, it is extremely important that nitrogen is completely displaced by
air. The atmosphere within the equipment to be maintained should be tested with suitable test
equipment to ensure the equipment is safe for personnel entry.
Experience indicates that for mixed-metallurgy systems unit startups in the past have been a
major source of copper transport to the boiler, with concentrations as high as 10 ppm during cold
starts. By following the preceding startup guidelines, especially for oxygen control and air inleakage, copper transport can be minimized during these periods.
TARGETS
NORMAL
ACTION LEVEL 1
672
(28 days)
ACTION LEVEL 2
96
(4 days)
ACTION LEVEL 3
16
IMMEDIATE SHUTDOWN
F-17
Organizations attempting to apply the criteria to peaking units are challenged by the chemistry
variations associated with shutdown and startup periods, especially if no provision is made for
equipment layup. For chemistry accounting purposes, it is generally accepted that accrued
times in action level conditions should only be counted while the unit is in service at or above
minimum load at which the unit is normally operated to supply power to the system. However,
this approach does not lessen the value and importance of optimizing cycle chemistry under all
operating conditions.
Some concerns relative to cycling and operation are given below. An * indicates the items
affected by water and steam chemistry:
increased thermal stress on turbine rotor, steam chests, valves, and inner casing,* leading to
corrosion fatigue
increased solid particle erosion of HP and IP turbine blading from superheater and reheater
tube exfoliation
the need for improved boiler control to minimize unit restart and reloading times*
acid dew point condensation- corrosion and plugging of air preheaters and back end
ductwork
burner turndown ratio/flame stability at low loads- feeder turndown and mill response times
during load ramps too slow
increased frequency of chemical cleaning and more monitoring and control of steam and
water chemistry needed*
increased possibility of mill fires and explosions during frequent starting and stopping of a
unit
distortion and internal rubbing of the boiler feed pump, if pump is not fully warmed up at
startup
F-18
Some of the possible solutions to these problems are given below. Many of these solutions
require considerable expenditures. An * denotes possible effects on cycle water chemistry:
Additional detailed information on this topic can be found in the EPRIs Cycling, Startup, and
Layup Guidelines.(3) and in a recent ASME publication(8).
F-19
F.6 REFERENCES
1.
2.
K. Shimmoller, Plant O&M: Taking the Long View. Power Engineering, February
2000.
3.
Cycling, Startup, and Lay-up Fossil Plant Cycle Chemistry Guidelines for Operators and
Chemists. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA.: August 1998. TR-107754.
4.
5.
6.
Guidelines for Copper in Fossil Plants. EPRI, Palo Alto, CA: 2000. 1000457.
7.
M.L. Hoffman, Concerted Utility Efforts Tames Copper Deposition, Power, June 1994.
8.
Consensus for the Layup of Boilers, Turbines, Turbine Condensers and Auxiliary
Equipment, ASME, New York, NY: 2002. CRTD-Vol. 66.
F-20
G
CALCULATION OF THE pH CORRECTED FOR THE
PRESENCE OF AMMONIA
(eq. G-1)
where [Na] = [NaOH] + [NaPO4 ] is the molar concentration of sodium balanced by hydroxyl and
phosphate anions, and [PO4] is the total molar concentration of phosphate. Note that the sodium
balanced by other anions, such as chloride and sulfate, is not counted in [Na]. If the small
concentration of the hydrogen ion is neglected, ammonium remains the only other cation
balancing the hydroxyl anions, so that [NaOH] = [OH] [NH4+], and R can be written:
[OH - ] - [NH 4 ] + [Na PO4 ]
R =
[PO 4 ]
(eq. G-2)
The determination of [NaPO4], the amount of sodium necessary to balance the phosphate anions,
requires the knowledge of the speciation of phosphate taking into account all three dissociation
constants and all four species resulting from the three-step dissociation of orthophosphoric acid:
23H3PO4, H2PO4 , HPO4 , and PO4 . Such a calculation, arithmetically rather cumbersome, is
necessary to obtain a general solution valid in the entire range of pH from 0 to 14. However, it
can be shown that in the range of pH relevant for phosphate treatment chemistry in samples of
drum boiler water cooled to ambient temperature, practically all the phosphate is present as the
2HPO4 anion. This fortunate simplification is due to large differences between successive
dissociation constants of the tri-basic acid (4 to 5 orders of magnitude). Therefore, it can be
assumed that solid trisodium phosphate dissociates according to the reaction:
Na3PO4
(eq. G-3)
The effect of reaction 3 is a contribution of one mole of NaOH by each mole of phosphate
present in the solution. In other words, 1 ppm additional phosphate as the trisodium salt
contributes the same increase in alkalinity as 0.421 ppm additional NaOH. It should be
emphasized, however, that this is only true for samples of boiler water at room temperature,
when pH is not much less than 9 or greater than 10.
G-1
Using equation G-3 the amount of sodium associated with phosphate as [NaPO4 ] = 2 [PO4] can
immediately be identified, and the ratio R (eq. G-2) can be expressed as a function of pH by the
following equation:
R =
10 pH pK w - [NH +4 ] + 2 [PO4]
[PO 4 ]
(eq. G-4)
+
-14
where Kw = [H ][OH] = 10 (pKw = 14) at 25 C (77 F) is the ion product of water.
The last step remaining before obtaining the final relationship between R and pH is to determine
the concentration of the ammonium cation. It may be tempting to assume that ammonia is
completely dissociated, and each mole of ammonia contributes one mole each of hydroxyl and
ammonium ions. Unfortunately, the concentration of the ammonium ion varies with the total
concentration of ammonia and with pH, and so it has to be calculated using the dissociation
constant of ammonia as discussed below.
Since ammonia is a weak base, the equilibrium constant of the reaction:
NH3 + H2O
NH4+ + OH
(eq. G-5)
proceeding from the left to the right side is relatively small; at 25 C (77 F):
Kd
[ NH 4+ ][OH ]
= 1.8 10 -5 ,
[ NH 3 ]
pK d = 4.74
(eq. G-6)
The small value of K d does not mean that ammonia is always far from completely dissociated
+
and that the concentration of the ammonium cation NH4 is always small compared to the total
concentration of ammonia. In fact, at sufficiently low concentration the dissociation is indeed
practically complete. However, quantitatively it turns out that sufficiently low concentration
means much less than the ammonia levels relevant for drum boilers of power plant steam
generators. As a rule ammonia is partly dissociated in boiler water samples at ambient
temperature.
G-2
To correctly calculate the actual dissociation degree of ammonia in dilute solutions as a function
of concentration, it is necessary to solve the system of four equations:
[ NH 4+ ][OH ]
[ NH 3 ]
[H + ][OH ] =
Kd
Kw
(eq. G-7)
(eq. G-8)
[ NH 4+ ] + [ NH 3 ] = m 0
(eq. G-9)
[H + ] + [NH 4+ ] = [OH ]
(eq. G-10)
with four unknown concentrations in square brackets. The solution of this system leads to a third
degree polynomial. If it is assumed that the concentration of hydroxyl ions coming from selfdissociation of water is very small in comparison to those coming from dissociation of ammonia,
+
then [OH] = [NH4 ] and the system can be reduced to two equations (eq. G-7 and G-9) leading
to a second degree polynomial. This simplified solution, most often presented in textbooks, is
accurate if the dilution is not extreme.
Figure G-1 plots the concentrations of the aqueous ammonium ion and ammonia as a function of
total ammonia obtained as a solution of equations G-7 through G-10. It shows that at about 0.6
ppm ammonia the degree of dissociation is about 50%. The enlargement of the dilute region
shows that at concentrations greater than about 50 ppb (0.05 ppm) the dissociation of ammonia
can not be considered complete even for approximate practical considerations. Thus, the
assumption that each mole of ammonia contributes one mole of the OH ion to the solution, and
so is equivalent to one mole of NaOH, is incorrect, and in general may lead to significant errors
in the estimation of the pH correction for ammonia.
G-3
Figure G-1
Concentrations of the Aqueous Ammonium Cation (NH4+) (Continuous Line) and Aqueous
Neutral Ammonia Species NH3 (Dashed Line) in Solutions of Pure Ammonia.
It should also be kept in mind that Figure G-1 represents solutions of pure ammonia in water.
Additional alkalinity due to phosphate and excess NaOH will reverse the dissociation (eq. G-5)
and further decrease the degree of dissociation.
Using equations G-7 and G-9 the concentration of the ammonium cation as a function of pH can
now be calculated, by first substituting [OH-] = 10pH pKw (equation G-8) . The result is
G-4
[ NH 4+ ] =
K d m NH 3
,
10 pH pKw + K d
(eq. G-11)
and the final form of equation G-4 expressing the Na/PO4 ratio R as a function of pH, phosphate
molality mPO4, and ammonia molality mNH3 is:
10 pH pK w R ( pH , m PO 4 , m NH 3 ) =
10
K m NH 3
+ Kd
m PO 4
d
pH pK w
+ 2 mPO 4
(eq. G-12)
where pH is the measured value, with ammonia. Note that essentially the same reasoning
leading to the above expression was presented by Verib.G1
Of course, without ammonia, equation G-12 is reduced to:
R ( pH 0 , m PO 4 ) =
10 pH 0 pK w
m PO 4
+ 2,
(eq. G-13)
yielding, after solving for pH0 without ammonia (the goal of the calculation),
pH 0 ( R, m PO 4 ) = log[( R 2) m PO 4 ] + pK w .
(eq. G-14)
Since the sodium to phosphate ratio remains the same with or without ammonia, the equation G12 can be substituted into equation G-14 to obtain the following expression for pH0 without
ammonia as a function the measured pH with ammonia and the concentration of ammonia, mNH3,
K d m NH 3
+ pK w ,
pH 0 ( pH, m NH 3 ) = log 10 pH pK w pH pK w
10
+ K d
(eq. G-15)
and the following expression for the correction pH = pH pH0 to be subtracted from the
measured value of pH:
K d m NH 3
pK w
pH ( pH , m NH 3 ) = pH log 10 pH pK w pH pK w
10
+ K d
(eq. G-16)
The molar concentration of ammonia mNH3 can be substituted by the mass fraction A expressed as
ppm using mNH3 = 0.001 A / MNH3 = A / 17031. For the purpose of boiler water chemistry
surveillance, equation G-15 may be used to calculate corrected pH from the measured boiler
water pH and ammonia concentration. A graphical presentation of equation G-15 at various
ammonia concentrations is shown in Figure G-2. A slightly simplified version of Figure G-2,
which allows plant personnel to easily determine the corrected boiler pH, is also shown in
Section 4 as Figure 4-5.
G-5
Note that equations G-15 and G-16 do not depend on the concentration of phosphate, and so are
valid for CT, PC(L), and PC(H). The only approximations used in the derivation of these
equations and Figure G-2 are the omission of the hydrogen ions in equation G-2 and the
assumption that reaction G-3 describes the speciation of phosphate, as discussed previously.
It is also worth noting that the sodium-to-phosphate ratio R used in this discussion can vary
continuously from zero to infinity. In practice the amounts of sodium above R = 3 are expressed
as ppm NaOH,
ppm NaOH = 1000 MNaOH mPO4 (R 3)
(eq. G-17)
or
K d m NH 3
ppm NaOH ( pH , mPO 4 , m NH 3 ) = 1000 M NaOH 10 pH pK w
pH pK w
+ Kd
10
mPO 4
(eq. G-18)
where 1000 MNaOH = 39997 kg/mol, and the molal concentration of phosphate mPO4 can be
substituted by the ppm mass fraction P using mPO4 = 0.001 P / MPO4 = P / 94971.
Figure G-2
Relationship Between Corrected Boiler Water pH, Measured Boiler Water pH and Measured
Ammonia Concentration, as Determined using Equation G-15. The lines on the figure
increase in 0.1 ppm ammonia increments from 0 to 2 ppm.
G-6
G.1 REFERENCES
1. G.J. Verib. Sodium to Phosphate Ratios Power Plant Chemistry 4(11), 687-690, 2002.
G-7
H
EPRI FOSSIL PLANT CYCLE CHEMISTRY REPORTS,
GUIDELINES AND CONFERENCE PROCEEDINGS
1.
2.
STEAM SAMPLING
TR-100196, December 1991
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
H-2
H-3
H-4
H-5
CONFERENCE PROCEEDINGS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Workshop on Corrosion of Steam Turbine Blading and Disks in the Phase Transition Zone.
TR-111340. November 1998
9.
Steam Chemistry: Interaction of Chemical Species with Water, Steam, and Materials
during Evaporation, Superheating, and Condensation.
TR-114837. August 2000
10.
11.
H-6
Program:
Boiler and Turbine Steam and Cycle Chemistry
About EPRI
EPRI creates science and technology solutions for
the global energy and energy services industry. U.S.
electric utilities established the Electric Power
Research Institute in 1973 as a nonprofit research
consortium for the benefit of utility members, their
customers, and society. Now known simply as EPRI,
the company provides a wide range of innovative
products and services to more than 1000 energyrelated organizations in 40 countries. EPRIs
multidisciplinary team of scientists and engineers
draws on a worldwide network of technical and
business expertise to help solve todays toughest
energy and environmental problems.
EPRI. Electrify the World
2. COPYRIGHT
This package, including the information contained in it, is either licensed to EPRI or owned by EPRI and is protected by United States
and international copyright laws.You may not, without the prior written permission of EPRI, reproduce, translate or modify this package, in any form, in whole or in part, or prepare any derivative work based on this package.
3. RESTRICTIONS
You may not rent, lease, license, disclose or give this package to any person or organization, or use the information contained in this
package, for the benefit of any third party or for any purpose other than as specified above unless such use is with the prior written
permission of EPRI.You agree to take all reasonable steps to prevent unauthorized disclosure or use of this package. Except as specified above, this agreement does not grant you any right to patents, copyrights, trade secrets, trade names, trademarks or any other
intellectual property, rights or licenses in respect of this package.
4.TERM AND TERMINATION
This license and this agreement are effective until terminated.You may terminate them at any time by destroying this package. EPRI has
the right to terminate the license and this agreement immediately if you fail to comply with any term or condition of this agreement.
Upon any termination you may destroy this package, but all obligations of nondisclosure will remain in effect.
5. DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTIES AND LIMITATION OF LIABILITIES
NEITHER EPRI,ANY MEMBER OF EPRI,ANY COSPONSOR, NOR ANY PERSON OR ORGANIZATION ACTING ON BEHALF
OF ANY OF THEM:
(A) MAKES ANY WARRANTY OR REPRESENTATION WHATSOEVER, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, (I) WITH RESPECT TO THE USE
OF ANY INFORMATION,APPARATUS, METHOD, PROCESS OR SIMILAR ITEM DISCLOSED IN THIS PACKAGE, INCLUDING
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR (II) THAT SUCH USE DOES NOT INFRINGE ON OR
INTERFERE WITH PRIVATELY OWNED RIGHTS, INCLUDING ANY PARTYS INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY, OR (III) THAT THIS
PACKAGE IS SUITABLE TO ANY PARTICULAR USERS CIRCUMSTANCE; OR
(B) ASSUMES RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY WHATSOEVER (INCLUDING ANY CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF EPRI OR ANY EPRI REPRESENTATIVE HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGES) RESULTING FROM YOUR SELECTION OR USE OF THIS PACKAGE OR ANY INFORMATION, APPARATUS,
METHOD, PROCESS OR SIMILAR ITEM DISCLOSED IN THIS PACKAGE.
6. EXPORT
The laws and regulations of the United States restrict the export and re-export of any portion of this package, and you agree not to
export or re-export this package or any related technical data in any form without the appropriate United States and foreign government approvals.
7. CHOICE OF LAW
This agreement will be governed by the laws of the State of California as applied to transactions taking place entirely in California
between California residents.
8. INTEGRATION
You have read and understand this agreement, and acknowledge that it is the final, complete and exclusive agreement between you
and EPRI concerning its subject matter, superseding any prior related understanding or agreement. No waiver, variation or different
terms of this agreement will be enforceable against EPRI unless EPRI gives its prior written consent, signed by an officer of EPRI.
EPRI 3412 Hillview Avenue, Palo Alto, California 94304 PO Box 10412, Palo Alto, California 94303 USA
800.313.3774 650.855.2121 [email protected] www.epri.com